advertisement
▼
Scroll to page 2
of 410
Xenon™/Granit™ Xenon 1900, 1900h, 1910, 1902, 1902h, 1912, 1902g-BF Granit 1910i, 1911i, 1980i, 1981i Area-Imaging Scanners User Guide Disclaimer Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII. HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. HII disclaims all responsibility for the selection and use of software and/or hardware to achieve intended results. This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII. 2010-2017 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com Microsoft® Windows®, Windows NT®, Windows 2000, Windows ME, Windows XP, and the Windows logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. Other product names or marks mentioned in this document may be trademarks or registered trademarks of other companies and are the property of their respective owners. For patent information, refer to www.hsmpats.com. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com TABLE OF CONTENTS Customer Support ..................................................................................................................... xvii Technical Assistance .......................................................................................................... xvii Product Service and Repair ............................................................................................. xvii Limited Warranty ................................................................................................................. xvii Send Feedback ..................................................................................................................... xvii Chapter 1 - Get Started .................................................................................... 1 About This Manual......................................................................................................................... 1 Unpack Your Device....................................................................................................................... 1 Connect the Device........................................................................................................................ 1 Connect with USB.................................................................................................................... 1 Connect with Keyboard Wedge .......................................................................................... 4 Connect with RS232 Serial Port ........................................................................................ 6 Connect with RS485............................................................................................................... 8 Mount a CCB01-010BT Charge Base .................................................................................... 9 Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base .................................................................... 9 Reading Techniques................................................................................................................... 11 Xenon 1900/1902/1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i ................................... 11 Granit 1980i/1981i.............................................................................................................. 11 Menu Bar Code Security Settings......................................................................................... 12 Set Custom Defaults .................................................................................................................. 12 Reset the Custom Defaults...................................................................................................... 13 Chapter 2 - Program the Interface ............................................................. 15 Introduction................................................................................................................................... 15 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com i Program the Interface - Plug and Play ...............................................................................15 Keyboard Wedge ..........................................................................................................................15 Laptop Direct Connect ..............................................................................................................16 RS232 Serial Port.........................................................................................................................16 RS485 ...............................................................................................................................................16 RS485 Packet Mode.............................................................................................................17 USB IBM SurePos ........................................................................................................................18 USB PC or Macintosh Keyboard ............................................................................................18 USB HID...........................................................................................................................................19 USB Serial .......................................................................................................................................19 CTS/RTS Emulation .............................................................................................................19 ACK/NAK Mode......................................................................................................................20 Remote MasterMind™ for USB ...............................................................................................20 Verifone® Ruby Terminal............................................................................................................20 Gilbarco® Terminal .......................................................................................................................21 Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port .....................................................................................................21 Datalogic™ Magellan® Aux Port ..............................................................................................21 NCR Bioptic Aux Port..................................................................................................................22 Wincor Nixdorf Terminal ...........................................................................................................22 Wincor Nixdorf Beetle™ Terminal ..........................................................................................22 Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A...............................................................................................23 Keyboard Country Layout.........................................................................................................23 Keyboard Style ..............................................................................................................................30 Keyboard Conversion .................................................................................................................32 Control Character Output.........................................................................................................32 Keyboard Modifiers.....................................................................................................................33 RS232 Modifiers ..........................................................................................................................34 RS232 Baud Rate ..................................................................................................................34 RS232 Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits, and Parity ............................................35 RS232 Receiver Time-Out .................................................................................................36 RS232 Handshake ................................................................................................................37 ii Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com RS232 Timeout.......................................................................................................................37 XON/XOFF ...............................................................................................................................38 ACK/NAK...................................................................................................................................38 Scanner to Bioptic Communication .....................................................................................38 Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode..........................................................................................39 Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode....................................................................................39 Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout ..............................................................................39 Chapter 3 - Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i........................................................................................41 How the Cordless Charge Base/Access Point Works.....................................................41 Link the Scanner to a Charge Base.......................................................................................41 Link the Scanner to an Access Point ....................................................................................42 Replace a Linked Scanner ........................................................................................................43 Communication Between the Cordless System and the Host...................................................................................................................................43 Program the Scanner and Base or Access Point .............................................................44 RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation...........................................................................44 System Conditions.......................................................................................................................44 Page Button....................................................................................................................................45 Page Button and Presentation Modes ................................................................................46 Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout.............................................................46 About the Battery .........................................................................................................................47 Charge Information ..............................................................................................................47 Battery Recommendations................................................................................................47 Safety Precautions for Lithium Batteries.....................................................................48 Proper Disposal of the Battery .........................................................................................48 Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning ........................................................................48 Scanner LED Sequences and Meaning........................................................................49 Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning ...................................................49 Base Power Communication Indicator .........................................................................50 Reset Scanner................................................................................................................................50 Scan While in Base Cradle........................................................................................................50 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com iii Base Charge Modes....................................................................................................................51 Page ..................................................................................................................................................51 Page Mode ...............................................................................................................................51 Page Pitch ................................................................................................................................52 Error Indicators.............................................................................................................................52 Beeper Pitch - Base Error...................................................................................................52 Number of Beeps - Base Error .........................................................................................53 Scanner Report.............................................................................................................................53 Scanner Address ..........................................................................................................................53 Base or Access Point Address .................................................................................................54 Scanner Modes.............................................................................................................................54 Charge Only Mode ................................................................................................................54 Charge and Link Mode........................................................................................................54 Linked Modes .........................................................................................................................55 Unlink the Scanner......................................................................................................................55 Override Locked Scanner...................................................................................................56 Out-of-Range Alarm...................................................................................................................56 Alarm Sound Type .................................................................................................................56 Scanner Power Time-Out Timer.............................................................................................57 Flexible Power Management...................................................................................................58 Batch Mode ....................................................................................................................................59 Batch Mode Beep ..................................................................................................................60 Batch Mode Storage ............................................................................................................60 Batch Mode Quantity...........................................................................................................61 Enter Quantities.....................................................................................................................61 Batch Mode Output Order .................................................................................................63 Total Records...........................................................................................................................63 Delete Last Code ...................................................................................................................64 Clear All Codes .......................................................................................................................64 Transmit Records to Host ..................................................................................................64 Batch Mode Transmit Delay..............................................................................................64 Multiple Scanner Operation ....................................................................................................65 Scanner Name ..............................................................................................................................65 iv Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Application Work Groups ..........................................................................................................67 Application Work Group Selection..................................................................................67 Reset the Factory Defaults: All Application Work Groups ............................................68 Reset the Custom Defaults: All Application Work Groups ...........................................69 Use the Scanner with Bluetooth Devices............................................................................69 Bluetooth Secure Simple Pairing (SSP)........................................................................69 Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect...................................................................................70 Virtual Keyboard.....................................................................................................................71 Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect.............................................................................71 Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/Laptops.............................................................................72 PDAs/Mobility Systems Devices .....................................................................................72 Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code ................................................................72 Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity ............................................................72 Auto Reconnect Mode .........................................................................................................73 Maximum Link Attempts ....................................................................................................73 Relink Time-Out .....................................................................................................................74 Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples.................................................................75 Host Acknowledgment ...............................................................................................................75 Host ACK On/Off ...................................................................................................................77 Host ACK Timeout .................................................................................................................77 Host ACK Responses ............................................................................................................77 Chapter 4 - Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF...................79 How the CCB01-010BT-BF Cordless Charge Base Works ..........................................79 Link the Scanner to a Charge Base.......................................................................................80 Replace a Linked Scanner ........................................................................................................80 Communication Between the Cordless System and the Host...................................................................................................................................81 Program the Scanner and Base..............................................................................................81 RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation...........................................................................81 System Conditions.......................................................................................................................82 About the Instant Charge Pack...............................................................................................83 Charge Information ..............................................................................................................83 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com v Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning........................................................................83 Scanner .....................................................................................................................................84 Low Power Alerts..........................................................................................................................84 Low Power Alert Range .......................................................................................................85 Low Power Alert Flash Number .......................................................................................85 Low Power Alert Repeat ......................................................................................................85 Low Power Alert Beep ..........................................................................................................86 Base...................................................................................................................................................86 Base Communication and Scanning ............................................................................86 Base Charge Status ..............................................................................................................87 Base Power Communication Indicator.........................................................................87 Reset Scanner ...............................................................................................................................87 Base Charge Modes....................................................................................................................88 Page Button with Scanner Out of the Base .......................................................................88 Page Button with Scanner in the Base................................................................................89 Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout.............................................................89 Scan While in Base Cradle........................................................................................................90 Paging ..............................................................................................................................................90 Page Mode ...............................................................................................................................90 Page Pitch ................................................................................................................................91 Linking Sound...............................................................................................................................91 Error Indicators.............................................................................................................................91 Beeper Pitch - Base Error...................................................................................................91 Number of Beeps - Base Error .........................................................................................92 Scanner Report.............................................................................................................................92 Scanner Address ..........................................................................................................................92 Base Address .................................................................................................................................93 Scanner Modes.............................................................................................................................93 Charge Only Mode ................................................................................................................93 Charge and Link Mode........................................................................................................93 Linked Modes .........................................................................................................................93 Unlink the Scanner......................................................................................................................94 Override Locked Scanner...................................................................................................95 vi Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Out-of-Range Alarm ...................................................................................................................95 Alarm Sound Type .................................................................................................................95 Scanner Power Time-Out Timer .............................................................................................96 Flexible Power Management ...................................................................................................97 Batch Mode ....................................................................................................................................98 Batch Mode Beep ..................................................................................................................99 Batch Mode Storage.............................................................................................................99 Batch Mode Quantity ........................................................................................................100 Enter Quantities ..................................................................................................................100 Batch Mode Output Order ..............................................................................................102 Total Records........................................................................................................................102 Delete Last Code.................................................................................................................102 Clear All Codes.....................................................................................................................103 Transmit Records to Host................................................................................................103 Batch Mode Transmit Delay ...........................................................................................103 Scanner Name............................................................................................................................104 Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code .............................................................105 Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity .........................................................105 Auto Reconnect Mode ......................................................................................................105 Maximum Link Attempts .................................................................................................106 Relink Time-Out ..................................................................................................................107 Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples..............................................................107 Host Acknowledgment ............................................................................................................108 Host ACK On/Off ................................................................................................................109 Host ACK Timeout ..............................................................................................................109 Host ACK Responses .........................................................................................................110 Chapter 5 - Input/Output Settings ..........................................................111 Power Up Beeper .......................................................................................................................111 Beep on BEL Character ..........................................................................................................112 Trigger Click.................................................................................................................................112 Good Read and Error Indicators..........................................................................................112 Beeper – Good Read ..........................................................................................................112 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com vii Beeper Volume – Good Read ......................................................................................... 113 Beeper Pitch – Good Read .............................................................................................. 113 Vibrate – Good Read.......................................................................................................... 113 Beeper Pitch – Error .......................................................................................................... 114 Beeper Duration – Good Read....................................................................................... 115 LED – Good Read ............................................................................................................... 115 Number of Beeps – Good Read..................................................................................... 115 Number of Beeps – Error................................................................................................. 115 Beeper Volume Max .......................................................................................................... 116 Good Read Delay ................................................................................................................ 116 User-Specified Good Read Delay................................................................................. 117 Trigger Modes ............................................................................................................................ 117 Manual Trigger .................................................................................................................... 117 Trigger Toggle ...................................................................................................................... 117 Serial Trigger ........................................................................................................................ 119 Read Time-Out .................................................................................................................... 119 Presentation Mode................................................................................................................... 120 Presentation LED Behavior after Decode................................................................. 120 Presentation Sensitivity................................................................................................... 120 Presentation Centering.................................................................................................... 121 In-Stand Sensor Mode............................................................................................................ 122 Poor Quality Codes................................................................................................................... 123 Poor Quality 1D Codes ..................................................................................................... 123 Poor Quality PDF Codes .................................................................................................. 123 CodeGate® .................................................................................................................................... 124 Streaming Presentation™ Mode.......................................................................................... 124 Streaming Presentation In-Stand ............................................................................... 125 Mobile Phone Read Mode ..................................................................................................... 125 Hands Free Time-Out.............................................................................................................. 126 Reread Delay............................................................................................................................... 126 User-Specified Reread Delay......................................................................................... 127 2D Reread Delay ................................................................................................................. 127 Character Activation ................................................................................................................ 127 viii Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Activation Character..........................................................................................................128 End Character Activation After Good Read ..............................................................128 Character Activation Timeout........................................................................................129 Character Deactivation...........................................................................................................129 Deactivation Character ....................................................................................................129 Illumination Lights ...................................................................................................................130 Aimer Delay..................................................................................................................................130 User-Specified Aimer Delay............................................................................................131 Aimer Mode .................................................................................................................................131 Centering......................................................................................................................................131 Single Code Centering......................................................................................................132 Custom Centering ..............................................................................................................132 Preferred Symbology ...............................................................................................................134 High Priority Symbology..................................................................................................135 Low Priority Symbology ...................................................................................................135 Preferred Symbology Time-out.....................................................................................135 Preferred Symbology Default ........................................................................................136 Output Sequence Overview...................................................................................................136 Output Sequence Editor ..................................................................................................136 To Add an Output Sequence...........................................................................................136 Other Programming Selections ....................................................................................137 Output Sequence Example.............................................................................................137 Output Sequence Editor ..................................................................................................138 Partial Sequence.................................................................................................................138 Require Output Sequence...............................................................................................139 Multiple Symbols ......................................................................................................................139 No Read.........................................................................................................................................140 Video Reverse..............................................................................................................................140 Working Orientation.................................................................................................................141 Chapter 6 - Healthcare Settings ...............................................................143 Quiet Operations - Combination Codes...........................................................................143 Silent Mode with Flashing LED ....................................................................................143 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com ix Silent Mode with Long LED ........................................................................................... 144 Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode)............................................................................ 144 Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) ......................................................................................... 145 Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings .............................................................. 145 Linking LED Colors and Sound .................................................................................... 145 Number of LED Flashes .................................................................................................. 146 LED Flash Rate.................................................................................................................... 146 LED Solid (No Flash)......................................................................................................... 147 Page Volume Control ........................................................................................................ 147 Out-of-Range Alarm Volume......................................................................................... 148 Out-of-Range Delay.......................................................................................................... 149 Chapter 7 - Data Edit ...................................................................................151 Prefix/Suffix Overview ............................................................................................................ 151 Points to Keep In Mind ..................................................................................................... 151 Add a Prefix or Suffix:........................................................................................................ 152 Example: Add a Tab Suffix to All Symbologies........................................................ 152 Clear One or All Prefixes or Suffixes ........................................................................... 152 Add a Carriage Return Suffix to All Symbologies .................................................. 153 Prefix Selections........................................................................................................................ 153 Suffix Selections........................................................................................................................ 153 Function Code Transmit......................................................................................................... 154 Intercharacter, Interfunction, and Intermessage Delays.......................................... 154 Intercharacter Delay ......................................................................................................... 154 User Specified Intercharacter Delay........................................................................... 155 Interfunction Delay ........................................................................................................... 155 Intermessage Delay........................................................................................................... 156 Chapter 8 - Data Format .............................................................................157 Data Format Editor Introduction........................................................................................ 157 Add a Data Format.................................................................................................................... 158 Other Programming Selections.................................................................................... 159 Terminal ID Table................................................................................................................ 160 x Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Data Format Editor Commands ..........................................................................................160 Send Commands ................................................................................................................160 Move Commands................................................................................................................165 Search Commands.............................................................................................................167 Miscellaneous Commands .............................................................................................169 Data Formatter...........................................................................................................................173 Data Format Non-Match Error Tone...........................................................................174 Primary/Alternate Data Formats ........................................................................................175 Single Scan Data Format Change................................................................................175 Chapter 9 - Symbologies.............................................................................177 All Symbologies..........................................................................................................................178 Message Length Description ...............................................................................................178 Codabar.........................................................................................................................................179 Code 39 .........................................................................................................................................181 Interleaved 2 of 5.......................................................................................................................185 NEC 2 of 5 ....................................................................................................................................186 NEC 2 of 5 Message Length ..........................................................................................187 Code 93 .........................................................................................................................................187 Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar start/stop) ...........................................................189 Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/stop) .........................................................................190 Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy..................................................................................190 Matrix 2 of 5 ................................................................................................................................191 Code 11 .........................................................................................................................................192 Code 128 ......................................................................................................................................193 ISBT 128 Concatenation..................................................................................................193 Code 128 Redundancy .....................................................................................................193 GS1-128 .......................................................................................................................................195 Telepen ..........................................................................................................................................196 UPC-A ............................................................................................................................................197 UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code ..............................................................199 Coupon GS1 DataBar Output...............................................................................................200 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com xi UPC-E0 ......................................................................................................................................... 201 UPC-E0 Addenda Required............................................................................................ 201 UPC-E1 ......................................................................................................................................... 203 EAN/JAN-13 ............................................................................................................................... 204 EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Separator ................................................................................ 206 ISBN Translate..................................................................................................................... 206 EAN/JAN-8 .................................................................................................................................. 207 MSI.................................................................................................................................................. 209 GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional............................................................................................. 211 GS1 DataBar Limited .............................................................................................................. 211 GS1 DataBar Expanded ......................................................................................................... 212 Trioptic Code............................................................................................................................... 212 Codablock A ................................................................................................................................ 213 Codablock F ................................................................................................................................ 214 Label Code................................................................................................................................... 214 PDF417......................................................................................................................................... 215 MacroPDF417............................................................................................................................ 216 MicroPDF417 ............................................................................................................................. 216 GS1 Composite Codes ............................................................................................................ 217 GS1 Emulation........................................................................................................................... 218 TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39) ............................................................................................. 219 QR Code........................................................................................................................................ 219 Data Matrix.................................................................................................................................. 221 MaxiCode ..................................................................................................................................... 222 Aztec Code ................................................................................................................................... 223 Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code ...................................................................................... 224 Postal Codes - 2D ..................................................................................................................... 225 Planet Code Check Digit.................................................................................................. 229 Postnet Check Digit........................................................................................................... 229 Australian Post Interpretation....................................................................................... 229 Postal Codes - Linear.............................................................................................................. 230 China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) ..................................................................................... 230 xii Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Korea Post..............................................................................................................................231 ..........................................................................................................................................................232 Chapter 10 - Imaging Commands.............................................................233 Single-Use Basis .......................................................................................................................233 Command Syntax......................................................................................................................233 Image Snap - IMGSNP............................................................................................................234 IMGSNP Modifiers .............................................................................................................234 Image Ship - IMGSHP .............................................................................................................237 IMGSHP Modifiers .............................................................................................................238 Image Size Compatibility.................................................................................................246 Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX.........................................................................247 Signature Capture Optimize ..........................................................................................247 IMGBOX Modifiers .............................................................................................................248 RF Default Imaging Device ...................................................................................................252 Chapter 11 - Utilities ...................................................................................253 To Add a Test Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies.........................................................253 Show Decoder Revision ..........................................................................................................253 Show Scan Driver Revision....................................................................................................253 Show Software Revision .........................................................................................................254 Show Data Format ....................................................................................................................254 Test Menu.....................................................................................................................................254 TotalFreedom..............................................................................................................................254 Application Plug-Ins (Apps)..................................................................................................255 EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Introduction....................................................................255 EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Operations ................................................................256 Install EZConfig Cloud for Scanning ..........................................................................256 Reset the Factory Defaults ....................................................................................................257 Chapter 12 - Serial Programming Commands.......................................259 Conventions ................................................................................................................................259 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com xiii Menu Command Syntax ........................................................................................................ 259 Query Commands..................................................................................................................... 260 Trigger Commands................................................................................................................... 262 Reset the Custom Defaults ................................................................................................... 263 Menu Commands ..................................................................................................................... 264 Chapter 13 - Product Specifications........................................................295 Xenon 1900/1900h/1910 Corded Scanner Product Specifications .................. 295 Xenon 1902/1902h/1912 Cordless Scanner Product Specifications ............... 296 Xenon 1902g-BF Scanner Product Specifications ..................................................... 298 Granit 1910i Industrial Corded Scanner Product Specifications.......................... 299 Granit 1911i Industrial Cordless Scanner Product Specifications....................... 300 Granit 1980i Industrial Full Range Corded Scanner Product Specifications... 301 Granit 1981i Industrial Full Range Cordless Scanner Product Specifications 302 CCB01-010BT Charge Base Product Specifications ................................................. 304 CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base Product Specifications.......................................... 305 CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Industrial Charge Base Product Specifications305 Depth of Field Charts .............................................................................................................. 306 Xenon B&W Scanner Typical Performance.............................................................. 306 Xenon B&W Scanner Guaranteed Performance .................................................... 307 Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Typical Performance.................................. 308 Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Guaranteed Performance........................ 308 Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Typical Performance.............................................. 309 Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Guaranteed Performance.................................... 309 Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Typical Performance (200 lux) .......................... 310 Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Guaranteed Performance (200 lux) ................ 310 Standard Connector Pinouts ............................................................................................... 311 Keyboard Wedge................................................................................................................. 312 Serial Output ........................................................................................................................ 312 RS485 Output...................................................................................................................... 312 USB .......................................................................................................................................... 313 Required Safety Labels .......................................................................................................... 314 Xenon 1900/1910/1902/1912 Scanner ................................................................. 314 xiv Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base ...................................................................315 Granit 1910i/1911i/1980i/1981i Scanner.............................................................316 CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base...........................................................................317 Chapter 14 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting ..................................319 Repairs...........................................................................................................................................319 Maintenance ...............................................................................................................................319 Cleaning the Scanner .......................................................................................................319 Cleaning the Window ........................................................................................................319 Health Care Housing.........................................................................................................320 Inspecting Cords and Connectors ...............................................................................320 Replacing Cables in Corded Scanners .............................................................................320 Replacing a Xenon Interface Cable.............................................................................321 Replacing a Granit Interface Cable .............................................................................321 Replacing Cables and Batteries in Cordless Systems................................................321 Replacing an Interface Cable in a Base.....................................................................321 Changing a Xenon Scanner Battery............................................................................322 Changing a Granit Scanner Battery ............................................................................323 Troubleshooting a Corded Scanner ...................................................................................323 Troubleshooting a Cordless System ..................................................................................324 Troubleshooting a Base ...................................................................................................324 Troubleshooting a Cordless Scanner..........................................................................325 Chapter A - Reference Charts ....................................................................327 Symbology Charts.....................................................................................................................327 Linear Symbologies ...........................................................................................................327 2D Symbologies ..................................................................................................................328 Postal Symbologies ...........................................................................................................329 ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252) ....................................................................330 Lower ASCII Reference Table................................................................................................331 ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements ................................................................334 Keyboard Key References.......................................................................................................337 Sample Symbols ........................................................................................................................339 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com xv Programming Chart................................................................................................................. 341 xvi Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Customer Support Technical Assistance To search our knowledge base for a solution or to log in to the Technical Support portal and report a problem, go to www.hsmcontactsupport.com. Product Service and Repair Honeywell International Inc. provides service for all of its products through service centers throughout the world. To obtain warranty or non-warranty service, you must first obtain a Return Material Authorization number (RMA #) and then return your product to Honeywell (postage paid) with a copy of the dated purchase record. To learn more, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and select Service & Repair at the bottom of the page. Limited Warranty For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and click Get Resources > Product Warranty. Send Feedback Your feedback is crucial to the continual improvement of our documentation. To provide feedback about this manual, contact the Honeywell Technical Communications department at [email protected]. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com xvii xviii Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 1 GET STARTED About This Manual This User’s Guide provides installation and programming instructions for the Xenon™ 1900 and 1910 corded area-imaging scanners, the Xenon 1902 and 1912 cordless area-imaging scanners, the Granit 1910i and 1980i corded industrial scanners, and the Granit 1911i and 1981i cordless industrial scanners. Product specifications, dimensions, warranty, and customer support information are also included. Honeywell bar code scanners are factory programmed for the most common terminal and communications settings. If you need to change these settings, programming is accomplished by scanning the bar codes in this guide. An asterisk (*) next to an option indicates the default setting. Unpack Your Device After you open the shipping carton containing the product, take the following steps: • Check for damage during shipment. Report damage immediately to the carrier who delivered the carton. • Make sure the items in the carton match your order. • Save the shipping container for later storage or shipping. Connect the Device Connect with USB A scanner or a cordless base can be connected to the USB port of a computer. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 1 1. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device first, then to the computer. Corded Xenon Scanner USB Connection: Corded Granit Scanner USB Connection: 2 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 2. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw. CCB01-010BT/ CCB01-010BT-BF Base USB Connection: CCB02-100BT/ CCB05-100BT Base USB Connection: Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed. 3. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BT or CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT or CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on page 9. 4. The scanner beeps. 5. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339. The unit defaults to a USB PC Keyboard. Refer to page 18 for other USB terminal settings. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 3 For additional USB programming and technical information, refer to “USB Application Note,” available at www.honeywellaidc.com. Connect with Keyboard Wedge A scanner or cordless base can be connected between the keyboard and PC as a “keyboard wedge,” where the scanner provides data output that is similar to keyboard entries. Note: The Granit 1980i does not support the keyboard wedge interface. The following is an example of a keyboard wedge connection: 1. Turn off power and disconnect the keyboard cable from the back of the terminal/computer. 2. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device and to the terminal/ computer. Corded Xenon Scanner Keyboard Wedge Connection: Corded Granit Scanner Keyboard Wedge Connection: 4 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 3. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw. CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base Keyboard Wedge Connection: CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base Keyboard Wedge Connection: Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed. 4. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BT or CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT or CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on page 9. 5. Turn the terminal/computer power back on. The scanner beeps. 6. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339. The scanner beeps once. If using a Granit scanner, it also vibrates. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 5 The unit defaults to an IBM PC AT and compatibles keyboard wedge interface with a USA keyboard. A carriage return (CR) suffix is added to bar code data. Connect with RS232 Serial Port 1. Turn off power to the terminal/computer. 2. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the scanner. Note: For the scanner or cordless base to work properly, you must have the correct cable for your type of terminal/computer. Corded Xenon Scanner RS232 Serial Port Connection: Corded Granit Scanner RS232 Serial Port Connection: 6 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 3. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw. CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base RS232 Serial Port Connection: CCB02-100BT/CCB05/100BT Base RS232 Serial Port Connection: Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed. 4. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BTor CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT or CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on page 9. 5. Plug the serial connector into the serial port on your computer. Tighten the two screws to secure the connector to the port. 6. Once the scanner or cordless base has been fully connected, power up the computer. This interface programs 115,200 baud, 8 data bits, no parity, and 1 stop bit. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 7 Connect with RS485 A Xenon scanner or cordless base can be connected for an IBM POS terminal interface. (This interface is not available in the Granit devices.) 1. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device, then to the computer. Corded Xenon Scanner RS485 Connection: CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base RS485 Connection: Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed. 2. Make sure the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. 3. Turn the terminal/computer power back on. The scanner beeps. 4. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339. The scanner beeps once. If using a Granit scanner, it also vibrates. For further RS485 settings, refer to RS485, page 16. 8 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Mount a CCB01-010BT Charge Base 2.8 in. 72.1mm 3.35 in. 85.09mm 2.36 in. 59.84mm 8x32 thread x .39 in. (10mm) deep Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base The CCB02-100BT or CCB05-100BT Base can be mounted on either a horizontal or vertical surface. The cables can be routed through either the top or the bottom of the base. The cables can be routed down through the bottom of the base, securing the cables in the wireways. The cables can also be routed up through the top of the base, crossing them over and securing the cables in the wireways. When routing the cables up through the top of the base, be sure to cross the cables over before placing in the wireways. If not, too much strain is placed on the cable connectors. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 9 When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking system is used to secure the scanner when it is in the stand. When mounted on a horizontal surface, the locking mechanism should be set to unlocked (pushed up). When mounted on a vertical surface, the locking mechanism should be set to locked (pushed down). Locked position for vertical mount Unlocked position for horizontal mount Use 30mm screws, appropriate for the mounting surface material, to mount the base securely. 2.51 in. 63.7mm 5.31 in. 134.92mm 2 in. 51.17mm 2.36 in. 60mm .84 in. 21.42mm 10 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Reading Techniques Xenon 1900/1902/1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i The Xenon 1900/1902 scanners have a view finder that projects a bright red aiming beam that corresponds to the scanner’s horizontal field of view. The Xenon 1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i scanners have an aiming pattern. The aiming beam or pattern should be centered over the bar code, but it can be positioned in any direction for a good read. Linear bar codes with aiming beam 2D Matrix symbol with aiming beam Linear bar codes with aiming pattern 2D Matrix symbol with aiming pattern Granit 1980i/1981i The Granit 1980i/1981i scanners use a laser aimer (red dot) and a red LED (red box) to locate bar codes. Use the red LED when scanning at a near distance (less than 11.8 inches / 30 cm) and center the box over the bar code. The laser aimer (red dot) appears to the right of the center of the bar code. Use the laser aimer (red dot) when scanning at a far distance (up to 50 feet / 15.2 meters) and aim at the Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 11 center of the bar code. At far distances the red box may not be apparent. For both near distance and far distance, the aimers can be positioned in any direction for a good read. Near distance scanning less than 11.8 in/30 cm Far distance scanning up to 50 ft/15.2 m The aiming beam or pattern is smaller when the scanner is closer to the code and larger when it is farther from the code. Symbologies with smaller bars or elements (mil size) should be read closer to the unit. Symbologies with larger bars or elements (mil size) should be read farther from the unit. To read single or multiple symbols (on a page or on an object), hold the scanner at an appropriate distance from the target, pull the trigger, and center the aiming beam or pattern on the symbol. If the code being scanned is highly reflective (e.g., laminated), it may be necessary to tilt the code up 15° to 18° to prevent unwanted reflection. Menu Bar Code Security Settings Honeywell scanners are programmed by scanning menu bar codes or by sending serial commands to the scanner. If you want to restrict the ability to scan menu codes, you can use the Menu Bar Code Security settings. Contact the nearest technical support office (see Technical Assistance on page xvii) for further information. Set Custom Defaults You have the ability to create a set of menu commands as your own, custom defaults. To do so, scan the Set Custom Defaults bar code below before scanning the menu commands for your custom defaults. If a menu command requires scanning numeric codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then a 12 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Save code, that entire sequence will be saved to your custom defaults. When you have entered all the commands you want to save for your custom defaults, scan the Save Custom Defaults bar code. Set Custom Defaults Save Custom Defaults Note: When using a cordless system, the Custom Defaults settings apply to all workgroups. Scanning the Save Defaults bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base to re-establish the link before any setup codes are entered. If using an Access Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information. You may have a series of custom settings and want to correct a single setting. To do so, just scan the new setting to overwrite the old one. For example, if you had previously saved the setting for Beeper Volume at Low to your custom defaults, and decide you want the beeper volume set to High, just scan the Set Custom Defaults bar code, then scan the Beeper Volume High menu code, and then Save Custom Defaults. The rest of the custom defaults will remain, but the beeper volume setting will be updated. Reset the Custom Defaults If you want the custom default settings restored to your scanner, scan the Activate Custom Defaults bar code below. This is the recommended default bar code for most users. It resets the scanner to the custom default settings. If there are no custom defaults, it will reset the scanner to the factory default settings. Any settings that have not been specified through the custom defaults will be defaulted to the factory default settings. Activate Custom Defaults Note: If using a cordless system, scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base to re-establish the link. If using an Access Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 13 14 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 2 PROGRAM THE INTERFACE Introduction This chapter describes how to program your system for the desired interface. Program the Interface - Plug and Play Plug and Play bar codes provide instant scanner set up for commonly used interfaces. Note: After you scan one of the codes, power cycle the host terminal to have the interface in effect. Keyboard Wedge If you want your system programmed for an IBM PC AT and compatibles keyboard wedge interface with a USA keyboard, scan the bar code below. Keyboard wedge is the default interface. Note: The Granit 1980i does not support the keyboard wedge interface. Note: The following bar code also programs a carriage return (CR) suffix. IBM PC AT and Compatibles with CR suffix Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 15 Laptop Direct Connect For most laptops, scanning the Laptop Direct Connect bar code allows operation of the scanner in parallel with the integral keyboard. The following Laptop Direct Connect bar code also programs a carriage return (CR) suffix and turns on Emulate External Keyboard (page 31). Note: The Granit 1980i does not support Laptop Direct Connect. Laptop Direct Connect with CR suffix RS232 Serial Port The RS232 Interface bar code is used when connecting to the serial port of a PC or terminal. The following RS232 Interface bar code also programs a carriage return (CR) and a line feed (LF) suffix, baud rate, and data format as indicated below. It also changes the trigger mode to manual. Option Setting Baud Rate 115,200 bps Data Format 8 data bits, no parity bit, 1 stop bit RS232 Interface RS485 Scan one of the following “Plug and Play” codes to program the scanner for an IBM POS terminal interface. Note: This interface is not supported in Granit devices. After scanning one of these codes, you must power cycle the cash register. IBM Port 5B Interface IBM Port 9B HHBCR-1 Interface 16 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com IBM Port 17 Interface IBM Port 9B HHBCR-2 Interface Each bar code above also programs the following suffixes for each symbology: Symbolog y Suffix Symbology Suffix EAN 8 0C Code 39 00 0A 0B EAN 13 16 Interleaved 2 of 5 00 0D 0B UPC A 0D Code 128 * 00 0A 0B UPC E 0A Code 128 ** 00 18 0B MaxiCode 00 2F 0B * Suffixes programmed for Code 128 with IBM 4683 Port 5B, IBM 4683 Port 9B HHBCR-1, and IBM 4683 Port 17 Interfaces **Suffixes programmed for Code 128 with IBM 4683 Port 9 HHBCR-2 Interface RS485 Packet Mode The following selection allows you to break up large bar code data into smaller packets on an IBM POS terminal. To break up large bar codes into small packets, scan the Packet Mode On bar code below. Scan the Packet Mode Off bar code if you want large bar code data to be sent to the host in a single chunk. Default = Packet Mode Off. * Packet Mode Off Packet Mode On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 17 RS485 Packet Length If you are using Packet mode, you can specify the size of the data “packet” that is sent to the host. Scan the Packet Length bar code, then the packet size (from 20 256) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 40. Packet Length USB IBM SurePos Scan one of the following “Plug and Play” codes to program the scanner for an IBM SurePos (USB handheld scanner) or IBM SurePos (USB tabletop scanner) interface. Note: After scanning one of these codes, you must power cycle the cash register. USB IBM SurePos (USB Handheld Scanner) Interface USB IBM SurePos (USB Tabletop Scanner) Interface Each bar code above also programs the following suffixes for each symbology: Symbology Suffix Symbology Suffix EAN 8 0C Code 39 00 0A 0B EAN 13 16 Interleaved 2 of 5 00 0D 0B UPC A 0D Code 128 00 18 0B UPC E 0A Code 39 00 0A 0B USB PC or Macintosh Keyboard Scan one of the following codes to program the scanner for USB PC Keyboard or USB Macintosh Keyboard. Scanning these codes also adds a CR suffix. USB Keyboard (PC) 18 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com USB Keyboard (Mac) USB Japanese Keyboard (PC) USB HID Scan the following code to program the scanner for USB HID bar code scanners. USB HID Bar Code Scanner USB Serial If you are using a Microsoft® Windows® PC, you will need to download the latest driver from the Honeywell website (www.honeywellaidc.com) and go to Get Resources - Downloads - Software. The driver will use the next available COM Port number. Apple® Macintosh computers recognize the scanner as a USB CDC class device and automatically use a class driver. After the driver is downloaded, scan the following code to program the scanner to emulate a regular RS232-based COM Port. USB Serial No extra configuration (e.g., baud rate) is necessary. Note: If you scan the USB Serial bar code either with an older Honeywell serial driver, or no driver installed, you may no longer be able to scan bar codes. If this happens, either uninstall the older driver versions and install the latest driver, or delete the specific device entry in Device Manager. CTS/RTS Emulation CTS/RTS Emulation On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 19 * CTS/RTS Emulation Off ACK/NAK Mode ACK/NAK Mode On * ACK/NAK Mode Off Remote MasterMind™ for USB When using a USB interface, you may wish to configure your scanner to communicate with Remote MasterMind Scanner Management Software (ReM). Scan the ReM On bar code to communicate with ReM. To disable this capability, scan ReM Off. ReM Off ReM On Verifone® Ruby Terminal Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Verifone Ruby terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 1200 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, mark parity bit, 1 stop bit. It also adds a line feed (LF) suffix and programs the following prefixes for each symbology: 20 Symbology Prefix UPC-A A UPC-E A EAN-8 FF EAN-13 F Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Verifone Ruby Settings Gilbarco® Terminal Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Gilbarco terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 2400 bps and the data format to 7 data bits, even parity, 2 stop bits. It also adds a carriage return (CR) suffix and programs the following prefixes for each symbology: Symbology Prefix UPC-A A UPC-E E0 EAN-8 FF EAN-13 F Gilbarco Settings Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Honeywell bioptic scanner auxiliary port configuration. This bar code sets the baud rate to 38400 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit. Honeywell Bioptic Settings Datalogic™ Magellan® Aux Port Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Datalogic Magellan auxiliary port configuration. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit. Datalogic Magellan Settings Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 21 NCR Bioptic Aux Port Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for an NCR bioptic scanner auxiliary port configuration. The following prefixes are programmed for each symbology: Symbology Prefix Symbology Prefix UPC-A A Interleaved 2 of 5 b UPC-E E0 Code 128 f Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF) a Code 39 a EAN-8 FF EAN-13 F NCR Bioptic Settings Wincor Nixdorf Terminal Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit. Wincor Nixdorf Terminal Settings Wincor Nixdorf Beetle™ Terminal Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf Beetle terminal. The following prefixes are programmed for each symbology: 22 Symbology Prefix Symbology Prefix Aztec Code V Interleaved 2 of 5 I Codabar N MaxiCode T Code 93 L MicroPDF417 S Code 128 K PDF417 Q Data Matrix R QR Code U EAN-8 B Straight 2 of 5 IATA H EAN-13 A UPC-A A0 GS1 DataBar E UPC-E C GS1-128 P All other bar codes M Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Wincor Nixdorf Beetle Settings Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, odd parity, 1 stop bit. The following prefixes are programmed for each symbology: Note: This setting is not supported in Granit devices. Symbology Prefix Symbology Prefix Code 128 K EAN-13 A Code 93 L GS1-128 K Codabar N Interleaved 2 of 5 I UPC-A A0 Plessey O UPC-E C Straight 2 of 5 IATA H EAN-8 B GS1 DataBar E All other bar codes M Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A Settings Keyboard Country Layout If your interface is USB Keyboard or Keyboard Wedge, your keyboard layout default is a US keyboard. To change this layout, scan the appropriate Keyboard Country bar code below. By default, national character replacements are used for the following characters: # $ @ [ \ ] ^ ‘ { | } ~. Refer to the "ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements" on page A-334 to view the character replacements for each country. Keyboard Countries * United States Albania Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 23 Keyboard Countries (Continued) Azeri (Cyrillic) Azeri (Latin) Belarus Belgium Bosnia Brazil Brazil (MS) Bulgaria (Cyrillic) Bulgaria (Latin) Canada (French legacy) Canada (French) Canada (Multilingual) 24 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Countries (Continued) Croatia Czech Czech (Programmers) Czech (QWERTY) Czech (QWERTZ) Denmark Dutch (Netherlands) Estonia Faroese Finland France Gaelic Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 25 Keyboard Countries (Continued) Germany Greek Greek (220 Latin) Greek (220) Greek (319 Latin) Greek (319) Greek (Latin) Greek (MS) Greek (Polytonic) Hebrew Hungarian (101 key) Hungary 26 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Countries (Continued) Iceland Irish Italian (142) Italy Japan ASCII Kazakh Kyrgyz (Cyrillic) Latin America Latvia Latvia (QWERTY) Lithuania Lithuania (IBM) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 27 Keyboard Countries (Continued) Macedonia Malta Mongolian (Cyrillic) Norway Poland Polish (214) Polish (Programmers) Portugal Romania Russia Russian (MS) Russian (Typewriter) 28 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Countries (Continued) SCS Serbia (Cyrillic) Serbia (Latin) Slovakia Slovakia (QWERTY) Slovakia (QWERTZ) Slovenia Spain Spanish variation Sweden Switzerland (French) Switzerland (German) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 29 Keyboard Countries (Continued) Tatar Turkey F Turkey Q Ukrainian United Kingdom United States (Dvorak) United States (Dvorak left) United Stated (Dvorak United States (International) Uzbek (Cyrillic) Keyboard Style This programs keyboard styles, such as Caps Lock and Shift Lock. If you have used Keyboard Conversion settings, they will override any of the following Keyboard Style settings. Default = Regular. 30 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Regular is used when you normally have the Caps Lock key off. * Regular Caps Lock is used when you normally have the Caps Lock key on. Caps Lock Shift Lock is used when you normally have the Shift Lock key on (not common to U.S. keyboards). Shift Lock Automatic Caps Lock is used if you change the Caps Lock key on and off. The software tracks and reflects if you have Caps Lock on or off . This selection can only be used with systems that have an LED that notes the Caps Lock status (AT keyboards). Automatic Caps Lock Autocaps via NumLock bar code should be scanned in countries (e.g., Germany, France) where the Caps Lock key cannot be used to toggle Caps Lock. The NumLock option works similarly to the regular Autocaps, but uses the NumLock key to retrieve the current state of the Caps Lock. Autocaps via NumLock Emulate External Keyboard should be scanned if you do not have an external keyboard (IBM AT or equivalent). Emulate External Keyboard Note: After scanning the Emulate External Keyboard bar code, you must power cycle your computer. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 31 Keyboard Conversion Alphabetic keyboard characters can be forced to be all upper case or all lowercase. So if you have the following bar code: “abc569GK,” you can make the output “ABC569GK” by scanning Convert All Characters to Upper Case, or to “abc569gk” by scanning Convert All Characters to Lower Case. These settings override Keyboard Style selections. Note: If your interface is a keyboard wedge, first scan the menu code for Automatic Caps Lock (page 31). Otherwise, your output may not be as expected. Default = Keyboard Conversion Off. * Keyboard Conversion Off Convert All Characters to Upper Case Convert All Characters to Lower Case Control Character Output This selection sends a text string instead of a control character. For example, when the control character for a carriage return is expected, the output would display [CR] instead of the ASCII code of 0D. Refer to ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252) on page 330. Only codes 00 through 1F are converted (the first column of the chart). Default = Off. Note: Control + X (Control + ASCII) Mode overrides this mode. Control Character Output On * Control Character Output Off 32 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Modifiers This modifies special keyboard features, such as CTRL+ ASCII codes and Turbo Mode. Control + X (Control + ASCII) Mode On: The scanner sends key combinations for ASCII control characters for values 00-1F. Windows is the preferred mode. All keyboard country codes are supported. DOS mode is a legacy mode, and it does not support all keyboard country codes. New users should use the Windows mode. Refer to ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330 for CTRL+ X Values. Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix Off: The scanner sends key combinations for ASCII control characters for values 00-1F, but it does not translate prefix or suffix information. Default = Control + X Mode Off. Windows Mode Control + X Mode On * Control + X Mode Off DOS Mode Control + X Mode On Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix Turbo Mode: The scanner sends characters to a terminal faster. If the terminal drops characters, do not use Turbo Mode. Default = Off. Turbo Mode On * Turbo Mode Off Numeric Keypad Mode: Sends numeric characters as if entered from a numeric keypad. Default = Off. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 33 Numeric Keypad Mode On * Numeric Keypad Mode Off Automatic Direct Connect Mode: This selection can be used if you have an IBM AT style terminal and the system is dropping characters. Default = Off. Automatic Direct Connect Mode On * Automatic Direct Connect Mode Off RS232 Modifiers RS232 Baud Rate Baud Rate sends the data from the scanner to the terminal at the specified rate. The host terminal must be set for the same baud rate as the scanner. Default = 115,200. 300 600 1200 2400 34 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 4800 9600 19200 38400 57,600 * 115,200 RS232 Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits, and Parity Data Bits sets the word length at 7 or 8 bits of data per character. If an application requires only ASCII Hex characters 0 through 7F decimal (text, digits, and punctuation), select 7 data bits. For applications that require use of the full ASCII set, select 8 data bits per character. Default = 8. Stop Bits sets the stop bits at 1 or 2. Default = 1. Parity provides a means of checking character bit patterns for validity. Default = None. 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 35 7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Even 7 Data, 2 Stop Parity None 7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Odd 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even * 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Mark RS232 Receiver Time-Out The unit stays awake to receive data until the RS232 Receiver Time-Out expires. A manual or serial trigger resets the time-out. When an RS232 receiver is sleeping, a character may be sent to wake up the receiver and reset the time-out. A transaction on the CTS line will also wake up the receiver. The receiver takes 300 milliseconds to completely come up. Change the RS232 receiver time-out by scanning the bar code below, then scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then scanning Save. The range is 0 to 300 seconds. Default = 0 seconds (no time-out - always on). RS232 Receiver Time-Out 36 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com RS232 Handshake RS232 Handshaking allows control of data transmission from the scanner using software commands from the host device. When RTS/CTS is turned Off, no data flow control is used. Flow Control, No Timeout: The scanner asserts RTS when it has data to send, and will wait indefinitely for CTS to be asserted by the host. Two-Direction Flow Control: The scanner asserts RTS when it is OK for the host to transmit. The host asserts CTS when it is OK for the device to transmit. Flow Control with Timeout: The scanner asserts RTS when it has data to send and waits for a delay (see RS232 Timeout on page 37) for CTS to be asserted by the host. If the delay time expires and CTS is not asserted, the device transmit buffer is cleared and scanning may resume. Default = RTS/CTS Off. Flow Control, No Timeout Two-Direction Flow Control Flow Control with Timeout * RTS/CTS Off RS232 Timeout When using Flow Control with Timeout, you must program the length of the delay you want to wait for CTS from the host. Set the length (in milliseconds) for a timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 1-5100 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then scanning Save. RS232 Timeout Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 37 XON/XOFF Standard ASCII control characters can be used to tell the scanner to start sending data (XON/XOFF On) or to stop sending data (XON/XOFF Off). When the host sends the XOFF character (DC3, hex 13) to the scanner, data transmission stops. To resume transmission, the host sends the XON character (DC1, hex 11). Data transmission continues where it left off when XOFF was sent. Default = XON/XOFF Off. XON/XOFF On * XON/XOFF Off ACK/NAK After transmitting data, the scanner waits for an ACK character (hex 06) or a NAK character (hex 15) response from the host. If ACK is received, the communications cycle is completed and the scanner looks for more bar codes. If NAK is received, the last set of bar code data is retransmitted and the scanner waits for ACK/NAK again. Turn on the ACK/NAK protocol by scanning the ACK/NAK On bar code below. To turn off the protocol, scan ACK/NAK Off. Default = ACK/NAK Off. ACK/NAK On * ACK/NAK Off Scanner to Bioptic Communication The following settings are used to set up communication between Honeywell scanners and bioptic scanners. Note: The scanner’s baud rate must be set to 38400 and the RS232 timeout must be set to 3000 in order to communicate with a bioptic scanner. See "RS232 Modifiers" on page 34, and RS232 Timeout on page 37 for further information. 38 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode Packet Mode On must be scanned to set the scanner’s format so it is compatible with a bioptic scanner. Default = Packet Mode Off. * Packet Mode Off Packet Mode On Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode Bioptic ACK/NAK On must be scanned so the scanner will wait for an ACK or NAK from a bioptic scanner after each packet is sent. The Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout (below) controls how long the scanner will wait for a response. Default = Bioptic ACK/NAK Off. * Bioptic ACK/NAK Off Bioptic ACK/NAK On Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout This allows you to set the length (in milliseconds) for a timeout for a bioptic scanner’s ACK/NAK response. Scan the bar code below, then set the timeout (from 130,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then scanning Save. Default = 5100. ACK/NAK Timeout Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 39 40 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 3 CORDLESS SYSTEM OPERATION: XENON 1902G/1912 AND GRANIT 1911I/1981I Note: This chapter does not apply to corded or Xenon 1902g-BF scanners. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for Xenon 1902g-BF scanning systems. How the Cordless Charge Base/Access Point Works A cordless charge base or an Access Point provide the link between the cordless scanner and the host system. The base/Access Point contains an interface assembly and an RF communication module. The RF communication module performs the data exchange between the cordless scanner and the interface assembly. The control assembly coordinates the central interface activities including: transmitting/receiving commands and data to/from the host system, performing software activities (parameter menuing, visual indicator support, power-on diagnostics), and data translation required for the host system. The cordless charge base is also a scanner’s battery charger. Refer to Charge Information, page 47, for additional information. Link the Scanner to a Charge Base Turn off power before connecting a base, then power up the computer once the base is fully connected. When the base is connected and powered up, put the scanner in the base to establish a link. The green LED on the base flashes to indicate the scanner’s battery is charging. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 41 If the scanner and base have previously been linked, you do not receive any feedback. If this is the first time that the scanner and base are linked, both devices emit a short chirp when their radios link. At this point, that one scanner is linked to one base. Xenon Scanner CCB01-010BT Charge Base Page Button and Base LEDs Granit Scanner CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Charge Base Page Button and Base LEDs To determine if your cordless system is set up correctly, scan one of the sample bar codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner provides a single good read beep and the green LED lights, the scanner has successfully linked to the base. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. If you receive an error tone and the red LED lights, the scanner has not linked to the base. Refer to page 325 for troubleshooting information. Link the Scanner to an Access Point Turn on the computer (laptop/desktop). Plug the interface cable into the Access Point first and then into the appropriate port on the computer. The Page button lights up when the connection to the host is made. Page Button Scan the linking bar code on the top of the Access Point to establish a connection between the Access Point and the scanner. The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the green LED to confirm a connection with the Access Point. The Access Point’s Page button remains blue. 42 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Replace a Linked Scanner If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base or an Access Point, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base, or scan the Access Point linking bar code. The locked link will be overridden; the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base or Access Point will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked. Override Locked Scanner (Single Scanner) Communication Between the Cordless System and the Host The cordless scanner provides immediate feedback in the form of a “good read” indication with a green LED on the scanner and an audible beep. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. This indicates that the bar code has been scanned correctly and the base or Access Point has acknowledged receiving the data. This is possible since the cordless system provides two-way communication between the scanner and the base or Access Point. When data is scanned, the data is sent to the host system via the base or Access Point. The cordless scanner recognizes data acknowledgment (ACK) from the base or Access Point. If it cannot be determined that the data has been properly sent to the base or Access Point, the scanner issues an error indication. You must then check to see if the scanned data was received by the host system. 2 1 2 1 2 1. Scanner reads code and gets ACK from base or Access Point 2. Base or Access Point sends data to host Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 43 Program the Scanner and Base or Access Point When using the scanner and charge base or Access Point together as a system, menu parameters and configuration settings are stored in the charge base or Access Point. Therefore, when programming any menu configuration settings, the scanner must be linked to the intended charge base or Access Point. Note: This only applies when the scanner is linked to a charge base or Access Point. If the scanner is in a non-base mode, configuration settings are stored in the scanner. RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation The cordless system uses a two-way Bluetooth® radio to transmit and receive data between the scanner and the base or Access Point. Designed for point-to-point and multi-point-to-single point applications, the radio operates using a license free ISM band, which sends relatively small data packets at a fast data rate over a radio signal with randomly changing frequencies, makes the cordless system highly responsive to a wide variety of data collection applications and resistant to noisy RF environments. The CCB01-010BT (Bluetooth Class 2) provides a communication range of 33 feet (10m) between the scanner and base or Access Point, depending on the environment. The CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT (Bluetooth Class 1) provides a communication range of 330 feet (100m) between the scanner and base or Access Point, depending on the environment. See Flexible Power Management, page 58, for information about controlling this range. System Conditions The components of the cordless system interact in specific ways as you associate a scanner to a base or Access Point, as you move a scanner out of range, bring a scanner back in range, or swap scanners between two cordless systems. The following information explains the cordless system operating conditions. Link Process Once a scanner is placed into a cordless charge base, the scanner’s battery charge status is checked, and software automatically detects the scanner and links it to the base depending on the selected link mode. Refer to Link the Scanner to an Access Point, page 42, for information about linking to an Access Point. Scanner Is Out of Range The cordless scanner is in communication with its base or Access Point, even when it is not transmitting bar code data. Whenever the scanner can’t communicate with the base or Access Point for a few seconds, it is out of range. If the scanner is out of 44 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com range and you scan a bar code, the scanner issues an error tone indicating no communication with the base or Access Point. A cordless charge base can also sound an alarm. Refer to Out-of-Range Alarm, page 56. Scanner Is Moved Back Into Range The scanner relinks if the scanner or the base or Access Point have been reset, or the scanner comes back into range. If the scanner relinks, you will hear a single chirp when the relinking process (uploading of the parameter table) is complete. Refer to Out-of-Range Alarm on page 56 for further information. Out of Range and Back into Range with Batch Mode On The scanner may store a number of symbols (approximately 500 U.P.C. symbols; others may vary) when it is out of range and then send them to the base or Access Point when back in range (see Batch Mode on page 59). You will not hear a communication error tone in this mode, but you will hear a short buzz when you pull the trigger if the radio communication is not working. Once the radio connection is made, the scanner produces a series of beeps while the data is being transferred to the base or Access Point. Page Button When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping (3 short and 1 long beep). If you pull the trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the base or Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop beeping. See Page on page 51 for further information about Page Button settings. Note: If you are using a Xenon 1902h model, refer to Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings on page 145 for additional Page Button settings. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 45 Page Button and Presentation Modes When in Streaming Presentation Mode, the scanner’s aimer goes out after a short time, but the scan illumination remains on all the time to continuously search for bar codes (see Streaming Presentation™ Mode on page 124). When in Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode, pressing the page button on the base puts the scanner into Streaming Presentation Mode until the timeout occurs. If a bar code is scanned before the timeout is reached, the timer starts over. When the scanner is in the base, press the page button once to put the scanner into Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. When the scanner is in the base and the base has external power (plugged into an outlet), press the page button twice to put the scanner into Streaming Presentation Mode. Press it twice again to end Streaming Presentation Mode. When the base does not have external power, pressing the page button twice does not trigger Streaming Presentation Mode. When the scanner is out of the base, the page button works normally. Default = Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode On. * Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode On To remove Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode, scan the bar code for * Page Mode On on page 52. Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout Set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and searching for bar codes when using Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. Set the length for the timeout by scanning one of the bar codes below. Default = 10,000 ms (10 seconds). *10 Second Timeout 46 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 60 Second Timeout About the Battery Warning: There is a danger of explosion if the batteries are incorrectly replaced. Replace the batteries with only the same or equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Dispose of used batteries according to the recycle program for batteries as directed by the governing agency for the country where the batteries are to be discarded. Power is supplied to the cordless scanner by a rechargeable battery that is integrated in the scanner handle. Batteries are shipped only partially charged. The battery should be charged for a minimum of 4 hours before initial use to ensure optimal performance. Charge Information The battery is designed to charge while the scanner is positioned in the cordless base unit. Refer to Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning, page 49, for an interpretation of the Charge Status indicators. Refer to Charge Only Mode (page 54) if you need to charge a scanner without linking it to the base. Place the scanner in the base that is connected to an appropriate power supply. Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type power supply with output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A. Note: If you are powering the base through the interface cable (for example, a USB cable) and not using an external power supply plugged into the aux port, the current available for charging is reduced and charge times are increased. Battery Recommendations • The battery is a lithium ion cell and can be used without a full charge, and can also be charged without fully discharging, without impacting the battery life. There is no need to perform any charge/discharge conditioning on this type of battery. • Keep the base connected to power when the host is not in use. • Replace a defective battery immediately since it could damage the scanner. • Although your battery can be recharged many times, it will eventually be depleted. Replace it after the battery is unable to hold an adequate charge. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 47 • If you are not sure if the battery or charger is working properly, send it to Honeywell International Inc. or an authorized service center for inspection. Refer to Customer Support on page xvii for additional information. Caution: Use only Honeywell Li-ion battery packs, model number BATSCN01, rated 3.7 Vdc, 7.4Whr in this device. Use of any nonHoneywell battery may result in damage not covered by the warranty. Safety Precautions for Lithium Batteries • Do not place batteries in fire or heat the batteries. • Do not store batteries near fire or other high temperature locations. • Do not store or carry batteries together with metal objects. • Do not expose batteries to water or allow the batteries to get wet. • Do not connect (short) the positive and negative terminals, of the batteries, to each other with any metal object. • Do not pierce, strike or step on batteries or subject batteries to strong impacts or shocks. • Do not disassemble or modify batteries. Caution: Danger of explosion if batteries are incorrectly replaced. Dispose of used batteries according to the recycle program for batteries as directed by the governing agency for the country where the batteries are to be discarded. Proper Disposal of the Battery When the battery has reached the end of its useful life, the battery should be disposed of by a qualified recycler or hazardous materials handler. Do not incinerate the battery or dispose of the battery with general waste materials. You may send the scanner’s battery to us. (postage paid). The shipper is responsible for complying with all federal, state, and local laws and regulations related to the packing, labeling, manifesting, and shipping of spent batteries. Contact the Product Service Department (page xvii) for recycling or disposal information. Since you may find that your cost of returning the batteries significant, it may be more cost effective to locate a local recycle/disposal company. Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning The scanner contains LEDs on the rear of the unit that indicate linking status, decoding state, and battery condition. The base has LEDs on the top of the unit that indicate its power up, communication, and battery charge condition. The red 48 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com LED = error; green LED = success of any type. Scanners and the CCB01-010BT base have audible indicators as well: 1 razz or error tone = error; 2 beeps = menu change; 1 beep = all other successes. The table below lists the indication and cause of the LED indication, beeps, and vibrations for the scanner. Scanner LED Sequences and Meaning Beeper Indication Vibrate Indication Cause Red Flash None None Battery low Green Flash 1 beep None Successful communication or linking Red, blinking Razz or error tone None Failed communication Green Flash 2 beeps 2 vibrations Successful menu change Red, blinking Razz or error tone 1 long vibration Unsuccessful menu change LED Indication Normal Operation Menu Operation Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning The base contains a red LED and the Access Point has a blue LED that indicate the status of the unit and verifies its communication with the host system. The base also has a green LED that indicates scanner battery charge condition. Red or Blue LED - Host Communication Red or Blue LED Communication Condition Off USB suspend On continuously Power on, system idle Short blinks in multiple pulses. Occurs while transferring data to/ from the RF module or the Host port. Receiving data Green LED - Scanner Battery (base only, does not apply to Access Point) Green LED Charge Condition Off Battery not detected or charge suspended Slow flash, 1 second on, 1 second off Pre-charge and charging On continuously Charge complete Fast flash, 300 mSec on, 300 mSec off Charge Error Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 49 Base Power Communication Indicator To display the power indicator on a base or an Access Point, scan the Base Power Communication Indicator On bar code. To turn off the power indicator, scan the Off bar code. Default = On. * Base Power Communication Indicator On Base Power Communication Indicator Off Reset Scanner Scanning this bar code reboots the scanner and causes it to relink with the base or Access Point. Reset Scanner Scan While in Base Cradle Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base. If you want to be able to scan bar codes while the scanner is in the base cradle, scan the Scan in Cradle On bar code below. If you want to only allow scanning when the scanner is out of the base cradle, scan Scan in Cradle Off. If you want the scanner to shut down when in the base cradle, scan Shut Down Scanner in Cradle. Default = Scan in Cradle On (for CCB01-010BT). Scan in Cradle Off * Scan in Cradle On Shut Down Scanner in Cradle 50 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Base Charge Modes When the base has both an external power supply (plugged into the auxiliary power port) and a host interface cable, it will draw its power from the external power supply. When the base does not have an external power supply, it draws its power from the interface cable. However, the scanner battery charges more slowly from a host interface cable than if auxiliary power were available. Using the following selections, you can specify whether the scanner battery is charged from power supplied via the host interface cable. When Base Charge Off is selected, the scanner battery does not charge when the scanner is in the base cradle. When External or Interface Cable Power is selected, the scanner battery charges from the base’s external power supply, if there is one. If there is no external power supply to the base, the scanner battery charges from the interface cable. When External Power Only is selected, the scanner battery only charges from the base’s external power supply. If there is no external power supply, the scanner battery does not charge. Note: If you are using a cordless charge base in Presentation Mode, External Power Only is the only setting available. Default = External or Interface Cable Power. Base Charge Off External or Interface Cable Power External Power Only Page Page Mode By default, the paging button on the base or Access Point pages the scanners associated with that base or Access Point. If you want the paging button on your base or Access Point to be disabled, scan the Page Mode Off bar code, below. When Page Mode is off, the base or Access Point will no longer page scanners when Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 51 the button is pressed. The red LED on the base or blue LED on the Access Point will remain lit to indicate that Page Mode is off. (This light will go out when the button is pressed, then back on when it’s released.) Default = Page Mode On. Note: If you are using a Xenon 1902h model, refer to Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings on page 145 for additional Page Button settings. * Page Mode On Page Mode Off Page Pitch When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping (see Page Button on page 45). You can set the pitch of the paging beep for each scanner by scanning one of the following bar codes. Default = Low. * Low (1000 Hz) Medium (3250 Hz) High (4200 Hz) Error Indicators Beeper Pitch - Base Error Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base. The CCB01-010BT base can be configured to beep at a particular pitch when an error occurs, such as transmission problems to a host system. The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the error tone the base emits when there is an error. Default = Low. 52 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Razz (250 Hz) Medium (3250 Hz) High (4200 Hz) Number of Beeps - Base Error Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base. The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the CCB01-010BT base for an error condition can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this option to have five error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in response to an error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1. Number of Base Error Beeps/LED Flashes Scanner Report Scan the bar code below to generate a report for the connected scanners. The report indicates the port, work group, scanner name, and address. To assign a name to your scanner, refer to Menu Command Syntax, page 259. Scanner Report Scanner Address Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the scanner you are using. Scanner Address Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 53 Base or Access Point Address Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the base or Access Point you are using. Base Address Scanner Modes Your scanner is capable of working in single scanner mode, multiple scanner mode, or with Bluetooth devices other than the charge base or Access Point. Charge Only Mode There may be times when you want to charge your scanner, but not link to the base. For example, if a scanner is linked to an Access Point or other Bluetooth device and you need to charge the scanner, but want to retain your existing link. In order to program the base for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it. Once the scanner is linked to the base, scan the Charge Only Mode bar code. Any subsequent scanners placed in that base will charge without linking to it. The scanner used to program the base remains linked to the base. To unlink this scanner, scan Unlink Scanner on page 55. Charge Only Mode Note: When in Charge Only Mode, the scanner periodically wakes up and beeps. See "Power Up Beeper" on page 5-111 to change this setting. Charge and Link Mode If you want to charge a scanner and link to the base, use Charge and Link Mode. If the base is programmed for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it first in order to program it for Charge and Link Mode. Scan the linking bar code on the base to link the scanner, then scan Charge and Link Mode. Default = Charge and Link Mode. * Charge and Link Mode 54 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Linked Modes Locked Link Mode and Open Link Mode are the link modes that accommodate different applications. Scan the appropriate bar codes included in the Open Link and Locked Link Mode explanations that follow to switch from one mode to another. Default = Open Link Mode. Locked Link Mode - Single Scanner If you link a scanner to a base or an Access Point using the Locked Link Mode, other scanners are blocked from being linked if they are inadvertently placed into the base, or if the Access Point linking bar code is scanned. If you do place a different scanner into a base, it will charge the scanner, but the scanner will not be linked. Locked Link Mode (Single Scanner) To use a different scanner, you need to unlink the original scanner by scanning the Unlink Scanner bar code. (See Scanner Modes, page 54.) Open Link Mode - Single Scanner When newly shipped or defaulted to factory settings, a scanner is not linked to a base or an Access Point. A link is established when the scanner is placed into a base, or an Access Point linking bar code is scanned. When in Open Link Mode, a new link is established when a new scanner is placed in the base, or you scan an Access Point linking bar code. Each time a scanner is placed into a base or scans an Access Point linking bar code, the scanner becomes linked to the base or Access point and the old scanner is unlinked. * Open Link Mode (Single Scanner) Unlink the Scanner If a base or an Access Point has a scanner linked to it, that scanner must be unlinked before a new scanner can be linked. Once the previous scanner is unlinked, it will no longer communicate with the base or Access Point. To unlink the scanner from a base or an Access Point, scan the Unlink Scanner bar code below. Unlink Scanner Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 55 Override Locked Scanner If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base or an Access Point, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base, or scan the Access Point linking bar code. The locked link will be overridden; the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base or Access Point will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked. Override Locked Scanner (Single Scanner) Out-of-Range Alarm If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and scanner. If your scanner is out range of an Access Point, an alarm sounds from just the scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base or Access Point, when the base or Access Point connects to another scanner, or when the alarm duration expires. To activate the alarm options for the scanner or the base and to set the alarm duration, scan the appropriate bar code below and then set the time-out duration (from 0-3000 seconds) by scanning digits on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0 sec (no alarm). Base Alarm Duration Note: The Access Point does not have a base alarm. Scanner Alarm Duration Note: If you are out of range when you scan a bar code, you will receive an error tone even if you do not have the alarm set. You receive the error tone since the data could not be communicated to the base or Access Point or the host. Alarm Sound Type You may change the alarm type for the scanner or a CCB01-010BT base by scanning the appropriate bar code below and then scanning a digit (0-7) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0. The sounds are as follows: 56 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Setting Sound 0 3 long beeps, medium pitch 1 3 long beeps, high pitch 2 4 short beeps, medium pitch 3 4 short beeps, high pitch 4 single chirps, medium pitch 5 2 chirps, then 1 chirp, medium pitch 6 single chirps, high pitch 7 2 chirps, then 1 chirp, high pitch Base Alarm Type Note: Only the CCB01-010BT base has an alarm. Scanner Alarm Type Scanner Power Time-Out Timer When there is no activity within a specified time period, the scanner enters low power mode. Scan the appropriate scanner power time-out bar code to change the time-out duration (in seconds). Note: Scanning zero (0) is the equivalent of setting no time-out. If there are no trigger pulls during the timer interval, the scanner goes into power down mode. Whenever the trigger is enabled, the timer is reset. If the scanner is placed in the charge base cradle and the battery is in the process of being charged, the scanner will not go into power down mode. Default = 3600 seconds. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 57 0 seconds 200 seconds 400 seconds 900 seconds * 3600 seconds 7200 seconds Note: When the scanner is in power down mode, pull the trigger to power the unit back up. There will be a set of power up beeps and a delay of up to a few seconds for the radio to join. The scanner will then be ready to use. Flexible Power Management If you are experiencing network performance issues, and suspect the scanner is interfering with other devices, you can turn down the power output of the scanner. This reduces the range between the scanner and a base or an Access Point as shown in the following illustration: 802.11 LAN Scanner Red r uced Powe Full Power 58 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Scan one of the bar codes below to set the scanner’s power output to Full Power (100%), Medium Power (35%), Medium Low Power (5%), or Low Power (1%). Default = Full Power. Note: Setting a Granit scanner to anything lower than Full Power changes it to Class II Bluetooth. * Full Power Medium Power Medium Low Power Low Power Batch Mode Batch mode is used to store bar code data when a scanner is out of range of its base or Access Point, or when performing inventory. The data is transmitted to the base or Access Point once the scanner is back in range or when the records are manually transmitted. Note: Batch Mode is only supported by the Honeywell Charge and Communication Base (CCB) and Honeywell Access Point (AP). Batch mode has limitations when using multiple scanners to one base or Access Point. If a cordless system is being used in “multiple link mode,” where up to 7 scanners are to be connected to one base or Access Point, some accumulated or batched scans could be lost if scanners are constantly being moved in and out of range. Automatic Batch Mode stores bar code data when the scanner is out of range of the base or Access Point. The data is automatically transmitted to the base or Access Point once the scanner is back in range. When the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes again, the scanner must be moved back into range of the base or Access Point so data can be transmitted. Inventory Batch Mode stores bar code data, whether or not you are in range of the base or Access Point. To transmit the stored data to the base or Access Point, either place the scanner in the base, or scan Transmit Inventory Records (page 64). When Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 59 the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes again, the data must be transmitted to the base or Access Point. Once the data is transmitted, it is cleared in the scanner. Persistent Batch Mode is the same as Inventory Batch Mode, except that once the data is transmitted to the base or Access Point, it is retained in the scanner. If you want to transmit more than once, you can do so using this mode. In order to clear the scanner’s buffer, you must scan Clear All Codes (see page 64). Default = Batch Mode Off. * Batch Mode Off Automatic Batch Mode Inventory Batch Mode Persistent Batch Mode Batch Mode Beep When scanning in Inventory Batch Mode (page 60), the scanner beeps every time a bar code is scanned. If using a Granit scanner, it also vibrates. When Batch Mode Beep is On, you will also hear a click when each bar code is sent to the host. If you do not want to hear these clicks, scan Batch Mode Beep Off. Default = Batch Mode Beep On. Batch Mode Beep Off * Batch Mode Beep On Batch Mode Storage When a scanner is storing data during a Batch Mode process, you can select whether the data is stored in Flash memory or in RAM. 60 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Flash Storage: The scanner writes any untransmitted data to flash memory prior to powering down. The data will still be there when the scanner powers back up. However, the scanner will power down, even with untransmitted data, if it reaches a power down timeout or if the battery power is very low. RAM Storage: The scanner will not power down while it contains data that has not been transmitted to the base or Access Point, even if it reaches a power down timeout. However, if the scanner runs out of battery power, it will power down and the data will be lost. Default = Flash Storage. * Flash Storage RAM Storage Batch Mode Quantity When in Batch Mode, you may wish to transmit the number of multiple bar codes scanned, rather than a single bar code multiple times. For example, if you scan three bar codes called XYZ with Batch Mode Quantity Off, when you transmit your data it will appear as XYZ three times. Using Batch Mode Quantity On and the Quantity Codes (page 63), you could output your data as “XYZ, 00003” instead. Note: If you wish to format your output, for example, place a CR or tab between the bar code data and the quantity, refer to Data Format beginning on page 157. Default = Batch Mode Quantity Off. * Batch Mode Quantity Off Batch Mode Quantity On Enter Quantities Quantity Codes (page 63) allow you to enter a quantity for the last item scanned, up to 9999 (default = 1). Quantity digits are shifted from right to left, so if a 5th digit is scanned, the 1st digit scanned is discarded and the 2nd, 3rd and 4th digits are moved to the left to accommodate the new digit. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 61 For example, if the Quantity 5 bar code is scanned after the quantity has been set to 1234, then the 1 is dropped, the quantity will be 2345. Example: Add a quantity of 5 for the last item scanned. 1. Scan the item's bar code. 2. Scan the quantity 5 bar code. Example: Add a quantity of 1,500 for the last item scanned. 1. Scan the item's bar code. 2. Scan the quantity 1 bar code. 3. Scan the quantity 5 bar code. 4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code. 5. Scan the quantity 0 bar code. Example: Change a quantity of 103 to 10. To correct an incorrect quantity, scan the quantity 0 bar code to replace the incorrect digits, then scan the correct quantity bar codes. 1. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 1030. 2. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0300. 3. Scan the quantity 1 bar code to change the quantity to 3001. 4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0010. Default = 1. Quantity Codes 0 1 2 3 62 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Quantity Codes (Continued) 4 5 6 7 8 9 Batch Mode Output Order When batch data is transmitted, select whether you want that data sent as FIFO (first-in first-out), or LIFO (last-in first-out). Default = Batch Mode FIFO. * Batch Mode FIFO Batch Mode LIFO Total Records If you wish to output the total number of bar codes scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Total Records. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 63 Total Records Delete Last Code If you want to delete the last bar code scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Delete Last Code. Delete Last Code Clear All Codes If you want to clear the scanner’s buffer of all data accumulated in Batch Mode, scan Clear All Codes. Clear All Codes Transmit Records to Host If you are operating in Inventory Batch Mode (see Inventory Batch Mode on page 60), you must scan the following bar code to transmit all the stored data to the host system. Transmit Inventory Records Batch Mode Transmit Delay Sometimes when accumulated scans are sent to the host system, the transmission of those scans is too fast for the application to process. To program a transmit delay between accumulated scans, scan one of the following delays. Default = Off. Note: In most cases, a short (250 ms (milliseconds)) delay is ideal, however, longer delays may be programmed. Contact Technical Support (page xvii) for additional information. 64 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Batch Mode Transmit Delay Off (No Delay) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Short (250 ms) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Medium (500 ms) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Long (1000 ms) Multiple Scanner Operation Note: Multiple Scanner Operation Mode allows you to link up to 7 scanners to one base or Access Point. You cannot join an 8th scanner until you unlink one of the 7 scanners or take a scanner out of range. To put the scanner in multiple scanner mode, scan the bar code below. Once you scan this bar code, the scanner is unlinked from the base or Access Point and must either be placed into the base, or you must scan the Access Point linking bar code in order to relink. Multiple Scanner Operation Scanner Name You may assign a name to each scanner you are using for identification purposes. For example, you may want to have a unique identifier for a scanner that is receiving imaging commands sent from the base or Access Point. The default name is in the format “ScannerName_Model_SN_XXXXXXXXXX” If you have more than one scanner linked to a base, and they all have the same name, the first scanner linked to the base receives commands. When renaming a series of scanners with identical names, unlink all except one of the scanners from the base. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 65 Perform the rename operation using either the bar codes on page 67, or by sending the serial command :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. where ScannerName is the current name of the scanner, and NewName is the new name for the scanner. If you wish to change the names of additional scanners, link them one at a time and repeat the :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. command for each scanner. To rename scanners with sequential, numeric names, scan the bar codes below. Scan the Reset code after each name change and wait for the scanner to relink to the base or Access Point before scanning a bar code to rename the next scanner. 0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 0006 0007 Reset 66 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com You may also scan the Scanner Name bar code below and scan a number for the scanner name. For example, if you wanted to name the linked scanner “312,” you would scan the bar code below, scan the 3, 1, and 2 bar codes on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Scan the Reset bar code and wait for the scanner to relink to the base. Scanner Name Application Work Groups Your cordless system can have up to 7 scanners linked to one base or Access Point. You can also have up to 7 work groups. If you want to have all of the scanners’ settings programmed alike, you don’t need to use more than 1 work group. If you want each scanner to have unique settings (e.g., beeper volume, prefix/suffix, data formatter), then you may program each scanner to its own unique work group and may program each scanner independently. For example, you might want to have multiple work groups in a retail/warehouse application where you need to have different data appended to bar codes used in the warehouse area versus the retail area. You could assign all the scanners in the retail area to one work group and those in the warehouse to another. Consequently, any desired changes to either the retail or warehouse area would apply to all scanners in that particular work group. Honeywell’s online configuration tool, EZConfig-Scanning (page 254), makes it easy for you to program your system for use with multiple scanners and multiple work groups. The scanner keeps a copy of the menu settings it is using. Whenever the scanner is connected or reconnected to a base or an Access Point, the scanner is updated with the latest settings from the base or Access Point for its work group. The scanner also receives menu setting changes processed by the base or Access Point. If a scanner is removed from a base or an Access Point and placed into another base or linked to another Access Point, it will be updated with the new base/Access Point settings for whatever work group to which that the scanner was previously assigned. For example, if the scanner was in work group 1 linked to the first base, it will be placed in work group 1 in the second base with the associated settings. Application Work Group Selection This programming selection allows you to assign a scanner to a work group by scanning the bar code below. You may then program the settings (e.g., beeper volume, prefix/suffix, data formatter) that your application requires. Default = Group 0. * Group 0 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 67 Group 1 Group 2 Group 3 Group 4 Group 5 Group 6 Reset the Factory Defaults: All Application Work Groups The following bar code defaults all of the work groups to the factory default settings. PAPDFT& Factory Default Settings: All Work Groups To see what the factory default settings are, refer to the table of Menu Commands, beginning on page 264. The standard product default settings for each of the commands are indicated by an asterisk (*). Note: Scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in the base, or the Access Point linking bar code must be scanned to re-establish the link. Refer to Scanner Modes, page 54 for additional information. If your scanner is in multiple scanner mode, you will hear up to 30 seconds of beeping while all scanners are relinked to the base or Access Point and the settings are changed. 68 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Reset the Custom Defaults: All Application Work Groups If you want the custom default settings restored to all of the work groups, scan the Custom Product Default Settings bar code below. (If there are no custom defaults, it will reset the work groups to the factory defaults.) See Set Custom Defaults on page 12 for further information about custom defaults. Custom Default Settings: All Work Groups Note: Scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base, or the Access Point linking bar code must be scanned to re-establish the link. Refer to Scanner Modes, page 54 for additional information. If your scanner is in multiple scanner mode, you will hear up to 30 seconds of beeping while all scanners are relinked to the base or Access Point and the settings are changed. Use the Scanner with Bluetooth Devices The scanner can be used either with the charge base, an Access Point, or with other Bluetooth devices. Those devices include personal computers, laptops, PDAs, and Honeywell mobility systems devices. Bluetooth Secure Simple Pairing (SSP) Secure Simple Pairing (SSP) allows you to connect simply and securely to other Bluetooth devices without having to enter a PIN code (as described in Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect procedure). SSP is only available when using Bluetooth version 2.1 or higher. When SSP is on, no PIN is required for pairing. Turn SSP off if you are connecting to a Bluetooth device that is not using a compatible Bluetooth version. Default = Bluetooth SSP On. Note: SSP is only available with Granit 1981i scanner. * Bluetooth SSP On Bluetooth SSP Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 69 Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect Your scanner can be paired with Bluetooth-capable devices, such as personal computers, laptops, and tablets, so that scanned data appears on your device screen as though it was entered on the keyboard. In order to pair with the Bluetooth device: 1. Scan the appropriate Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect bar code below. Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect Bluetooth HID Japanese Keyboard Connect 2. Set your personal computer, laptop or tablet so it searches for other Bluetooth devices. (Refer to your device’s User’s Guide for pairing instructions.) 3. Select the scanner name on your device. Some devices will automatically pair with the scanner. If your device pairs automatically with the scanner, it displays a successful pairing message and you do not need to continue to the next step. 4. If your device does not automatically pair with the scanner, a PIN is displayed. This PIN must be scanned within 60 seconds. Quickly scan Bluetooth PIN Code below, then scan the numeric bar code(s) for the PIN code from the chart below, then scan Save. Bluetooth PIN Code 0 1 2 3 70 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 4 5 6 7 8 9 Save Virtual Keyboard Once your scanner has been connected directly to an iPad, smart phone, or laptop, you can toggle the virtual keyboard on your device with a quick double pull of the scanner trigger. Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect If your scanner has been connected directly to an iPad, smart phone, or laptop using Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect (page 70), you must disconnect it in order to once again communicate with the base or Access Point. Scan the Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect bar code to unlink the scanner from the currently linked host. Scan the linking bar code on the base or Access Point to relink the scanner. Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 71 Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/Laptops Scanning the Non-Base BT Connection bar code below unlinks your scanner and puts it into a discoverable state. Once the scanner searches for and connects with a Bluetooth host, the scanner stores the connection to the host device address and switches virtual COM ports. This allows the scanner to automatically relink to the host if the connection is lost. Non-Base BT Connection PDAs/Mobility Systems Devices You may also use the scanner with a PDA or a Honeywell Mobility Systems device. Scan the bar code below and follow the instructions supplied with your Bluetooth device to locate the scanner, and connect with it. BT Connection - PDA/Mobility Systems Device Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code Some devices require a PIN code as part of the Bluetooth security features. Your scanner’s default PIN is 1234, which you may need to enter the first time you connect to your PDA or PC. The PIN code must be between 1 and 16 characters. To change the PIN, scan the bar code below and then scan the appropriate numeric bar codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Bluetooth PIN Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity The settings described below can help you customize the relinking behavior of the cordless area-imaging system to obtain the best compromise between convenience and low interference. Note: ISM band refers to the 2.4 to 2.48 GHz frequency band used by wireless networks, cordless phones, and Bluetooth. 72 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Auto Reconnect Mode Auto Reconnect controls whether or not the scanner automatically begins the relink process when a loss of connection is detected. When the Auto Reconnect On bar code is scanned, the scanner begins the relink process immediately, without user intervention. Default = Auto Reconnect On. * Auto Reconnect On Auto Reconnect Off Note: If you are connecting to a Bluetooth Interface Module, set Auto Reconnect to Off. The table below shows the results of the Auto Reconnect On and Off settings: Event Auto Reconnect On Auto Reconnect Off Scanner out of range Relink occurs automatically. If maximum number of link attempts is unsuccessful, then the scanner must be relinked by either pulling the trigger, placing the scanner in the base, or scanning the Access Point linking bar code. (See Maximum Link Attempts on page 73.) The scanner is relinked by pulling the trigger, or scanning the Access Point linking bar code. Base or Access point reset (firmware upgrade or power cycle) Scanner behaves as if out of range. No attempt to relink made while base or Access Point is powered off. Trigger must be pulled to initiate relinking. Scanner power down due to Power Time-Out Timer setting Trigger must be pulled, Access Point linking bar code must be scanned, or the scanner must be placed in the base unit to relink. (Note: scanner relinks on power up, but powers on due to one of the above actions.) Scanner reset due to firmware upgrade Relink occurs automatically. Scanner reset due to battery change Relink occurs automatically. Scanner placed in different base unit Relink to new base occurs automatically. Maximum Link Attempts The Maximum Link Attempts setting controls the number of times the scanner tries to form a connection with a base or an Access Point. During the connection setup process, the scanner transmits in order to search for and connect to a base Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 73 or an Access Point. In order to prevent continuous transmissions that could interfere with other users of the ISM band, the number of attempts to connect is limited by this setting. After the maximum number of attempts is reached, the scanner will not attempt to reconnect to a base or an Access Point. Pressing the trigger, scanning an Access Point linking bar code, or placing the scanner in the cradle resets the attempt count and the scanner will again try to link. Scan the Maximum Link Attempts bar code, then scan the number of attempts for the setting (from 0-100) from theProgramming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0. Maximum Link Attempts Note: When Auto Reconnect Mode is On, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the scanner to try to link until the Power Time-Out Timer setting expires. When Auto Reconnect Mode is Off, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the scanner to only attempt linking one time after a trigger pull. Relink Time-Out Relink Time-Out controls the idle time between relink attempts. An attempt to link a scanner to a base or an Access Point typically lasts up to 5 seconds. This is the time when the scanner is actually attempting a contact . Relink Time-Out controls the amount of time, in seconds, that elapses between the end of one connection attempt and the start of the next. Note: The length of time for an attempt depends on the number of scanners connected to a base unit or Access Point. An extra 7 seconds may be required when a connection is successful. Scan the Relink Time-Out bar code, then scan the number of seconds for the setting (from 1-100) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 3 seconds. Relink Time-Out 74 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples Default values When the scanner goes out of range, the scanner repeatedly attempts to connect to the base unit or Access Point. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Example: Maximum Link Attempts set to 15 Other values at default setting When the scanner goes out of range, 15 attempts are made to link to the base unit or Access Point. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to connect to the base or Access Point, but retains any bar codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 0 Maximum Link Attempts set to 15 Other values at default setting When the scanner goes out of range, no action is taken to relink. When the trigger is pulled, 15 attempts are made to link to the base or Access Point. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to connect to the base or Access Point, but retains any bar codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Refer to Auto Reconnect Mode, page 73, to review other events that can start the relink process. Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 1 Maximum Link Attempts set to 0 Relink Time-Out set to 10 Scanner Power Time-Out Timer set to 1800 Note: See Scanner Power Time-Out Timer on page 57. The scanner attempts to connect to the base or Access Point every 15 seconds, measured from one attempt start to the next attempt start. After one half hour, the scanner powers off. Host Acknowledgment Some applications require that the host terminal (or server) validate incoming bar code data (database look-up) and provide acknowledgment to the scanner whether or not to proceed. In Host ACK Mode, the scanner waits for this acknowledgment after each scan. Visual and audible acknowledgments provide valuable Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 75 feedback to the scan operator. The Host ACK functionality is controlled via a number of pre-defined escape commands that are sent to the scanner to make it behave in different ways. Note: System performance degrades when using Host ACK at rates lower than 9600 baud. The following criteria must be met for the Host ACK to work correctly: • The cordless system must be configured for Host Port RS232 (terminal ID = 000) or USB COM Emulation (terminal ID = 130). • RTS/CTS is defaulted off. You must enable it if the host system requires it. • Host ACK must be set to On (page 77). • A comma must be used as a terminator. • The host terminal software must be capable of interpreting the bar code data, make decisions based on the data content, and send out appropriate escape commands to the scanner. Escape commands are addressed to the scanner via “Application Work Groups.” Once a command is sent, all scanners in a group respond to that command. Because of this, it is recommended that each scanner is assigned to its own group in Host ACK mode. The commands to which the scanner responds are listed on page 77. The [ESC] is a 1B in hex. A typical command string is y [ESC] x, where “y” is the application work group number, “[ESC] x” is the escape command, and the comma is the terminator, which is required. (When “y” is not specified, the command is sent to the default Application Work Group 0.) Example: Commands may be strung together to create custom response sequences. An example of a command string is listed below. [ESC]4,[ESC]5,[ESC]6, The above example will make a scanner that is in application work group zero beep low, then medium, then high. Example: A good read beep is required for any item on file, but a razz or error tone is required if the item is not on file. In this case, [ESC]7, is sent from the host to the scanner for an on-file product [ESC]8,[ESC]8, is sent from the host to the scanner for a not-on-file product When a bar code is scanned, the scanner enters a timeout period until either the host ACK sequence is received, or the timeout expires (in 10 seconds, by default). Once Host ACK is enabled, the system works as follows when a bar code is scanned: • 76 The scanner reads the code and sends data to the base or Access Point to transmit to the host system. No audible or visual indication is emitted until the scanner receives an escape command. The scanner read illumination goes out when there’s a successful read. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com • Scanner operation is suspended until 1) a valid escape string is received from the host system or 2) the scanner times out. • Once condition 1 or 2 above has been met, the scanner is ready to scan again, and the process repeats. A time-out occurs if the scanner does not receive a valid escape command within 10 seconds. A time-out is indicated by an error tone. If a time-out occurs, the operator should check the host system to understand why a response to the scanner was not received. Host ACK On/Off Host ACK On * Host ACK Off Host ACK Timeout You can set a timeout for the length of time the scanner waits for a valid escape command when using Host Acknowledgment Mode. Set the length (in seconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-90 seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 10. Host ACK Timeout Host ACK Responses Command Action [ESC] a, Double beeps to indicate a successful menu change was made. [ESC] b, Razz or error tone to indicate a menu change was unsuccessful. [ESC] 1, The green LED illuminates for 135 milliseconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 2, The green LED illuminates for 2 seconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 3, The green LED illuminates for 5 seconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 4, Emits a beep at a low pitch. [ESC] 5, Emits a beep at a medium pitch. [ESC] 6, Emits a beep at a high pitch. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 77 78 Command Action [ESC] 7, Beeps to indicate a successful decode and communication to host. [ESC] 8,[ESC] 8, Razz or error tone to indicate a decode/communication to host was unsuccessful. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 4 CORDLESS SYSTEM OPERATION: XENON 1902G-BF Note: This chapter applies only to Xenon 1902g-BF cordless scanning systems. It does not apply to corded scanners, Xenon 1902g/1912, or Granit 1911i/1981i scanners. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41 for other Xenon and Granit cordless scanning systems. How the CCB01-010BT-BF Cordless Charge Base Works A cordless charge base provides the link between the cordless scanner and the host system. The base contains an interface assembly and an RF communication module. The RF communication module performs the data exchange between the cordless scanner and the interface assembly. The control assembly coordinates the central interface activities including: transmitting/receiving commands and data to/from the host system, performing software activities (parameter menuing, visual indicator support, power-on diagnostics), and data translation required for the host system. The cordless charge base is also a scanner’s instant charge pack charger. Refer to Charge Information, page 83, for additional information. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 79 Link the Scanner to a Charge Base Xenon Scanner CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base Page Button and Base LEDs When the base is connected and powered up, put the scanner in the base to establish a link. The green LED on the base flashes to indicate the scanner’s instant charge pack is charging. Note: The scanner’s instant charge pack must be charged to establish a link with the base. If the scanner and base have previously been linked, you do not receive any feedback. If this is the first time that the scanner and base are linked, both devices emit a short chirp when their radios link. At this point, that one scanner is linked to one base. The linking sound can be turned on or off. See Linking Sound on page 91. To determine if your scanner has linked to the base correctly, scan one of the sample bar codes beginning on page 339. If the scanner provides a single good read beep and the green LED lights, the scanner has successfully linked to the base. If you receive an error tone and the red LED lights, the scanner has not linked to the base. Refer to page 325 for troubleshooting information. Replace a Linked Scanner If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base. The locked link will be overridden, the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked. Override Locked Scanner (Single Scanner) 80 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Communication Between the Cordless System and the Host The cordless scanner provides immediate feedback in the form of a “good read” indication with a green LED on the scanner and an audible beep. This indicates that the bar code has been scanned correctly and the base has acknowledged receiving the data. This is possible since the cordless system provides two-way communication between the scanner and the base. When data is scanned, the data is sent to the host system via the base. The cordless scanner recognizes data acknowledgment (ACK) from the base. If it cannot be determined that the data has been properly sent to the base, the scanner issues an error indication. You must then check to see if the scanned data was received by the host system. 1 2 1. Scanner reads code and gets ACK from base. 2. Base sends data to host. Program the Scanner and Base When using the scanner and charge base together as a system, menu parameters and configuration settings are stored in the charge base. Therefore, when programming any menu configuration settings, the scanner must be linked to the charge base. Note: This only applies when the scanner is linked to a charge base. If the scanner is in a non-base mode, configuration settings are stored in the scanner. RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation The cordless system uses a two-way, low energy, Bluetooth® radio to transmit and receive data between the scanner and the base. It provides single-point to singlepoint communication. The radio operates using a license free ISM band, which sends relatively small data packets at a fast data rate over a radio signal with randomly changing frequencies, makes the cordless system highly responsive to a wide variety of data collection applications and resistant to noisy RF environments. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 81 The CCB01-010BT-BF (Bluetooth Class 2) provides a communication range of 33 feet (10m) between the scanner and base, depending on the environment. See Flexible Power Management, page 97, for information about controlling this range. System Conditions The components of the cordless system interact in specific ways as you associate a scanner to a base, as you move a scanner out of range and bring a scanner back in range. The following information explains the cordless system operating conditions. Link Process Once a scanner is placed into a cordless charge base, the scanner’s instant charge pack status is checked, and software automatically detects the scanner and links it to the base depending on the selected link mode. Scanner Is Out of Range The cordless scanner is in communication with its base, even when it is not transmitting bar code data. Whenever the scanner can’t communicate with the base for a few seconds, it is out of range. If the scanner is out of range and you scan a bar code, the scanner issues an error tone indicating no communication with the base. A cordless charge base can also sound an alarm. Refer to Out-of-Range Alarm, page 95. Scanner Is Moved Back Into Range The scanner relinks if the scanner or the base have been reset, or the scanner comes back into range. If the scanner relinks, you will hear a single chirp when the relinking process (uploading of the parameter table) is complete. Refer to Out-ofRange Alarm on page 95 for further information. Out of Range and Back into Range with Batch Mode On The scanner may store a number of symbols (approximately 500 U.P.C. symbols; others may vary) when it is out of range and then send them to the base when back in range (see Batch Mode on page 98). You will not hear a communication error tone in this mode, but you will hear a short buzz when you pull the trigger if the radio communication is not working. Once the radio connection is made, the scanner produces a series of beeps while the data is being transferred to the base. 82 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com About the Instant Charge Pack Power is supplied to the cordless scanner by a rechargeable instant charge pack that is integrated in the scanner handle. The instant charge pack must be charged before initial use. When the scanner is not in use, return it to the base. The model CCB01-010BT-BF base is designed for use with the Honeywell model Xenon 1902g-BF scanner. Charge Information The instant charge pack is designed to charge while the scanner is positioned in the cordless base unit. Refer to Base, page 86, for an interpretation of the Charge Status indicators. Refer to Charge Only Mode (page 93) if you need to charge a scanner without linking it to the base. Place the scanner in the base that is connected to an appropriate power supply. Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type power supply with output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A. Caution: The Xenon 1902g-BF scanner can only be charged by CCB01010BT-BF base. Use of any non-Honeywell power supply may result in damage not covered by the warranty. Note: If you are powering the base through the interface cable (for example, a USB cable) and not using an external power supply plugged into the aux port, the current available for charging is reduced and charge times are increased. Charge times can be improved by connecting the interface cable to a BC 1.2 compliant USB charge port. Charging via the power supply is fastest. The AC adapter should be plugged into the connector in the bottom of the base. Using the interface cable power link is not recommended and will significantly increase charge times. Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning The scanner contains LEDs on the rear of the unit that indicate linking status, decoding state, and instant charge pack condition. The base has LEDs on the top of the unit that indicate its power up, communication, and instant charge pack condition. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 83 Scanner Scanner Communication and Scanning The following feedback is provided by the scanner and indicates communication and scanning status. LED Indication Beeper Indication Cause Red Flash None Charge pack low Green Flash 1 beep Successful communication or linking Red, blinking Razz or error tone Failed communication Green Flash 2 beeps Successful menu change Red, blinking Razz or error tone Unsuccessful menu change Normal Operation Menu Operation Scanner Charge Pack Status The following charge status feedback is provided by the scanner when the scanner is out of the base and has been idle for 5 seconds. Scanner LED Scanner Beep Charge Level Approximate Expected Scans* Yellow 3 sets of flashes 2 short beeps per flash 30% 100 Red 3 sets of flashes 2 short beeps per flash 10% 50 * The number of scans was measured with a clearly printed UPC code in good light. The approximate number of scans varies with changes in label quality, symbology, and environmental factors. Low Power Alerts Low power alerts allow you to customize the scanner LEDs to flash in different patterns when the scanner charge level is low. Use the bar codes that follow to customize the settings for the power range being configured, the number of flashes per alert, the interval between flashes, the number of alerts, and the interval between alerts. The beeper can also be set to silent, or to sound with the flash patterns. 84 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Low Power Alert Range Set the power range that will trigger a low power alert. Default = 10-30%. *Low Power Alert 10-30% Low Power Alert 10-50% Low Power Alert Flash Number You can program the scanner’s LEDs to flash up to 9 times for the low power alert. If the Low Power Alert Beep (page 86) is on, a double beep will sound with each flash. To set the number of low power flashes, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 3 flashes. Low Power Alert Flash Number Interval Between Flashes Set the length of time, in seconds, between the LED flashes for a low power alert. To set the interval, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 2 seconds between flashes. Interval Between Flashes Low Power Alert Repeat Set how many times you want the low power flash pattern (flashes and intervals) to repeat. To set the number, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-5) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1. Low Power Alert Repeat Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 85 Interval Between Alerts If you have set the Low Power Alert Repeat (page 85) to more than 1, you can set the length of time, in seconds, between the low power alerts. To set this interval, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (10-120) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 10 seconds between alerts. Interval Between Alerts Low Power Alert Beep If you do not want the beeper to sound for a low power alert, scan the Low Power Alert Beep Off bar code. Any low power alert settings will still flash the scanner LEDs, whether or not the beeper sounds. Default = Low Power Alert Beep On. Low Power Alert Beep Off *Low Power Alert Beep On Base The base contains colored LEDs that indicate the status of the unit, verifies its communication with the host system, and indicates scanner instant charge pack condition. Base Communication and Scanning The following feedback is provided by the base and indicates communication and scanning status. Red LED - Host Communication 86 Red LED Communication Condition Off USB suspend On continuously Host communication available Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Red LED - Host Communication Communication Condition Red LED Short blinks in multiple pulses. Occurs while transferring data to/from the RF module or the host port. Receiving/sending data Base Charge Status When charging, the base indicates the progress while the scanner resides in the base. Base Button/LED Charge Level Approximate Expected Scans* Green on 100% 450 Green slow blink 50-99% 200 Green fast blink 30-50% 100 Yellow fast blink 0-30% Charging - do not scan * The number of scans was measured with a clearly printed UPC code in good light. The approximate number of scans varies with changes in label quality, symbology, and environmental factors. Base Power Communication Indicator To display the power indicator on a base, scan the Base Power Communication Indicator On bar code. To turn off the power indicator, scan the Off bar code. Default = On. * Base Power Communication Indicator On Base Power Communication Indicator Off Reset Scanner Scanning this bar code reboots the scanner and causes it to relink with the base. Reset Scanner Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 87 Base Charge Modes When the base has both an external power supply (plugged into the auxiliary power port) and a host interface cable, it will draw its power from the external power supply. When the base does not have an external power supply, it draws its power from the interface cable. However, the scanner instant charge pack charges more slowly from a host interface cable than if auxiliary power were available. Using the following selections, you can specify whether the scanner instant charge pack is charged from power supplied via the host interface cable. When Base Charge Off is selected, the scanner instant charge pack does not charge when the scanner is in the base cradle. When External or Interface Cable Power is selected, the scanner instant charge pack charges from the base’s external power supply, if there is one. If there is no external power supply to the base, the scanner instant charge pack charges from the interface cable. When External Power Only is selected, the scanner instant charge pack only charges from the base’s external power supply. If there is no external power supply, the scanner instant charge pack does not charge. Default = External or Interface Cable Power. Base Charge Off External or Interface Cable Power External Power Only Page Button with Scanner Out of the Base 88 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com When the scanner is out of the base, press the page button on the base to make the associated scanner start beeping (3 short and 1 long beep). If you pull the trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the base a second time, the scanner stops beeping. See Paging on page 90 for further information about Page Button settings. Page Button with Scanner in the Base When the scanner is in the base, press the page button on the base to begin Streaming Presentation Mode. The scanner acts as a presentation scanner for 10 seconds. If a bar code is scanned before the 10 second timeout is reached, the timer starts over. Lift the scanner from the base to return to manual triggering. To change the timeout from 10 seconds see Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout on page 89. Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout Set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and searching for bar codes when using Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. Set the length for the timeout by scanning one of the bar codes below. Default = 10,000 ms (10 seconds). *10 Second Timeout 30 Second Timeout 1 Minute Timeout 2 Minute Timeout 3 Minute Timeout See Paging, below, for further information about Page Button settings. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 89 Scan While in Base Cradle If you want to be able to scan bar codes while the scanner is in the base cradle, scan the Scan in Cradle On bar code below. If you want to only allow scanning when the scanner is out of the base cradle, scan Scan in Cradle Off. If you want the scanner to shut down when in the base cradle, scan Shut Down Scanner in Cradle. Default = Scan in Cradle On. Scan in Cradle Off * Scan in Cradle On Shut Down Scanner in Cradle Paging Page Mode When the scanner is out of the base, the paging button on the base pages the scanner associated with that base. If you want to disable the paging button, scan the Page Mode Off bar code, below. When Page Mode is off, the base will no longer page the scanner when the button is pressed and no scanner is in the base. The red LED on the base remains lit to indicate that Page Mode is off. (This light will go out when the button is pressed, then back on when it’s released.) Default = Page Mode On. * Page Mode On Page Mode Off 90 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Page Pitch When the scanner is out of the base and you press the Page button, the scanner associated with that base begins beeping. You can set the pitch of the paging beep for the scanner by scanning one of the following bar codes. Default = Low. * Low (1000 Hz) Medium (3250 Hz) High (4200 Hz) Linking Sound Under normal operations, the scanner clicks when linking to a base. If you want to silence this sound, scan the Silent Linking bar code below. To return to the default clicking sound, scan Linking Sound. Default = Linking Sound. * Linking Sound Silent Linking Error Indicators Beeper Pitch - Base Error The base can be configured to beep at a particular pitch when an error occurs, such as transmission problems to a host system. The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the error tone the base emits when there is an error. Default = Low. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 91 * Razz (250 Hz) Medium (3250 Hz) High (4200 Hz) Number of Beeps - Base Error The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the base for an error condition can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this option to have five error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in response to an error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1. Number of Base Error Beeps/LED Flashes Scanner Report Scan the bar code below to generate a report for the connected scanner. The report indicates the port, scanner name, and address. To assign a name to your scanner, refer to Menu Command Syntax, page 259. Scanner Report Scanner Address Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the scanner you are using. Scanner Address 92 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Base Address Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the base you are using. Base Address Scanner Modes Charge Only Mode There may be times when you want to charge your scanner, but not link to the base. In order to program the base for Charge Only Mode, you must link the scanner to it. Once the scanner is linked to the base, scan the Charge Only Mode bar code. Any subsequent scanners placed in that base will charge without linking to it. The scanner used to program the base remains linked to the base. To unlink this scanner, scan Unlink Scanner on page 94. Charge Only Mode Note: When in Charge Only Mode, the scanner periodically wakes up and beeps. See Power Up Beeper on page 111 to change this setting. Charge and Link Mode If you want to charge a scanner and link to the base, use Charge and Link Mode. If the base is programmed for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it first in order to program it for Charge and Link Mode. Scan the linking bar code on the base to link the scanner, then scan Charge and Link Mode. Default = Charge and Link Mode. * Charge and Link Mode Linked Modes Locked Link Mode and Open Link Mode are the link modes that accommodate different applications. Scan the appropriate bar codes included in the Open Link and Locked Link Mode explanations that follow to switch from one mode to another. Default = Open Link Mode. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 93 Locked Link Mode - Single Scanner If you link a scanner to a base using the Locked Link Mode, other scanners are blocked from being linked if they are inadvertently placed into the base. If you do place a different scanner into a base, it will charge the scanner, but the scanner will not be linked. Locked Link Mode (Single Scanner) To use a different scanner, you need to unlink the original scanner by scanning the Unlink Scanner bar code. (See Scanner Modes, page 93.) Open Link Mode - Single Scanner When newly shipped or defaulted to factory settings, a scanner is not linked to a base. A link is established when the scanner is placed into a base. When in Open Link Mode, a new link is established when a new scanner is placed in the base. Each time a scanner is placed into a base, the scanner becomes linked to the base and the old scanner is unlinked. * Open Link Mode (Single Scanner) Unlink the Scanner If a base has a scanner linked to it, that scanner must be unlinked before a new scanner can be linked. Once the previous scanner is unlinked, it will no longer communicate with the base. To unlink the scanner from a base, scan the Unlink Scanner bar code below. Unlink Scanner 94 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Override Locked Scanner If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base. The locked link is overridden, the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base is removed, and the new scanner is linked to the base. Override Locked Scanner (Single Scanner) Out-of-Range Alarm If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base, when the base connects to another scanner, or when the alarm duration expires. To activate the alarm options for the scanner or the base and to set the alarm duration, scan the appropriate bar code below and then set the time-out duration (from 0-3000 seconds) by scanning digits on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Base Alarm Duration Scanner Alarm Duration Note: If you are out of range when you scan a bar code, you will receive an error tone even if you do not have the alarm set. You receive the error tone since the data could not be communicated to the base or the host. Alarm Sound Type You may change the alarm type for the scanner or a base by scanning the appropriate bar code below and then scanning a digit (0-7) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0. The sounds are as follows: Setting Sound 0 3 long beeps, medium pitch 1 3 long beeps, high pitch 2 4 short beeps, medium pitch Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 95 Setting Sound 3 4 short beeps, high pitch 4 single chirps, medium pitch 5 2 chirps, then 1 chirp, medium pitch 6 single chirps, high pitch 7 2 chirps, then 1 chirp, high pitch Base Alarm Type Scanner Alarm Type Scanner Power Time-Out Timer When there is no activity within a specified time period, the scanner enters low power mode. Scan the appropriate scanner power time-out bar code to change the time-out duration (in seconds). Note: Scanning zero (0) is the equivalent of setting no time-out. If there are no trigger pulls during the timer interval, the scanner goes into power down mode. Whenever the trigger is enabled, the timer is reset. If the scanner is placed in the base and the instant charge pack is in the process of being charged, the scanner will not go into power down mode. Default = 400 seconds. 96 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 0 seconds 200 seconds * 400 seconds 900 seconds 3600 seconds 7200 seconds Note: When the scanner is in power down mode, pull the trigger to power the unit back up. There will be a set of power up beeps and a delay of up to a few seconds for the radio to join. The scanner will then be ready to use. Flexible Power Management If you are experiencing network performance issues, and suspect the scanner is interfering with other devices, you can turn down the power output of the scanner. This reduces the range between the scanner and a base as shown in the following illustration: 802.11 LAN Scanner Red r uced Powe Full Power Scan one of the bar codes below to set the scanner’s power output to Full Power (100%), Medium High Power (88%), Medium Power (50%), or Low Power (1%). Default = High Power. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 97 Full Power * Medium High Power Medium Power Low Power Batch Mode Batch mode is used to store bar code data when a scanner is out of range of its base, or when performing inventory. The data is transmitted to the base once the scanner is back in range or when the records are manually transmitted. Automatic Batch Mode stores bar code data when the scanner is out of range of the base. The data is automatically transmitted to the base once the scanner is back in range. When the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes again, the scanner must be moved back into range of the base so data can be transmitted. Inventory Batch Mode stores bar code data, whether or not you are in range of the base. To transmit the stored data to the base, either place the scanner in the base, or scan Transmit Inventory Records (page 103). When the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes again, the data must be transmitted to the base. Once the data is transmitted, it is cleared in the scanner. Persistent Batch Mode is the same as Inventory Batch Mode, except that once the data is transmitted to the base, it is retained in the scanner. If you want to transmit more than once, you can do so using this mode. In order to clear the scanner’s buffer, you must scan Clear All Codes (see page 103). Default = Batch Mode Off. * Batch Mode Off 98 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Automatic Batch Mode Inventory Batch Mode Persistent Batch Mode Batch Mode Beep When scanning in Inventory Batch Mode (page 99), the scanner beeps every time a bar code is scanned. When Batch Mode Beep is On, you will also hear a click when each bar code is sent to the host. If you do not want to hear these clicks, scan Batch Mode Beep Off. Default = Batch Mode Beep On. Batch Mode Beep Off * Batch Mode Beep On Batch Mode Storage When a scanner is storing data during a Batch Mode process, you can select whether the data is stored in Flash memory or in RAM. Flash Storage: The scanner writes any untransmitted data to flash memory prior to powering down. The data will still be there when the scanner powers back up. However, the scanner will power down, even with untransmitted data, if it reaches a power down timeout or if the instant charge pack power is very low. RAM Storage: The scanner will not power down while it contains data that has not been transmitted to the base, even if it reaches a power down timeout. However, if the scanner charge pack runs out of power, it will power down and the data will be lost. Default = Flash Storage. * Flash Storage Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 99 RAM Storage Batch Mode Quantity When in Batch Mode, you may wish to transmit the number of multiple bar codes scanned, rather than a single bar code multiple times. For example, if you scan three bar codes called XYZ with Batch Mode Quantity Off, when you transmit your data it will appear as XYZ three times. Using Batch Mode Quantity On and the Quantity Codes (page 101), you could output your data as “XYZ, 00003” instead. Note: If you wish to format your output, for example, place a CR or tab between the bar code data and the quantity, refer to Data Format beginning on page 157. Default = Batch Mode Quantity Off. * Batch Mode Quantity Off Batch Mode Quantity On Enter Quantities Quantity Codes (page 101) allow you to enter a quantity for the last item scanned, up to 9999 (default = 1). Quantity digits are shifted from right to left, so if a 5th digit is scanned, the 1st digit scanned is discarded and the 2nd, 3rd and 4th digits are moved to the left to accommodate the new digit. For example, if the Quantity 5 bar code is scanned after the quantity has been set to 1234, then the 1 is dropped, the quantity will be 2345. Example: Add a quantity of 5 for the last item scanned. 1. Scan the item's bar code. 2. Scan the quantity 5 bar code. Example: Add a quantity of 1,500 for the last item scanned. 1. Scan the item's bar code. 2. Scan the quantity 1 bar code. 3. Scan the quantity 5 bar code. 4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code. 100 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 5. Scan the quantity 0 bar code. Example: Change a quantity of 103 to 10. To correct an incorrect quantity, scan the quantity 0 bar code to replace the incorrect digits, then scan the correct quantity bar codes. 1. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 1030. 2. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0300. 3. Scan the quantity 1 bar code to change the quantity to 3001. 4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0010. Default = 1. Quantity Codes 0 *1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 101 Quantity Codes (Continued) 8 9 Batch Mode Output Order When batch data is transmitted, select whether you want that data sent as FIFO (first-in first-out), or LIFO (last-in first-out). Default = Batch Mode FIFO. * Batch Mode FIFO Batch Mode LIFO Total Records If you wish to output the total number of bar codes scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Total Records. Total Records Delete Last Code If you want to delete the last bar code scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Delete Last Code. Delete Last Code 102 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Clear All Codes If you want to clear the scanner’s buffer of all data accumulated in Batch Mode, scan Clear All Codes. Clear All Codes Transmit Records to Host If you are operating in Inventory Batch Mode (see Inventory Batch Mode on page 99), you must scan the following bar code to transmit all the stored data to the host system. Transmit Inventory Records Batch Mode Transmit Delay Sometimes when accumulated scans are sent to the host system, the transmission of those scans is too fast for the application to process. To program a transmit delay between accumulated scans, scan one of the following delays. Default = Off. Note: In most cases, a short (250 ms (milliseconds)) delay is ideal, however, longer delays may be programmed. Contact Technical Support (page xvii) for additional information. * Batch Mode Transmit Delay Off (No Delay) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Short (250 ms) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Medium (500 ms) Batch Mode Transmit Delay Long (1000 ms) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 103 Scanner Name You may assign a name to each scanner you are using for identification purposes. The default name is in the format “ScannerName_Model_SN_XXXXXXXXXX” Perform the rename operation using either the bar codes on page 105, or by sending the serial command :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. where ScannerName is the current name of the scanner, and NewName is the new name for the scanner. To rename scanners with sequential, numeric names, scan the bar codes below. Scan the Reset code after each name change and wait for the scanner to relink to the base before scanning a bar code to rename the next scanner. 0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 0006 0007 Reset 104 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com You may also scan the Scanner Name bar code below and scan a number for the scanner name. For example, if you wanted to name the linked scanner “312,” you would scan the bar code below, scan the 3, 1, and 2 bar codes on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Scan the Reset bar code and wait for the scanner to relink to the base. Scanner Name Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code Some devices require a PIN code as part of the Bluetooth security features. Your scanner’s default PIN is 1234, which you may need to enter the first time you connect to your PC. The PIN code must be between 1 and 16 characters. To change the PIN, scan the bar code below and then scan the appropriate numeric bar codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Bluetooth PIN Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity The settings described below can help you customize the relinking behavior of the cordless area-imaging system to obtain the best compromise between convenience and low interference. Note: ISM band refers to the 2.4 to 2.48 GHz frequency band used by wireless networks, cordless phones, and Bluetooth. Auto Reconnect Mode Auto Reconnect controls whether or not the scanner automatically begins the relink process when a loss of connection is detected. When the Auto Reconnect On bar code is scanned, the scanner begins the relink process immediately, without user intervention. Default = Auto Reconnect On. * Auto Reconnect On Auto Reconnect Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 105 The table below shows the results of the Auto Reconnect On and Off settings: Event Auto Reconnect On Auto Reconnect Off Scanner out of range Relink occurs automatically. If maximum number of link attempts is unsuccessful, then the scanner must be relinked by either pulling the trigger or placing the scanner in the base. (See Maximum Link Attempts on page 106.) The scanner is relinked by pulling the trigger. Base reset (firmware upgrade or power cycle) Scanner behaves as if out of range. No attempt to relink made while base is powered off. Trigger must be pulled to initiate relinking. Scanner power down due to Power Time-Out Timer setting Trigger must be pulled or the scanner must be placed in the base unit to relink. (Note: scanner relinks on power up, but powers on due to one of the above actions.) Scanner reset due to firmware upgrade Relink occurs automatically. Scanner reset due to instant charge pack change Relink occurs automatically. Scanner placed in different base unit Relink to new base occurs automatically. Maximum Link Attempts The Maximum Link Attempts setting controls the number of times the scanner tries to form a connection with a base. During the connection setup process, the scanner transmits in order to search for and connect to a base. In order to prevent continuous transmissions that could interfere with other users of the ISM band, the number of attempts to connect is limited by this setting. After the maximum number of attempts is reached, the scanner will not attempt to reconnect to a base. Pressing the trigger or placing the scanner in the base resets the counter and the scanner will again try to link. Scan the Maximum Link Attempts bar code, then scan the number of attempts for the setting (from 0-100) from theProgramming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 4. Maximum Link Attempts Note: When Auto Reconnect Mode is On, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the scanner to try to link until the Power Time-Out Timer setting expires. When Auto Reconnect Mode is Off, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the scanner to only attempt linking one time after a trigger pull. 106 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Relink Time-Out Relink Time-Out controls the idle time between relink attempts. An attempt to link a scanner to a base typically lasts up to 5 seconds. This is the time when the scanner is actually attempting a contact. Relink Time-Out controls the amount of time, in seconds, that elapses between the end of one connection attempt and the start of the next. Scan the Relink Time-Out bar code, then scan the number of seconds for the setting (from 1-100) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 2 seconds. Relink Time-Out Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples Default values When the scanner goes out of range, the scanner repeatedly attempts to connect to the base. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Example: Maximum Link Attempts set to 15 Other values at default setting When the scanner goes out of range, 15 attempts are made to link to the base. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to connect to the base, but retains any bar codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 0 Maximum Link Attempts set to 15 Other values at default setting When the scanner goes out of range, no action is taken to relink. When the trigger is pulled, 15 attempts are made to link to the base. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to connect to the Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 107 base, but retains any bar codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Refer to Auto Reconnect Mode, page 105, to review other events that can start the relink process. Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 1 Maximum Link Attempts set to 0 Relink Time-Out set to 10 Scanner Power Time-Out Timer set to 1800 Note: See Scanner Power Time-Out Timer on page 96. The scanner attempts to connect to the base every 15 seconds, measured from one attempt start to the next attempt start. After one half hour, the scanner powers off. Host Acknowledgment Some applications require that the host terminal (or server) validate incoming bar code data (database look-up) and provide acknowledgment to the scanner whether or not to proceed. In Host ACK Mode, the scanner waits for this acknowledgment after each scan. Visual and audible acknowledgments provide valuable feedback to the scan operator. The Host ACK functionality is controlled via a number of pre-defined escape commands that are sent to the scanner to make it behave in different ways. Note: System performance degrades when using Host ACK at rates lower than 9600 baud. The following criteria must be met for the Host ACK to work correctly: • The cordless system must be configured for Host Port RS232 (terminal ID = 000) or USB COM Emulation (terminal ID = 130). • RTS/CTS is defaulted off. You must enable it if the host system requires it. • Host ACK must be set to On (page 109). • A comma must be used as a terminator. • The host terminal software must be capable of interpreting the bar code data, make decisions based on the data content, and send out appropriate escape commands to the scanner. The commands to which the scanner responds are listed on page 110. The [ESC] is a 1B in hex. A typical command string is [ESC] x,. [ESC] x is the escape command, and the comma is the terminator, which is required. Example: Commands may be strung together to create custom response sequences. An example of a command string is listed below. [ESC]4,[ESC]5,[ESC]6, The above example will make a scanner beep low, then medium, then high. Example: A good read beep is required for any item on file, but a razz or error tone is required if the item is not on file. In this case, 108 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com [ESC]7, is sent from the host to the scanner for an on-file product [ESC]8,[ESC]8, is sent from the host to the scanner for a not-on-file product When a bar code is scanned, the scanner enters a timeout period until either the host ACK sequence is received, or the timeout expires (in 10 seconds, by default). Once Host ACK is enabled, the system works as follows when a bar code is scanned: • The scanner reads the code and sends data to the base to transmit to the host system. No audible or visual indication is emitted until the scanner receives an escape command. The scanner read illumination goes out when there’s a successful read. • Scanner operation is suspended until 1) a valid escape string is received from the host system or 2) the scanner times out. • Once condition 1 or 2 above has been met, the scanner is ready to scan again, and the process repeats. A time-out occurs if the scanner does not receive a valid escape command within 10 seconds. A time-out is indicated by an error tone. If a time-out occurs, the operator should check the host system to understand why a response to the scanner was not received. Host ACK On/Off Host ACK On * Host ACK Off Host ACK Timeout You can set a timeout for the length of time the scanner waits for a valid escape command when using Host Acknowledgment Mode. Set the length (in seconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-90 seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 10. Host ACK Timeout Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 109 Host ACK Responses 110 Command Action [ESC] a, Double beeps to indicate a successful menu change was made. [ESC] b, Razz or error tone to indicate a menu change was unsuccessful. [ESC] 1, The green LED illuminates for 135 milliseconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 2, The green LED illuminates for 2 seconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 3, The green LED illuminates for 5 seconds followed by a pause. [ESC] 4, Emits a beep at a low pitch. [ESC] 5, Emits a beep at a medium pitch. [ESC] 6, Emits a beep at a high pitch. [ESC] 7, Beeps to indicate a successful decode and communication to host. [ESC] 8,[ESC] 8, Razz or error tone to indicate a decode/communication to host was unsuccessful. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 5 INPUT/OUTPUT SETTINGS Power Up Beeper Note: This feature does not apply to the CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT base. The scanner can be programmed to beep when it’s powered up. If you are using a cordless system, the base can also be programmed to beep when it is powered up. Scan the Off bar code(s) if you don’t want a power up beep. Default = Power Up Beeper On - Scanner. Power Up Beeper Off Scanner * Power Up Beeper On Scanner Power Up Beeper Off Cordless Base Power Up Beeper On Cordless Base Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 111 Beep on BEL Character You may wish to force the scanner to beep upon a command sent from the host. If you scan the Beep on BEL On bar code below, the scanner will beep every time a BEL character is received from the host. Default = Beep on BEL Off. *Beep on BEL Off Beep on BEL On Trigger Click To hear an audible click every time the scanner trigger is pressed, scan the Trigger Click On bar code below. Scan the Trigger Click Off code if you don’t wish to hear the click. (This feature has no effect on serial or automatic triggering.) Default = Trigger Click Off. *Trigger Click Off Trigger Click On Good Read and Error Indicators Beeper – Good Read The beeper may be programmed On or Off in response to a good read. Turning this option off only turns off the beeper response to a good read indication. All error and menu beeps are still audible. Default = Beeper - Good Read On. Beeper - Good Read Off * Beeper - Good Read On 112 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Beeper Volume – Good Read The beeper volume codes modify the volume of the beep the scanner emits on a good read. Default = High for Granit/Xenon, Low for Xenon HC. * Low Medium * High Off Beeper Pitch – Good Read The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the beep the scanner emits on a good read. The Medium pitch differs for the Xenon and Granit scanners. Default = Medium. Low (1600 Hz) * Medium - Xenon (2700 Hz) * Medium - Granit (3200 Hz) High (4200 Hz) Vibrate – Good Read Note: Vibration settings apply only to Granit Devices. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 113 The scanner vibrates once when a bar code is successfully read, and twice when a programming bar code is successfully read. When a programming bar code is unsuccessful, the scanner emits one long vibration (2 times the Vibrate Duration length). Scan Vibrate - Good Read Off to keep the scanner from vibrating. Default = Vibrate - Good Read On. Vibrate- Good Read Off * Vibrate- Good Read On Vibrate Duration If you want to set the length for the good read vibration, scan the bar code below, then set the duration (from 100 - 2,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 300 ms. Vibrate Duration Beeper Pitch – Error The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the sound the scanner emits when there is a bad read or error. Default = Razz. * Razz (250 Hz) Medium (3250 Hz) High (4200 Hz) 114 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Beeper Duration – Good Read The beeper duration codes modify the length of the beep the scanner emits on a good read. Default = Normal. * Normal Beep Short Beep LED – Good Read The LED indicator can be programmed On or Off in response to a good read. Default = On. * LED - Good Read On LED - Good Read Off Number of Beeps – Good Read The number of beeps of a good read can be programmed from 1 - 9. The same number of beeps will be applied to the beeper and LED in response to a good read. For example, if you program this option to have five beeps, there will be five beeps and five LED flashes in response to a good read. The beeps and LED flashes are in sync with one another. To change the number of beeps, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1. Number of Good Read Beeps/LED Flashes Number of Beeps – Error The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the scanner for a bad read or error can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this option to have five error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in response Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 115 to an error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1. Number of Error Beeps/LED Flashes Beeper Volume Max Note: The Beeper Volume Max feature only applies to Granit products. Scan the following bar code to set all error and good read beeps to the maximum volume. This feature also sets the Beeper Pitch – Good Read to the highest level. Beeper Volume Max Good Read Delay This sets the minimum amount of time before the scanner can read another bar code. Default = 0 ms (No Delay). * No Delay Short Delay (500 ms) Medium Delay (1,000 ms) Long Delay (1,500 ms) 116 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com User-Specified Good Read Delay If you want to set your own length for the good read delay, scan the bar code below, then set the delay (from 0 - 30,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. User-Specified Good Read Delay Trigger Modes Manual Trigger When in manual trigger mode, the scanner scans until a bar code is read, or until the trigger is released. Two modes are available, Normal and Enhanced. Normal mode offers good scan speed and the longest working ranges (depth of field). Enhanced mode will give you the highest possible scan speed but slightly less range than Normal mode. Enhanced mode is best used when you require a very fast scan speed and don’t require a long working range. Default = Manual TriggerNormal. Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Enhanced Manual Trigger Mode. * Manual Trigger - Normal Manual Trigger Enhanced Trigger Toggle Note: Only the Xenon 1900 and 1902 support Trigger Toggle mode. Trigger Toggle mode lets you quickly hit the trigger 2 or 3 times to put the scanner into either imaging mode, cell phone read mode, or centering mode, then toggle back to scanning. So, like a double-click with a mouse, you can control what the next scanner’s action will be. For example, you could double-press the trigger to go into imaging mode, then the next trigger press takes the image. The scanner then reverts to scanning mode. Or you could triple-press the trigger to go into cell phone read mode, the customer presents the phone and it’s read, then the scanner reverts to scanning mode. Use the following codes to configure what action you would like the scanner to take when in Trigger Toggle mode. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 117 *Trigger Toggle Off Trigger Toggle - Image Capture Trigger Toggle - Cell Phone Read Trigger Toggle - Centering Trigger Number This sets the number of trigger preses required to activate the Trigger Toggle Mode. 2 Quick Triggers 3 Quick Triggers 4 Quick Triggers Trigger Timing This sets the timing of the trigger presses in order to qualify as a trigger toggle, rather than a regular trigger press. After scanning the Trigger Timing bar code, set the time-out duration (from 50-2,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 400ms. Trigger Timing 118 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Trigger Toggle Timeout This sets the length of time the scanner stays in trigger toggle mode before reverting to scan mode. After scanning the Trigger Toggle Timeout bar code, set the time-out duration (from 0 to 65 seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 5 seconds. Note: If this is set to 0, you must repeat the toggle sequence to return to the default scanning mode. For example, if 2 quick trigger presses puts the scanner into cell phone read mode and the Trigger Timing is 0, you would have to do 2 quick presses again to go back to the default scanning mode. Trigger Toggle Timeout Serial Trigger You can activate the scanner either by pressing the trigger, or using a serial trigger command (see Trigger Commands on page 262). You must be in a serial interface mode in order to use serial triggering. Refer to RS232 Serial Port (page 16) or USB Serial (page 19) for further information. When in serial mode, the scanner scans until a bar code has been read or until the deactivate command is sent. The scanner can also be set to turn itself off after a specified time has elapsed (see Read Time-Out, which follows). Read Time-Out Use this selection to set a time-out (in milliseconds) of the scanner’s trigger when using serial commands to trigger the scanner. Once the scanner has timed out, you can activate the scanner either by pressing the trigger or using a serial trigger command. After scanning the Read Time-Out bar code, set the time-out duration (from 0-300,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 30,000 ms. Read Time-Out Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 119 Presentation Mode Presentation Mode uses ambient light and scanner illumination to detect bar codes. When in Presentation Mode, the LEDs remain dim until a bar code is presented to the scanner, then the aimer turns on and the LEDs turn up to read the code. If the light level in the room is not high enough, Presentation Mode may not work properly Note: If you are using a cordless charge base in Presentation Mode, the battery will not charge unless the power supply is plugged into the base’s auxiliary power port. Scan the following bar code to program your scanner for Presentation Mode. Presentation Mode Presentation LED Behavior after Decode When a scanner is in presentation mode, the LED aimer dims 30 seconds after a bar code is decoded. If you wish to dim the LED aimer immediately after a bar code is decoded, scan the LEDs Off bar code, below. Default = LEDs On. * LEDs On LEDs Off Presentation Sensitivity Presentation Sensitivity is a numeric range that increases or decreases the scanner's reaction time to bar code presentation. To set the sensitivity, scan the Sensitivity bar code, then scan the degree of sensitivity (from 0-20) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. 0 is the most sensitive setting, and 20 is the least sensitive. Default = 1. Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support this setting. Sensitivity 120 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Presentation Centering Use Presentation Centering to narrow the scanner’s field of view when it is in the stand to make sure the scanner reads only those bar codes intended by the user. For instance, if multiple codes are placed closely together, Presentation Centering will insure that only the desired codes are read. Note: To adjust centering when the scanner is hand-held, see Centering (page 5-131). If a bar code is not touched by a predefined window, it will not be decoded or output by the scanner. If Presentation Centering is turned on by scanning Presentation Centering On, the scanner only reads codes that pass through the centering window you specify using the Top of Presentation Centering Window, Bottom of Presentation Centering Window, Left, and Right of Presentation Centering Window bar codes. In the example below, the white box is the centering window. The centering window has been set to 20% left, 30% right, 8% top, and 25% bottom. Since Bar Code 1 passes through the centering window, it will be read. Bar Code 2 does not pass through the centering window, so it will not be read. 0% Bar Code 1 10 Bar Code 2 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100% Note: A bar code needs only to be touched by the centering window in order to be read. ?It does not need to pass completely through the centering window. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 121 Scan Presentation Centering On, then scan one of the following bar codes to change the top, bottom, left, or right of the centering window. Then scan the percent you want to shift the centering window from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default Presentation Centering = 40% for Top and Left, 60% for Bottom and Right. Presentation Centering On * Presentation Centering Off Top of Presentation Centering Window Bottom of Presentation Centering Window Left of Presentation Centering Window Right of Presentation Centering Window In-Stand Sensor Mode Note: The In-Stand Sensor feature only applies to Xenon 1900, 1900h, 1910, 1902, 1902h, and 1912products. It does not apply to the Xenon 1902g-BF or Granit products. 122 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com This feature senses when the scanner is removed from the stand and tells it to begin manual triggering. When Sensor On is enabled, the scanner defaults to Streaming Presentation Mode when it is in the stand, and to Manual Trigger Mode when it is removed from the stand. Default = Sensor On. * Sensor On Sensor Off Note: If you are taking images (see Imaging Commands beginning on page 233), you must set the In-Stand Sensor to Off. You may program a Streaming Presentation Mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone) you wish to use for in-stand scanning, and a Manual Trigger mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone) you wish to use for out-of-stand scanning. To do this, you must first scan the preferred Streaming Presentation mode (see below), then scan the Manual Trigger mode (see page 117 and page 125) you want to use. Poor Quality Codes Poor Quality 1D Codes This setting improves the scanner’s ability to read damaged or badly printed linear bar codes. When Poor Quality 1D Reading On is scanned, poor quality linear bar code reading is improved, but the scanner’s snappiness is decreased, making it less aggressive when reading good quality bar codes. This setting does not affect 2D bar code reading. Default = Poor Quality 1D Reading Off. Poor Quality 1D Reading On * Poor Quality 1D Reading Off Poor Quality PDF Codes This setting improves the scanner’s ability to read damaged or badly printed PDF codes by combining information from multiple images. When Poor Quality PDF On is scanned, poor quality PDF code reading is improved, but the scanner’s snap- Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 123 piness is decreased, making it less aggressive when reading good quality bar codes. This setting does not affect 1D bar code reading. Default = Poor Quality PDF Reading Off. Poor Quality PDF Reading On * Poor Quality PDF Reading Off CodeGate® When CodeGate is On, the trigger is used to allow decoded data to be transmitted to the host system. The scanner remains on, scanning and decoding bar codes, but the bar code data is not transmitted until the trigger is pressed. When CodeGate is Off, bar code data is transmitted when it is decoded. Default = CodeGate Off Out-ofStand. * CodeGate Off Out-of-Stand CodeGate On Out-of-Stand Streaming Presentation™ Mode When in Streaming Presentation mode, the scanner’s aimer goes out after a short time, but the scan illumination remains on all the time to continuously search for bar codes. Two modes are available, Normal and Enhanced. Normal mode offers good scan speed and the longest working ranges (depth of field). Enhanced mode will give you the highest possible scan speed but slightly less range than Normal mode. Enhanced mode is best used when you require a very fast scan speed and don’t require a long working range. Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Enhanced Streaming Presentation Mode. 124 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Streaming Presentation Mode - Normal Streaming Presentation Mode - Enhanced When using Preferred Symbology (page 5-134), a lower priority symbol must be centered on the aiming pattern to be read in Streaming Presentation Mode. Note: If you are using a cordless charge base, it must have an external power supply plugged into the aux port for Streaming Presentation to work properly. Streaming Presentation In-Stand This option is available when using In-Stand Sensor Mode, page 122. You may program a specific Streaming Presentation Mode for in-stand scanning, and a Manual Trigger mode for out-of-stand scanning. To do this, you must first scan the preferred Streaming Presentation mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone), then scan the Manual Trigger mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone) you want to use. Mobile Phone Read Mode When this mode is selected, your scanner is optimized to read bar codes from mobile phone or other LED displays. However, the speed of scanning printed bar codes may be slightly lower when this mode is enabled. You can enable Mobile Phone Reading for either a hand held device, or for a hands-free (presentation) application. Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support these settings. Hand Held Scanning - Mobile Phone Streaming Presentation Mobile Phone Note: To turn off Mobil Phone Read Mode, scan a Manual or Serial Trigger Mode bar code (see page 117). Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 125 Hands Free Time-Out The Scan Stand and Presentation Modes are referred to as “hands free” modes. If the scanner’s trigger is pulled when using a hands free mode, the scanner changes to manual trigger mode. You can set the time the scanner should remain in manual trigger mode by setting the Hands Free Time-Out. Once the time-out value is reached, (if there have been no further trigger pulls) the scanner reverts to the original hands free mode. Scan the Hands Free Time-Out bar code, then scan the time-out duration (from 0300,000 milliseconds) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 5,000 ms. Hands Free Time-Out Reread Delay This sets the time period before the scanner can read the same bar code a second time. Setting a reread delay protects against accidental rereads of the same bar code. Longer delays are effective in minimizing accidental rereads. Use shorter delays in applications where repetitive bar code scanning is required. Reread Delay only works when in a Presentation Mode (see page 120). Default = Medium. Short (500 ms) * Medium (750 ms) Long (1000 ms) Extra Long (2000 ms) 126 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com User-Specified Reread Delay If you want to set your own length for the reread delay, scan the bar code below, then set the delay (from 0-30,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. User-Specified Reread Delay 2D Reread Delay Sometimes 2D bar codes can take longer to read than other bar codes. If you wish to set a separate Reread Delay for 2D bar codes, scan one of the programming codes that follows. 2D Reread Delay Off indicates that the time set for Reread Delay is used for both 1D and 2D bar codes. Default = 2D Reread Delay Off. * 2D Reread Delay Off Short (1000ms) Medium (2000ms) Long (3000ms) Extra Long (4000ms) Character Activation You may use a character sent from the host to trigger the scanner to begin scanning. When the activation character is received, the scanner continues scanning until either the Character Activation Timeout (page 5-129), the deactivation character is received (see Deactivation Character on page 129), or a bar code is trans- Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 127 mitted. Scan the following On bar code to use character activation, then use Activation Character (page 128) to select the character you will send from the host to start scanning. Default = Off. * Off On Activation Character This sets the character used to trigger scanning when using Character Activation Mode. On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the hex value that represents the character you want to use to trigger scanning. Scan the following bar code, then use the Programming Chart to read the alphanumeric combination that represents that ASCII character. Scan Save to finish. Default = 12 [DC2]. Activation Character End Character Activation After Good Read After a bar code is successfully detected and read from the scanner, the illumination can be programmed either to remain on and scanning, or to turn off. When End Character Activation After Good Read is enabled, the illumination turns off and stops scanning after a good read. If you scan Do Not End Character Activation After Good Read, the illumination remains on after a good read. Do Not End Character Activation After Good Read End Character Activation After Good Read 128 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Character Activation Timeout You can set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and attempting to decode bar codes when using Character Activation Mode. Set the length (in milliseconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-300,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 30,000 ms. Character Activation Timeout Character Deactivation If you have sent a character from the host to trigger the scanner to begin scanning, you can also send a deactivation character to stop scanning. Scan the following On bar code to use character deactivation, then use Deactivation Character (following) to select the character you will send from the host to terminate scanning. Default = Off. * Off On Deactivation Character This sets the character used to terminate scanning when using Character Deactivation Mode. On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the hex value that represents the character you want to use to terminate scanning. Scan the following bar code, then use the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 to read the alphanumeric combination that represents that ASCII character. Scan Save to finish. Default = 14 [DC4]. Deactivation Character Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 129 Illumination Lights If you want the illumination lights on while reading a bar code, scan the Lights On bar code, below. However, if you want to turn just the lights off, scan the Lights Off bar code. Default = Lights On. Note: This setting does not affect the aimer light. The aiming light can be set using Aimer Mode (page 131). * Lights On Lights Off Aimer Delay The aimer delay allows a delay time for the operator to aim the scanner before the picture is taken. Use these codes to set the time between when the trigger is pulled and when the picture is taken. During the delay time, the aiming light will appear, but the LEDs won’t turn on until the delay time is over. Default = Off. 1 millisecond 250 milliseconds 500 milliseconds * Off (no 130 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com User-Specified Aimer Delay If you want to set your own length for the duration of the delay, scan the bar code below, then set the time-out by scanning digits (0 - 4,000 ms) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Delay Duration Aimer Mode This feature allows you to turn the aimer on and off. When the Interlaced bar code is scanned, the aimer is interlaced with the illumination LEDs. Default = Interlaced Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Aimer Mode. Off * Interlaced Centering Use Centering to narrow the scanner’s field of view to make sure that when the scanner is hand-held, it reads only those bar codes intended by the user. For instance, if multiple codes are placed closely together, centering will insure that only the desired codes are read. (Centering can be used in conjunction with Aimer Delay, page 130, for the most error-free operation in applications where multiple codes are spaced closely together. Using the Aimer Delay and Centering features, the scanner can emulate the operation of older systems, such as linear laser bar code scanners.) Note: To adjust centering when the scanner is in the stand, see Presentation Centering (page 5-121). Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 131 Single Code Centering Scan Single Code Centering to target the bar code closest to the center of the image. Singling out a bar code in this manner increases scanning accuracy when there are multiple bar codes close together. Single Code Centering Custom Centering Use the following settings to customize your centering window. If a bar code is not touched by a predefined window, it will not be decoded or output by the scanner. If centering is turned on by scanning Centering On, the scanner only reads codes 132 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com that pass through the centering window you specify using the Top of Centering Window, Bottom of Centering Window, Left, and Right of Centering Window bar codes. Example: In the example below, the white box is the centering window. The centering window has been set to 20% left, 30% right, 8% top, and 25% bottom. Since Bar Code 1 passes through the centering window, it will be read. Bar Code 2 does not pass through the centering window, so it will not be read. 0% Bar Code 1 10 Bar Code 2 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100% Note: A bar code needs only to be touched by the centering window in order to be read. It does not need to pass completely through the centering window. Scan Centering On, then scan one of the following bar codes to change the top, bottom, left, or right of the centering window. Then scan the percent you want to shift the centering window using digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default Centering = 40% for Top and Left, 60% for Bottom and Right. Centering On * Centering Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 133 Top of Centering Window Bottom of Centering Window Left of Centering Window Right of Centering Window Preferred Symbology The scanner can be programmed to specify one symbology as a higher priority over other symbologies in situations where both bar code symbologies appear on the same label, but the lower priority symbology cannot be disabled. For example, you may be using the scanner in a retail setting to read U.P.C. symbols, but have occasional need to read a code on a drivers license. Since some licenses have a Code 39 symbol as well as the PDF417 symbol, you can use Preferred Symbology to specify that the PDF417 symbol be read instead of the Code 39. Preferred Symbology classifies each symbology as high priority, low priority, or as an unspecified type. When a low priority symbology is presented, the scanner ignores it for a set period of time (see Preferred Symbology Time-out on page 135) while it searches for the high priority symbology. If a high priority symbology is located during this period, then that data is read immediately. If the time-out period expires before a high priority symbology is read, the scanner will read any bar code in its view (low priority or unspecified). If there is no bar code in the scanner’s view after the time-out period expires, then no data is reported. Note: A low priority symbol must be centered on the aiming pattern to be read. Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Preferred Symbology. Default = Preferred Symbology Off. Preferred Symbology On 134 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Preferred Symbology Off High Priority Symbology To specify the high priority symbology, scan the High Priority Symbology bar code below. On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology you want to set as high priority. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = None. High Priority Symbology Low Priority Symbology To specify the low priority symbology, scan the Low Priority Symbology bar code below. On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology you want to set as low priority. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. If you want to set additional low priority symbologies, scan FF, then scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, for the next symbology. You can program up to 5 low priority symbologies. Scan Save to save your selection. Default = None. Low Priority Symbology Preferred Symbology Time-out Once you have enabled Preferred Symbology and entered the high and low priority symbologies, you must set the time-out period. This is the period of time the scanner will search for a high priority bar code after a low priority bar code has been encountered. Scan the bar code below, then set the delay (from 1-3,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 500 ms. Preferred Symbology Time-out Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 135 Preferred Symbology Default Scan the bar code below to set all Preferred Symbology entries to their default values. Preferred Symbology Default Output Sequence Overview Output Sequence Editor This programming selection allows you to program the scanner to output data (when scanning more than one symbol) in whatever order your application requires, regardless of the order in which the bar codes are scanned. Reading the Default Sequence symbol programs the scanner to the Universal values, shown below. These are the defaults. Be certain you want to delete or clear all formats before you read the Default Sequence symbol. Note: To make Output Sequence Editor selections, you’ll need to know the code I.D., code length, and character match(es) your application requires. Use the Alphanumeric symbols from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. You must hold the trigger while reading each bar code in the sequence. To Add an Output Sequence 1. Scan the Enter Sequence symbol (see Require Output Sequence, page 139). 2. Code I.D. On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology to which you want to apply the output sequence format. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart (inside back cover). 3. Length Specify what length (up to 9999 characters) of data output will be acceptable for this symbology. Scan the four digit data length Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. (Note: 50 characters is entered as 0050. 9999 is a universal number, indicating all lengths.) When calculating the length, you must count any programmed prefixes, suffixes, or formatted characters as part of the length (unless using 9999). 4. Character Match Sequences On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the Hex value that represents the character(s) you want to match. Use the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, to read the alphanumeric combination that represents the ASCII characters. (99 is the Universal number, indicating all characters.) 136 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 5. End Output Sequence Editor Scan F F to enter an Output Sequence for an additional symbology, or Save to save your entries. Other Programming Selections Discard exits without saving any Output Sequence changes. Output Sequence Example In this example, you are scanning Code 93, Code 128, and Code 39 bar codes, but you want the scanner to output Code 39 1st, Code 128 2nd, and Code 93 3rd, as shown below. Note: Code 93 must be enabled to use this example. A - Code 39 B - Code 128 C - Code 93 You would set up the sequence editor with the following command line: SEQBLK62999941FF6A999942FF69999943FF The breakdown of the command line is shown below: SEQBLK sequence editor start command 62 code identifier for Code 39 9999 code length that must match for Code 39, 9999 = all lengths 41 start character match for Code 39, 41h = “A” FF termination string for first code 6A code identifier for Code 128 9999 code length that must match for Code 128, 9999 = all lengths 42 start character match for Code 128, 42h = “B” FF termination string for second code 69 code identifier for Code 93 9999 code length that must match for Code 93, 9999 = all lengths Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 137 43 start character match for Code 93, 43h = “C” FF termination string for third code To program the previous example using specific lengths, you would have to count any programmed prefixes, suffixes, or formatted characters as part of the length. If you use the example on page 137, but assume a <CR> suffix and specific code lengths, you would use the following command line: SEQBLK62001241FF6A001342FF69001243FF The breakdown of the command line is shown below: SEQBLK sequence editor start command 62 code identifier for Code 39 0012 A - Code 39 sample length (11) plus CR suffix (1) = 12 41 start character match for Code 39, 41h = “A” FF termination string for first code 6A code identifier for Code 128 0013 B - Code 128 sample length (12) plus CR suffix (1) = 13 42 start character match for Code 128, 42h = “B” FF termination string for second code 69 code identifier for Code 93 0012 C - Code 93 sample length (11) plus CR suffix (1) = 12 43 start character match for Code 93, 43h = “C” FFtermination string for third code Output Sequence Editor Enter Sequence Default Sequence Partial Sequence If an output sequence operation is terminated before all your output sequence criteria are met, the bar code data acquired to that point is a “partial sequence.” 138 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Scan Discard Partial Sequence to discard partial sequences when the output sequence operation is terminated before completion. Scan Transmit Partial Sequence to transmit partial sequences. (Any fields in the sequence where no data match occurred are skipped in the output.) Transmit Partial Sequence * Discard Partial Sequence Require Output Sequence When an output sequence is Required, all output data must conform to an edited sequence or the scanner will not transmit the output data to the host device. When it’s On/Not Required, the scanner will attempt to get the output data to conform to an edited sequence but, if it cannot, the scanner transmits all output data to the host device as is. When the output sequence is Off, the bar code data is output to the host as the scanner decodes it. Default = Off. Note: This selection is unavailable when the Multiple Symbols Selection is turned on. Required On/Not Required *Off Multiple Symbols When this programming selection is turned On, it allows you to read multiple symbols with a single pull of the scanner’s trigger. If you press and hold the trigger, aiming the scanner at a series of symbols, it reads unique symbols once, beeping (if turned on) for each read. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. The Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 139 scanner attempts to find and decode new symbols as long as the trigger is pulled. When this programming selection is turned Off, the scanner will only read the symbol closest to the aiming beam. Default = Off. On * Off No Read With No Read turned On, the scanner notifies you if a code cannot be read. If using an EZConfig-Scanning Tool Scan Data Window (see page 255), an “NR” appears when a code cannot be read. If No Read is turned Off, the “NR” will not appear. Default = Off. On * Off If you want a different notation than “NR,” for example, “Error,” or “Bad Code,” you can edit the output message (see Data Format beginning on page 157). The hex code for the No Read symbol is 9C. Video Reverse Video Reverse is used to allow the scanner to read bar codes that are inverted. The Video Reverse Off bar code below is an example of this type of bar code. Scan Video Reverse Only to read only inverted bar codes. Scan Video Reverse and Standard Bar Codes to read both types of codes. Note: After scanning Video Reverse Only, menu bar codes cannot be read. You must scan Video Reverse Off or Video Reverse and Standard Bar Codes in order to read menu bar codes. Note: Images downloaded from the unit are not reversed. This is a setting for decoding only. 140 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Video Reverse Only Video Reverse and Standard Bar Codes * Video Reverse Off Working Orientation Some bar codes are direction-sensitive. For example, KIX codes and OCR can misread when scanned sideways or upside down. Use the working orientation settings if your direction-sensitive codes will not usually be presented upright to the scanner. Default = Upright. Upright: Vertical, Top to Bottom: (Rotate CW 90°) Upside Down: Vertical, Bottom to Top: (Rotate CCW 90°) * Upright Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 141 Vertical, Bottom to Top Upside Down Vertical, Top to Bottom 142 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 6 HEALTHCARE SETTINGS The following settings have been developed to enhance scanning in a healthcare environment. These settings are only supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner and Xenon 1902h scanner and base. They allow you to set quickly configure streaming presentation, and to set the scanner and base to quiet modes for scanning that do not disturb resting patients. Quiet Operations - Combination Codes The following combination codes program your Xenon healthcare scanner and base for silent or quiet settings using a single programming code. If you wish to program some of these quiet settings individually, refer to Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings, beginning on page 145. Silent Mode with Flashing LED Scan the following bar code to completely silence the Xenon 1900h scanner or Xenon 1902h scanner and base. The scanner beep, base beep, base and scanner power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is scanned, the LED and aimer flash 5 times. Green indicates a good scan, red indicates a bad scan. Silent Mode with Flashing LED Cordless Scanner and Base Silent Mode with Flashing LED Corded Scanner Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 143 Silent Mode with Long LED Scan the following bar code to completely silence the Xenon 1900h scanner or Xenon 1902h scanner and base. The scanner beep, base beep, base and scanner power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is scanned, the LED and aimer remain solidly lit for 1 second. Green indicates a good scan, red indicates a bad scan. Silent Mode with Long LED Cordless Scanner and Base Silent Mode with Long LED Corded Scanner Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode) The following bar code silences the base, and sets the scanner for a very low beep when reading bar codes. After scanning this code, the base beep, base and scanner power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is scanned, the scanner emits a very soft beep. Nighttime Mode Cordless Scanner and Base Nighttime Mode Corded Scanner 144 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) The following bar code sets all sounds to on, but at a low volume. The scanner beep, base beep, base and scanner power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all set to low volume. Daytime Mode Cordless Scanner and Base Daytime Mode Corded Scanner To reset your scanner and base to default sounds, refer to Reset the Custom Defaults (page 263). Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings If you have silenced or muted the scanner and base sounds, you may wish to adjust the visual (LED) indicators for Bluetooth linking sounds, scanning sounds, paging sounds, and out of range alarm sounds. Linking LED Colors and Sound Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner. Under normal operations, the scanner chirps when linking to a base or an access point, and the LED on both the base and scanner flash green. If you want to silence all sounds and set both devices to flash red LEDs to indicate the linking status, scan the Red LED Flashes/Silent bar code below. The LEDS flash red while linking, then green to indicate the base and scanner are linked. To return to the default LED colors and sound, scan Green LED Flashes/Sound. Default = Green LED Flashes/Sound. * Green LED Flashes/Sound Red LED Flashes/Silent Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 145 Number of LED Flashes If you have silenced the scanner’s beeper, you may set the number of times the LED flashes when reading bar codes. Default = 1 LED Flash. Note: If you have set LED Solid (No Flash) (page 147), to anything but Off, that setting will override the LED Flash settings. In that case, scan the LED Solid Off bar code to turn off this feature, then scan the LED Flash code you wish to use. * 1 LED Flash 5 LED Flashes 10 LED Flashes 25 LED Flashes LED Flash Rate If you have silenced the scanner’s beeper, you may set the how quickly the LED flashes when reading bar codes. Default = Fast Flash. * Fast Flash Medium Flash Slow Flash 146 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com LED Solid (No Flash) Under normal operations, the scanner’s LED flashes once for a good read. You may set the LED to remain on for a length of time after a good read instead of flashing. Default = LED Solid Off (Resume Flash). * LED Solid Off (Resume Flash) LED Solid 1 Second LED Solid 3 Seconds LED Solid 5 Seconds If you have scanned a bar code and don’t want to wait for the LED to turn off, press the trigger a 2nd time and the LED turns off. You can then scan the next bar code. Page Volume Control Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner. When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping in response. If you pull the trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the base or Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop beeping. The following settings set the paging volume, independent of the volume used when scanning bar codes. Default = Low. Page Volume Off * Page Volume Low Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 147 Page Volume Medium Page Volume High Out-of-Range Alarm Volume Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner. If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and scanner. If your scanner is out range of an Access Point, an alarm sounds from just the scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base or Access Point, when the base or Access Point connects to another scanner, or when the alarm duration expires (see Out-of-Range Delay on page 149). The following settings set the Out-of-Range Alarm for the base and the scanner, independent of the volume used when scanning bar codes. Default = Base Alarm Volume Low, Scanner Alarm Volume Low. Base Alarm Volume Off Scanner Alarm Volume Off * Base Alarm Volume Low * Scanner Alarm Volume Low Base Alarm Volume Medium 148 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Scanner Alarm Volume Medium Base Alarm Volume High Scanner Alarm Volume High Out-of-Range Delay Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner. When using the Out-of-Range Alarm settings, the length of the delay for the alarm is set with an Out-of-Range Delay. When the scanner is out of range of the base or Access Point, the alarm will delay for a set length of time before going off. Set the length (in seconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 0-3,000 seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = No Delay. Out-of-Range Delay Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 149 150 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 7 DATA EDIT Prefix/Suffix Overview When a bar code is scanned, additional information is sent to the host computer along with the bar code data. This group of bar code data and additional, user-defined data is called a “message string.” The selections in this section are used to build the user-defined data into the message string. Prefix and Suffix characters are data characters that can be sent before and after scanned data. You can specify if they should be sent with all symbologies, or only with specific symbologies. The following illustration shows the breakdown of a message string: Prefix Scanned Data 1-11 variable length alpha numeric & control characters Suffix 1-11 alpha numeric & control characters Points to Keep In Mind • It is not necessary to build a message string. The selections in this chapter are only used if you wish to alter the default settings. Default prefix = None. Default suffix = None. • A prefix or suffix may be added or cleared from one symbology or all symbologies. • You can add any prefix or suffix from the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330, plus Code I.D. and AIM I.D. • You can string together several entries for several symbologies at one time. • Enter prefixes and suffixes in the order in which you want them to appear on the output. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 151 • When setting up for specific symbologies (as opposed to all symbologies), the specific symbology ID value counts as an added prefix or suffix character. • The maximum size of a prefix or suffix configuration is 200 characters, which includes header information. Add a Prefix or Suffix: Step 1. Scan the Add Prefix or Add Suffix symbol (page 153). Step 2. Determine the 2 digit hex value from the Symbology Charts (beginning on page A-327) for the symbology to which you want to apply the prefix or suffix. For example, for Code 128, Code ID is “j” and Hex ID is “6A”. Step 3. Scan the 2 hex digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, or scan 9, 9 for all symbologies. To add the Code I.D., scan 5, C, 8, 0. To add the AIM I.D., scan 5, C, 8, 1. To add the serial number, scan 5, C, 8, 8. To add a backslash (\), scan 5, C, 5, C. Note: When adding a backslash (\), you must scan 5C twice – once to create the leading backslash and then to create the backslash itself. Step 4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for every prefix or suffix character. Step 5. Scan Save to exit and save, or scan Discard to exit without saving. Repeat the steps above to add a prefix or suffix for another symbology. Example: Add a Tab Suffix to All Symbologies Step 1. Scan Add Suffix. Step 2. Scan 9, 9 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 to apply this suffix to all symbologies. Step 3. Scan 0, 9 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. This corresponds with the hex value for a horizontal tab, shown in the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330. Step 4. Scan Save, or scan Discard to exit without saving. Clear One or All Prefixes or Suffixes You can clear a single prefix or suffix, or clear all prefixes/suffixes for a symbology. If you have been entering prefixes and suffixes for single symbologies, you can use Clear One Prefix (Suffix) to delete a specific character from a symbology. When you Clear All Prefixes (Suffixes), all the prefixes or suffixes for a symbology are deleted. 152 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Step 1. Scan the Clear One Prefix or Clear One Suffix symbol. Step 2. Determine the 2 digit Hex value from the Symbology Chart (included in the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327) for the symbology from which you want to clear the prefix or suffix. Step 3. Scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 or scan 9, 9 for all symbologies. Your change is automatically saved. Add a Carriage Return Suffix to All Symbologies Scan the following bar code if you wish to add a carriage return suffix to all symbologies at once. This action first clears all current suffixes, then programs a carriage return suffix for all symbologies. Add CR Suffix All Symbologies Prefix Selections Add Prefix Clear One Prefix Clear All Prefixes Suffix Selections Add Suffix Clear One Suffix Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 153 Clear All Suffixes Function Code Transmit When this selection is enabled and function codes are contained within the scanned data, the scanner transmits the function code to the terminal. Charts of these function codes are provided in ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330. When the scanner is in keyboard wedge mode, the scan code is converted to a key code before it is transmitted. Default = Enable. * Enable Disable Intercharacter, Interfunction, and Intermessage Delays Some terminals drop information (characters) if data comes through too quickly. Intercharacter, interfunction, and intermessage delays slow the transmission of data, increasing data integrity. Intercharacter Delay An intercharacter delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be placed between the transmission of each character of scanned data. Scan the Intercharacter Delay bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Prefix Scanned Data 1 2 3 4 Suffix 5 Intercharacter Delay Intercharacter Delay 154 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com To remove this delay, scan the Intercharacter Delay bar code, then set the number of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Note: Intercharacter delays are not supported in USB serial emulation. User Specified Intercharacter Delay An intercharacter delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be placed after the transmission of a particular character of scanned data. Scan the Delay Length bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Next, scan the Character to Trigger Delay bar code, then the 2-digit hex value for a printable character to trigger the delay (see Lower ASCII Reference Table, page 331.) Delay Length Character to Trigger Delay To remove this delay, scan the Delay Length bar code, and set the number of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Interfunction Delay An interfunction delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be placed between the transmission of each control character in the message string. Scan the Interfunction Delay bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays, and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Prefix STX 1 Scanned Data HT 2 3 4 5 Suffix CR LF Interfunction Delays Interfunction Delay Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 155 To remove this delay, scan the Interfunction Delay bar code, then set the number of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Intermessage Delay An intermessage delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be placed between each scan transmission. Scan the Intermessage Delay bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays, and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. 1st Scan Transmission 2nd Scan Transmission Intermessage Delay Intermessage Delay To remove this delay, scan the Intermessage Delay bar code, then set the number of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. 156 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 8 DATA FORMAT Data Format Editor Introduction You may use the Data Format Editor to change the scanner’s output. For example, you can use the Data Format Editor to insert characters at certain points in bar code data as it is scanned. The selections in the following pages are used only if you wish to alter the output. Default Data Format setting = None. Normally, when you scan a bar code, it is output automatically. However, when you create a format, you must use a “send” command (see Send Commands on page 160) within the format program to output data. Multiple formats may be programmed into the scanner. They are stacked in the order in which they are entered. However, the following list presents the order in which formats are applied: 1. Specific Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Actual Length 2. Specific Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Universal Length 3. Specific Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Actual Length 4. Specific Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Universal Length 5. Universal Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Actual Length 6. Universal Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Universal Length 7. Universal Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Actual Length 8. Universal Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Universal Length The maximum size of a data format configuration is 2000 bytes, which includes header information. If a bar code is read that fails the first data format, the next data format, if there is one, will be used on the bar code data. If there is no other data format, the raw data is output. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 157 If you have changed data format settings, and wish to clear all formats and return to the factory defaults, scan the Default Data Format code below. * Default Data Format Add a Data Format Step 1. Scan the Enter Data Format symbol (page 159). Step 2. Select Primary/Alternate Format Determine if this will be your primary data format, or one of 3 alternate formats. This allows you to save a total of 4 different data formats. To program your primary format, scan 0 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. If you are programming an alternate format, scan 1, 2, or 3, depending on which alternate format you are programming. (See Primary/Alternate Data Formats on page 175 for further information.) Step 3. Terminal Type Refer to Terminal ID Table (page 160) and locate the Terminal ID number for your PC. Scan three numeric bar codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, to program the scanner for your terminal ID (you must enter 3 digits). For example, scan 0 0 3 for an AT wedge. Note: 099 indicates all terminal types. Step 4. Code I.D. In the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327, find the symbology to which you want to apply the data format. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. If you wish to create a data format for all symbologies, with the exception of some specific symbologies, refer to B8 (page 173). If you are creating a data format for Batch Mode Quantity, use 35 for the Code I.D. Note: 99 indicates all symbologies. Step 5. Length Specify what length (up to 9999 characters) of data will be acceptable for this symbology. Scan the four digit data length from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. For example, 50 characters is entered as 0050. Note: 9999 indicates all lengths. Step 6. 158 Editor Commands Refer to Data Format Editor Commands (page 160). Scan the symbols that represent the command you want to enter. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Step 7. Scan Save to save your data format, or Discard to exit without saving your changes. Enter Data Format Save Discard Other Programming Selections • Clear One Data Format This deletes one data format for one symbology. If you are clearing the primary format, scan 0 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. If you are clearing an alternate format, scan 1, 2, or 3, depending on the format you are clearing. Scan the Terminal Type and Code I.D. (see Symbology Charts on page 327), and the bar code data length for the specific data format that you want to delete. All other formats remain unaffected. • Clear all Data Formats This clears all data formats. • Save Exit and save your data format changes. • Discard Exit without saving any data format changes. Clear One Data Format Clear All Data Formats Save Discard Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 159 Terminal ID Table Terminal Model(s) Terminal ID USB PC keyboard (HID) 124 Mac Keyboard 125 PC Keyboard (Japanese) 134 Serial (COM driver required) 130 HID POS 131 Serial Keyboard USB SurePOS Handheld 128 USB SurePOS Tabletop 129 RS232 TTL 000 RS232 True 000 RS485 (IBM-HHBCR 1+2, 46xx) 051 PS2 compatibles 003 AT compatibles 002 Data Format Editor Commands When working with the Data Format Editor, a virtual cursor is moved along your input data string. The following commands are used to both move this cursor to different positions, and to select, replace, and insert data into the final output. Send Commands Send all characters F1 Include in the output message all of the characters from the input message, starting from current cursor position, followed by an insert character. Syntax = F1xx where xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Send a number of characters F2 Include in the output message a number of characters followed by an insert character. Start from the current cursor position and continue for “nn” characters or through the last character in the input message, followed by character “xx.” Syntax = F2nnxx where nn stands for the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters, and xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. 160 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com F2 Example: Send a number of characters Send the first 10 characters from the bar code above, followed by a carriage return. Command string: F2100D F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command 10 is the number of characters to send 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 1234567890 F2 and F1 Example: Split characters into 2 lines Send the first 10 characters from the bar code above, followed by a carriage return, followed by the rest of the characters. Command string: F2100DF10D F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command 10 is the number of characters to send for the first line 0D is the hex value for a CR F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 1234567890 ABCDEFGHIJ <CR> Send all characters up to a particular character F3 Include in the output message all characters from the input message, starting with the character at the current cursor position and continuing to, but not including, the search character “ss,” followed by an insert character. The cursor is moved forward to the “ss” character. Syntax = F3ssxx where ss stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code, and xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. F3 Example: Send all characters up to a particular character Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 161 Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “D,” followed by a carriage return. Command string: F3440D F3 is the “Send all characters up to a particular character” command 44 is the hex value for a 'D” 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 1234567890ABC <CR> Send all characters up to a string B9 Include in the output message all characters from the input message, starting with the character at the current cursor position and continuing to, but not including, the search string “s...s.” The cursor is moved forward to the beginning of the “s...s” string. Syntax = B9nnnns...s where nnnn stands for the length of the string, and s...s stands for the string to be matched. The string is made up of hex values for the characters in the string. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. B9 Example: Send all characters up to a defined string Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “AB.” Command string: B900024142 B9 is the “Send all characters up to a string” command 0002 is the length of the string (2 characters) 41 is the hex value for A 42 is the hex value for B The data is output as: 1234567890 Send all but the last characters E9 Include in the output message all but the last “nn” characters, starting from the current cursor position. The cursor is moved forward to one position past the last input message character included. Syntax = E9nn where nn stands for the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters that will not be sent at the end of the message. 162 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Insert a character multiple times F4 Send “xx” character “nn” times in the output message, leaving the cursor in the current position. Syntax = F4xxnn where xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code, and nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of times it should be sent. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. E9 and F4 Example: Send all but the last characters, followed by 2 tabs Send all characters except for the last 8 from the bar code above, followed by 2 tabs. Command string: E908F40902 E9 is the “Send all but the last characters” command 08 is the number of characters at the end to ignore F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command 09 is the hex value for a horizontal tab 02 is the number of times the tab character is sent The data is output as: 1234567890AB <tab><tab> Insert a string BA Send “ss” string of “nn” length in the output message, leaving the cursor in the current position. Syntax = BAnnnns...s where nnnn stands for the length of the string, and s...s stands for the string. The string is made up of hex values for the characters in the string. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. B9 and BA Example: Look for the string “AB” and insert 2 asterisks (**) Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “AB.” Insert 2 asterisks at that point, and send the rest of the data with a carriage return after. Command string: B900024142BA00022A2AF10D B9 is the “Send all characters up to a string” command 0002 is the length of the string (2 characters) 41 is the hex value for A 42 is the hex value for B Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 163 BA is the “Insert a string” command 0002 is the length of the string to be added (2 characters) 2A is the hex value for an asterisk (*) 2A is the hex value for an asterisk (*) F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 1234567890**ABCDEFGHIJ <CR> Insert symbology name B3 Insert the name of the bar code’s symbology in the output message, without moving the cursor. Only symbologies with a Honeywell ID are included (see Symbology Charts on page 327). Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Insert bar code length B4 Insert the bar code’s length in the output message, without moving the cursor. The length is expressed as a numeric string and does not include leading zeros. B3 and B4 Example: Insert the symbology name and length Send the symbology name and length before the bar code data from the bar code above. Break up these insertions with spaces. End with a carriage return. Command string: B3F42001B4F42001F10D B3 is the “Insert symbology name” command F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command 20 is the hex value for a space 01 is the number of times the space character is sent B4 is the “Insert bar code length” command F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command 20 is the hex value for a space 01 is the number of times the space character is sent F1 is the “Send all characters” command 164 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: Code128 20 1234567890ABCDEFGHIJ <CR> Insert key strokes B5 Insert a key stroke or combination of key strokes. Key strokes are dependent on your keyboard (see Keyboard Key References on page 337). Any key can be inserted, including arrows and functions. Syntax = 5CB5xxssnn where xx is the number of keys pressed (without key modifiers), ss is the key modifier from the table below, and nn is the key number from the Keyboard Key References, page 337. • Key Modifiers Hex No Key Modifier 00 Shift Left 01 Shift Right 02 Alt Left 04 Alt Right 08 Control Left 10 Control Right 20 For example, B501021F inserts an “A” on a 104 key, U.S. style keyboard. B5 = the command, 01 = number of key press events (without the key modifier), 02 is the key modifier for Shift Right, and 1F is the “a” key. If a lower case “a” were to be inserted, B501001F would be entered. If there are three keystrokes, the syntax would change from B5xxssnn for one keystroke to B5xxssnnssnnssnn. An example that would insert "abc" is as follows: B503001F00320030F833. Note: Key modifiers can be added together when needed. The sum is converted to hexadecimals. Example: Control Left+Shift Left = 17, converted to hexadecimal = 11. Move Commands Move the cursor forward a number of characters F5 Move the cursor ahead “nn” characters from current cursor position. Syntax = F5nn where nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters the cursor should be moved ahead. F5 Example: Move the cursor forward and send the data Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 165 Move the cursor forward 3 characters, then send the rest of the bar code data from the bar code above. End with a carriage return. Command string: F503F10D F5 is the “Move the cursor forward a number of characters” command 03 is the number of characters to move the cursor F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 4567890ABCDEFGHIJ <CR> Move the cursor backward a number of characters F6 Move the cursor back “nn” characters from current cursor position. Syntax = F6nn where nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters the cursor should be moved back. Move the cursor to the beginning F7 Move the cursor to the first character in the input message. Syntax = F7. FE and F7 Example: Manipulate bar codes that begin with a 1 Search for bar codes that begin with a 1. If a bar code matches, move the cursor back to the beginning of the data and send 6 characters followed by a carriage return. Using the bar code above: Command string: FE31F7F2060D FE is the “Compare characters” command 31 is the hex value for 1 F7 is the “Move the cursor to the beginning” command F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command 06 is the number of characters to send 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 123456 <CR> 166 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Move the cursor to the end EA Move the cursor to the last character in the input message. Syntax = EA. Search Commands Search forward for a character F8 Search the input message forward for “xx” character from the current cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the “xx” character. Syntax = F8xx where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. F8 Example: Send bar code data that starts after a particular character Search for the letter “D” in bar codes and send all the data that follows, including the “D.” Using the bar code above: Command string: F844F10D F8 is the “Search forward for a character” command 44 is the hex value for “D” F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: DEFGHIJ <CR> Search backward for a character F9 Search the input message backward for “xx” character from the current cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the “xx” character. Syntax = F9xx where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 167 Search forward for a string B0 Search forward for “s” string from the current cursor position, leaving cursor pointing to “s” string. Syntax = B0nnnnS where nnnn is the string length (up to 9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each character in the match string. For example, B0000454657374 will search forward for the first occurrence of the 4 character string “Test.” Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. B0 Example: Send bar code data that starts after a string of characters Search for the letters “FGH” in bar codes and send all the data that follows, including “FGH.” Using the bar code above: Command string: B00003464748F10D B0 is the “Search forward for a string” command 0003 is the string length (3 characters) 46 is the hex value for “F” 47 is the hex value for “G” 48 is the hex value for “H” F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: FGHIJ <CR> Search backward for a string B1 Search backward for “s” string from the current cursor position, leaving cursor pointing to “s” string. Syntax = B1nnnnS where nnnn is the string length (up to 9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each character in the match string. For example, B1000454657374 will search backward for the first occurrence of the 4 character string “Test.” Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. 168 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Search forward for a non-matching character E6 Search the input message forward for the first non-“xx” character from the current cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the non-“xx” character. Syntax = E6xx where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. E6 Example: Remove zeros at the beginning of bar code data This example shows a bar code that has been zero filled. You may want to ignore the zeros and send all the data that follows. E6 searches forward for the first character that is not zero, then sends all the data after, followed by a carriage return. Using the bar code above: Command string: E630F10D E6 is the “Search forward for a non-matching character” command 30 is the hex value for 0 F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 37692 <CR> Search backward for a non-matching character E7 Search the input message backward for the first non-“xx” character from the current cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the non-“xx” character. Syntax = E7xx where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Miscellaneous Commands Suppress characters FB Suppress all occurrences of up to 15 different characters, starting at the current cursor position, as the cursor is advanced by other commands. When the FC command is encountered, the suppress function is terminated. The cursor is not moved by the FB command. Syntax = FBnnxxyy . .zz where nn is a count of the number of suppressed characters in the list, and xxyy .. zz is the list of characters to be suppressed. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 169 FB Example: Remove spaces in bar code data This example shows a bar code that has spaces in the data. You may want to remove the spaces before sending the data. Using the bar code above: Command string: FB0120F10D FB is the “Suppress characters” command 01 is the number of character types to be suppressed 20 is the hex value for a space F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 34567890 <CR> Stop suppressing characters FC Disables suppress filter and clear all suppressed characters. Syntax = FC. Replace characters E4 Replaces up to 15 characters in the output message, without moving the cursor. Replacement continues until the E5 command is encountered. Syntax = E4nnxx1xx2yy1yy2...zz1zz2 where nn is the total count of the number of characters in the list (characters to be replaced plus replacement characters); xx1 defines characters to be replaced and xx2 defines replacement characters, continuing through zz1 and zz2. E4 Example: Replace zeros with CRs in bar code data If the bar code has characters that the host application does not want included, you can use the E4 command to replace those characters with something else. In this example, you will replace the zeros in the bar code above with carriage returns. Command string: E402300DF10D E4 is the “Replace characters” command 02 is the total count of characters to be replaced, plus the replacement characters (0 is replaced by CR, so total characters = 2) 30 is the hex value for 0 170 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 0D is the hex value for a CR (the character that will replace the 0) F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR The data is output as: 1234 5678 ABC <CR> Stop replacing characters E5 Terminates character replacement. Syntax = E5. Compare characters FE Compare the character in the current cursor position to the character “xx.” If characters are equal, move the cursor forward one position. Syntax = FExx where xx stands for the comparison character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Compare string B2 Compare the string in the input message to the string “s.” If the strings are equal, move the cursor forward past the end of the string. Syntax = B2nnnnS where nnnn is the string length (up to 9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each character in the match string. For example, B2000454657374 will compare the string at the current cursor position with the 4 character string “Test.” Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes. Check for a number EC Check to make sure there is an ASCII number at the current cursor position. The format is aborted if the character is not numeric. EC Example: Only output the data if the bar code begins with a number If you want only data from bar codes that begin with a number, you can use EC to check for the number. Command string: ECF10D EC is the “Check for a number” command F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 171 If this bar code is read, the next data format, if there is one, will be used on the data. If there is no other format, the format fails and the raw data is output as AB1234. If this bar code is read: the data is output as: 1234AB <CR> Check for non-numeric character ED Check to make sure there is a non-numeric ASCII character at the current cursor position. The format is aborted if the character is numeric. ED Example: Only output the data if the bar code begins with a letter If you want only data from bar codes that begin with a letter, you can use ED to check for the letter. Command string: EDF10D ED is the “Check for a non-numeric character” command F1 is the “Send all characters” command 0D is the hex value for a CR If this bar code is read, the next data format, if there is one, will be used on this data. If there is no other format, the format fails and the raw data is output as 1234AB. If this bar code is read: the data is output as: AB1234 <CR> Insert a delay EF Inserts a delay of up to 49,995 milliseconds (in multiples of 5), starting from the current cursor position. Syntax = EFnnnn where nnnn stands for the delay in 5ms increments, up to 9999. This command can only be used with keyboard emulation. 172 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Discard Data B8 Discards types of data. For example, you may want to discard Code 128 bar codes that begin with the letter A. In step 4 (page 158), select 6A (for Code 128), and in step 5, select 9999 (for all lengths). Enter FE41B8 to compare and discard Code 128 bar codes that begin with the letter A. Syntax = B8. Note: The B8 command must be entered after all other commands. The Data Format must be Required (see page 173) in order for the B8 command to work. If Data Format is On, but Not Required (page 174), bar code data that meets the B8 format is scanned and output as usual. Because the data format needs to be On and Required (page 174) for the B8 command, you must input data formats for all bar codes you wish to discard as well as all bar codes you wish to output. Other data format settings impact the B8 command. If Data Format Non-Match Error Tone is On (page 174), the scanner emits an error tone. If Data format Non-Match Error Tone is Off, the code is disabled for reading and no tone is sounded. Data Formatter When Data Formatter is turned Off, the bar code data is output to the host as read, including prefixes and suffixes. Data Formatter Off You may wish to require the data to conform to a data format you have created and saved. The following settings can be applied to your data format: • Data Formatter On, Not Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix Scanned data is modified according to your data format, and prefixes and suffixes are transmitted. • Data Formatter On, Not Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix Scanned data is modified according to your data format. If a data format is found for a particular symbol, those prefixes and suffixes are not transmitted. If a data format is not found for that symbol, the prefixes and suffixes are transmitted. • Data Format Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix Scanned data is modified according to your data format, and prefixes and suffixes are transmitted. Any data that does not match your data format requirements generates an error tone and the data in that bar code is not transmitted. If you wish to process this type of bar code without generating an error tone, see Data Format Non-Match Error Tone. • Data Format Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix Scanned data is modified according to your data format. If a data format is found for a particular symbol, those prefixes and suffixes are not transmitted. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 173 Any data that does not match your data format requirements generates an error tone. If you wish to process this type of bar code without generating an error tone, see Data Format Non-Match Error Tone. Choose one of the following options. Default = Data Formatter On, Not Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix. * Data Formatter On, Not Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix Data Formatter On, Not Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix Data Format Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix Data Format Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix Data Format Non-Match Error Tone When a bar code is encountered that doesn’t match your required data format, the scanner normally generates an error tone. However, you may want to continue scanning bar codes without hearing the error tone. If you scan the Data Format Non-Match Error Tone Off bar code, data that doesn’t conform to your data format is not transmitted, and no error tone will sound. If you wish to hear the error tone when a non-matching bar code is found, scan the Data Format Non-Match Error Tone On bar code. Default = Data Format Non-Match Error Tone On. * Data Format Non-Match Error Tone On Data Format Non-Match Error Tone Off 174 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Primary/Alternate Data Formats You can save up to four data formats, and switch between these formats. Your primary data format is saved under 0. Your other three formats are saved under 1, 2, and 3. To set your device to use one of these formats, scan one of the bar codes below. Primary Data Format Data Format 1 Data Format 2 Data Format 3 Single Scan Data Format Change You can also switch between data formats for a single scan. The next bar code is scanned using an alternate data format, then reverts to the format you have selected above (either Primary, 1, 2, or 3). For example, you may have set your device to the data format you saved as Data Format 3. You can switch to Data Format 1 for a single trigger pull by scanning the Single Scan-Data Format 1 bar code below. The next bar code that is scanned uses Data Format 1, then reverts back to Data Format 3. Single Scan-Primary Data Format Single Scan-Data Format 1 Single Scan-Data Format 2 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 175 Single Scan-Data Format 3 176 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 9 SYMBOLOGIES This programming section contains the following menu selections. Refer to Chapter 12 for settings and defaults. • • • • • • • • • • • • • All Symbologies Aztec Code China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code Codabar Codablock A Codablock F Code 11 Code 128 Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF) Code 39 Code 93 Data Matrix • EAN/JAN-13 • EAN/JAN-8 • • • • GS1 Composite Codes GS1 DataBar Expanded GS1 DataBar Limited GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional • GS1 Emulation • GS1-128 • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Interleaved 2 of 5 Korea Post Label Code Matrix 2 of 5 MaxiCode MicroPDF417 MSI NEC 2 of 5 Postal Codes - 2D Postal Codes - Linear PDF417 GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional QR Code Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/ stop) Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar start/stop) TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39) Telepen Trioptic Code UPC-A UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code UPC-E0 UPC-E1 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 177 All Symbologies If you want to decode all the symbologies allowable for your scanner, scan the All Symbologies On code. If on the other hand, you want to decode only a particular symbology, scan All Symbologies Off followed by the On symbol for that particular symbology. Note: Scanner performance may reduce by scanning All Symbologies On. Only scan All Symbologies On when needed. All Symbologies On All Symbologies Off Note: When All Symbologies On is scanned, 2D Postal Codes are not enabled. 2D Postal Codes must be enabled separately. Message Length Description You are able to set the valid reading length of some of the bar code symbologies. You may wish to set the same value for minimum and maximum length to force the scanner to read fixed length bar code data. This helps reduce the chances of a misread. Example: Decode only those bar codes with a count of 9-20 characters. Min. length = 09 Max. length = 20 Example: Decode only those bar codes with a count of 15 characters. Min. length = 15 Max. length = 15 For a value other than the minimum and maximum message length defaults, scan the bar codes included in the explanation of the symbology, then scan the digit value of the message length and Save bar codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The minimum and maximum lengths and the defaults are included with the respective symbologies. 178 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Codabar <Default All Codabar Settings> Codabar On/Off * On Off Codabar Start /Stop Characters Start/Stop characters identify the leading and trailing ends of the bar code. You may either transmit, or not transmit Start/Stop characters. Default = Don’t Transmit. Transmit * Don’t Transmit Codabar Check Character Codabar check characters are created using different “modulos.” You can program the scanner to read only Codabar bar codes with Modulo 16 check characters. Default = No Check Character. No Check Character indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with or without a check character. When Check Character is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner will only read Codabar bar codes printed with a check character, and will transmit this character at the end of the scanned data. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 179 When Check Character is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit will only read Codabar bar codes printed with a check character, but will not transmit the check character with the scanned data. * No Check Character Validate Modulo 16, but Don’t Transmit Validate Modulo 16 and Transmit Codabar Concatenation Codabar supports symbol concatenation. When you enable concatenation, the scanner looks for a Codabar symbol having a “D” start character, adjacent to a symbol having a “D” stop character. In this case the two messages are concatenated into one with the “D” characters omitted. A 1 2 3 4 D D 5 6 7 8 A Select Require to prevent the scanner from decoding a single “D” Codabar symbol without its companion. This selection has no effect on Codabar symbols without Stop/Start D characters. On * Off Require 180 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Codabar Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 2-60. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 60. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Code 39 < Default All Code 39 Settings > Code 39 On/Off * On Off If you are reading Code 39 bar codes, Codablock A should remain disabled. If you are enabling Codablock A (see Codablock A on page 213), you should disable Code 39. Code 39 Start /Stop Characters Start/Stop characters identify the leading and trailing ends of the bar code. You may either transmit, or not transmit Start/Stop characters. Default = Don’t Transmit. Transmit Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 181 * Don’t Transmit Code 39 Check Character No Check Character indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with or without a check character. When Check Character is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads Code 39 bar codes printed with a check character, but will not transmit the check character with the scanned data. When Check Character is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads Code 39 bar codes printed with a check character, and will transmit this character at the end of the scanned data. Default = No Check Character. * No Check Character Validate, but Don’t Transmit Validate and Transmit Code 39 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 0-48. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 48. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length 182 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Code 39 Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 39 bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner encounters a Code 39 bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers Code 39 bar codes until it reads a Code 39 bar code that does not have the append trigger. The data is then transmitted in the order in which the bar codes were read (FIFO). Default = Off. On * Off Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF) Code 32 Pharmaceutical is a form of the Code 39 symbology used by Italian pharmacies. This symbology is also known as PARAF. Note: Trioptic Code (page 212) must be turned off while scanning Code 32 Pharmaceutical codes. On * Off Full ASCII If Full ASCII Code 39 decoding is enabled, certain character pairs within the bar code symbol will be interpreted as a single character. For example: $V will be decoded as the ASCII character SYN, and /C will be decoded as the ASCII character #. Default = Off. Full ASCII Table NUL %U SOH $A STX $B ETX $C EOT $D ENQ $E ACK $F DLE $P DC1 $Q DC2 $R DC3 $S DC4 $T NAK $U SYN $V SP ! “ # $ % & SPACE /A /B /C /D /E /F 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 @ A B C D E F %V A B C D E F P Q R S T U V P Q R S T U V Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com ‘ a b c d e f %W +A +B +C +D +E +F p q r s t u v +P +Q +R +S +T +U +V 183 Full ASCII Table (Continued) BEL BS HT LF VT FF CR SO SI $G $H $I $J $K $L $M $N $O ETB $W CAN $X EM $Y SUB $Z ESC %A FS %B GS %C RS %D US %E ‘ ( ) * + , . / /G /H /I /J /K /L . /O 7 8 9 : ; < = > ? 7 8 9 /Z %F %G %H %I %J G H I J K L M N O G H I J K L M N O W X Y Z [ \ ] ^ _ W X Y Z %K %L %M %N %O g h i j k l m n o +G +H +I +J +K +L +M +N +O w x y z { | } ~ DEL +W +X +Y +Z %P %Q %R %S %T Character pairs /M and /N decode as a minus sign and period respectively. Character pairs /P through /Y decode as 0 through 9. Full ASCII On * Full ASCII Off Code 39 Code Page Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. Code 39 Code Page 184 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Interleaved 2 of 5 < Default All Interleaved 2 of 5 Settings > Interleaved 2 of 5 On/Off * On Off Check Digit No Check Digit indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with or without a check digit. When Check Digit is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads Interleaved 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, but will not transmit the check digit with the scanned data. When Check Digit is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads Interleaved 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, and will transmit this digit at the end of the scanned data. Default = No Check Digit. * No Check Digit Validate, but Don’t Transmit Validate and Transmit Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 185 Interleaved 2 of 5 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 6, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length NEC 2 of 5 < Default All NEC 2 of 5 Settings > NEC 2 of 5 On/Off * On Off Check Digit No Check Digit indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with or without a check digit. When Check Digit is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads NEC 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, but will not transmit the check digit with the scanned data. 186 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com When Check Digit is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads NEC 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, and will transmit this digit at the end of the scanned data. Default = No Check Digit. * No Check Digit Validate, but Don’t Transmit Validate and Transmit NEC 2 of 5 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Code 93 < Default All Code 93 Settings > Code 93 On/Off * On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 187 Off Code 93 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 0-80. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Code 93 Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 93 bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When this function is enabled, the scanner stores those Code 93 bar codes that start with a space (excluding the start and stop symbols), and does not immediately transmit the data. The scanner stores the data in the order in which the bar codes are read, deleting the first space from each. The scanner transmits the appended data when it reads a Code 93 bar code that starts with a character other than a space. Default = Off. On * Off Code 93 Code Page Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 188 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. Code 93 Code Page Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar start/stop) <Default All Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Settings> Straight 2 of 5 Industrial On/Off On * Off Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 189 Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/stop) <Default All Straight 2 of 5 IATA Settings> Straight 2 of 5 IATA On/Off On * Off Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy If you are encountering errors when reading Straight 2 of 5 IATA bar codes, you may want to adjust the redundancy count. Redundancy adjusts the number of times a bar code is decoded before transmission, which may reduce the number of errors. Note that the higher the redundancy count, the longer it will take to decode the bar code. To adjust the redundancy, scan the Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy bar code below, then scan a redundancy count between 0 and 10 on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Then scan the Save bar code. Default = 0. Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy Straight 2 of 5 IATA Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length 190 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Matrix 2 of 5 <Default All Matrix 2 of 5 Settings> Matrix 2 of 5 On/Off On * Off Matrix 2 of 5 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 191 Code 11 <Default All Code 11 Settings> Code 11 On/Off On * Off Check Digits Required This option sets whether 1 or 2 check digits are required with Code 11 bar codes. Default = Two Check Digits. One Check Digit * Two Check Digits Code 11 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length 192 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Code 128 <Default All Code 128 Settings> Code 128 On/Off * On Off If you are reading Code 128 bar codes, Codablock F should remain disabled. If you are enabling Codablock F (see Codablock F on page 214), you should disable Code 128. ISBT 128 Concatenation In 1994 the International Society of Blood Transfusion (ISBT) ratified a standard for communicating critical blood information in a uniform manner. The use of ISBT formats requires a paid license. The ISBT 128 Application Specification describes 1) the critical data elements for labeling blood products, 2) the current recommendation to use Code 128 due to its high degree of security and its space-efficient design, 3) a variation of Code 128 that supports concatenation of neighboring symbols, and 4) the standard layout for bar codes on a blood product label. Use the bar codes below to turn concatenation on or off. Default =Off. On * Off Code 128 Redundancy If you are encountering errors when reading Code 128 bar codes, you may want to adjust the redundancy count. Redundancy adjusts the number of times a bar code is decoded before transmission, which may reduce the number of errors. Note that Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 193 the higher the redundancy count, the longer it will take to decode the bar code. To adjust the redundancy, scan the Code 128 Redundancy bar code below, then scan a redundancy count between 0 and 10 on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. Then scan the Save bar code. Default = 0. Code 128 Redundancy Code 128 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 0-80. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Code 128 Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 128 bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner encounters a Code 128 bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers Code 128 bar codes until it reads a Code 128 bar code that does not have the append trigger. The data is then transmitted in the order in which the bar codes were read (FIFO). Default = Off. On * Off Code 128 Code Page Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 194 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. Code 128 Code Page GS1-128 <Default All GS1-128 Settings> GS1-128 On/Off * On Off GS1-128 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 195 Telepen <Default All Telepen Settings> Telepen On/Off On * Off Telepen Output Using AIM Telepen Output, the scanner reads symbols with start/stop pattern 1 and decodes them as standard full ASCII (start/stop pattern 1). When Original Telepen Output is selected, the scanner reads symbols with start/stop pattern 1 and decodes them as compressed numeric with optional full ASCII (start/stop pattern 2). Default = AIM Telepen Output. * AIM Telepen Output Original Telepen Output Telepen Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-60. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 60. Minimum Message Length 196 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Maximum Message Length UPC-A <Default All UPC-A Settings> UPC-A On/Off * On Off Note: To convert UPC-A bar codes to EAN-13, see Convert UPC-A to EAN-13 on page 204. UPC-A Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On. * On Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 197 UPC-A Number System The numeric system digit of a U.P.C. symbol is normally transmitted at the beginning of the scanned data, but the unit can be programmed so it will not transmit it (Off). Default = On. * On Off UPC-A Addenda This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned UPC-A data. Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda. 2 Digit Addenda On * 2 Digit Addenda Off 5 Digit Addenda On * 5 Digit Addenda Off UPC-A Addenda Required When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read UPC-A bar codes that have addenda. You must then turn on a 2 or 5 digit addenda listed on page 198. Default = Not Required. Required 198 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Not Required Addenda Timeout You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded, based on the setting you are using for UPC-A Addenda Required. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500. Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches. Addenda Timeout UPC-A Addenda Separator When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On. * On Off UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code Use the following codes to enable or disable UPC-A and EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code. When left on the default setting (Off), the scanner treats Coupon Codes and Extended Coupon Codes as single bar codes. If you scan the Allow Concatenation code, when the scanner sees the coupon code and the extended coupon code in a single scan, it transmits both as one symbologies. Otherwise, it transmits the first coupon code it reads. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 199 If you scan the Require Concatenation code, the scanner must see and read the coupon code and extended coupon code in a single read to transmit the data. No data is output unless both codes are read. Default = Off. * Off Allow Concatenation Require Concatenation Addenda Timeout You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded, based on the setting you are using for UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500. Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches. Addenda Timeout Coupon GS1 DataBar Output If you scan coupons that have both UPC and GS1 DataBar codes, you may wish to scan and output only the data from the GS1 DataBar code. Scan the GS1 Output On code below to scan and output only the GS1 DataBar code data. Default = GS1 Output Off. * GS1 Output Off GS1 Output On 200 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com UPC-E0 <Default All UPC-E Settings> UPC-E0 On/Off Most U.P.C. bar codes lead with the 0 number system. To read these codes, use the UPC-E0 On selection. If you need to read codes that lead with the 1 number system, use UPC-E1 (page 203). Default = On. * UPC-E0 On UPC-E0 Off UPC-E0 Expand UPC-E Expand expands the UPC-E code to the 12 digit, UPC-A format. Default = Off. On * Off UPC-E0 Addenda Required When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read UPC-E bar codes that have addenda. Default = Not Required. Required * Not Required Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 201 Addenda Timeout You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded, based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500. Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches. Addenda Timeout UPC-E0 Addenda Separator When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On. * On Off UPC-E0 Check Digit Check Digit specifies whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On. * On Off 202 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com UPC-E0 Leading Zero This feature allows the transmission of a leading zero (0) at the beginning of scanned data. To prevent transmission, scan Off. Default = On. * On Off UPC-E0 Addenda This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned UPC-E data. Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda. 2 Digit Addenda On * 2 Digit Addenda Off 5 Digit Addenda On * 5 Digit Addenda Off UPC-E1 Most U.P.C. bar codes lead with the 0 number system. For these codes, use UPC-E0 (page 201). If you need to read codes that lead with the 1 number system, use the UPC-E1 On selection. Default = Off. UPC-E1 On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 203 * UPC-E1 Off EAN/JAN-13 <Default All EAN/JAN Settings> EAN/JAN-13 On/Off * On Off Convert UPC-A to EAN-13 When UPC-A Converted to EAN-13 is selected, UPC-A bar codes are converted to 13 digit EAN-13 codes by adding a zero to the front. When Do not Convert UPC-A is selected, UPC-A codes are read as UPC-A. UPC-A Converted to EAN-13 * Do not Convert UPC-A 204 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com EAN/JAN-13 Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On. * On Off EAN/JAN-13 Addenda This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned EAN/JAN-13 data. Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda. 2 Digit Addenda On * 2 Digit Addenda Off 5 Digit Addenda On * 5 Digit Addenda Off EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Required When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read EAN/JAN-13 bar codes that have addenda. Default = Not Required. Required * Not Required Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 205 Addenda Timeout You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded, based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500. Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches. Addenda Timeout EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Separator When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On. * On Off Note: If you want to enable or disable EAN13 with Extended Coupon Code, refer to UPC-A/ EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code (page 199). ISBN Translate When On is scanned, EAN-13 Bookland symbols are translated into their equivalent ISBN number format. Default = Off. On * Off 206 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com EAN/JAN-8 <Default All EAN/JAN-8 Settings> EAN/JAN-8 On/Off * On Off EAN/JAN-8 Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On. * On Off EAN/JAN-8 Addenda This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned EAN/JAN-8 data. Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda. 2 Digit Addenda On * 2 Digit Addenda Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 207 5 Digit Addenda On * 5 Digit Addenda Off EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Required When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read EAN/JAN-8 bar codes that have addenda. Default = Not Required. Required * Not Required Addenda Timeout You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded, based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500. Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches. Addenda Timeout EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Separator When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On. * On 208 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Off MSI <Default All MSI Settings> MSI On/Off On * Off MSI Check Character Different types of check characters are used with MSI bar codes. You can program the scanner to read MSI bar codes with Type 10 check characters. Default = Validate Type 10, but Don’t Transmit. When Check Character is set to Validate Type 10/11 and Transmit, the scanner will only read MSI bar codes printed with the specified type check character(s), and will transmit the character(s) at the end of the scanned data. When Check Character is set to Validate Type 10/11, but Don’t Transmit, the unit will only read MSI bar codes printed with the specified type check character(s), but will not transmit the check character(s) with the scanned data. * Validate Type 10, but Don’t Transmit Validate Type 10 and Transmit Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 209 Validate 2 Type 10 Characters, but Don’t Transmit Validate 2 Type 10 Characters and Transmit Validate Type 11 then Type 10 Character, but Don’t Transmit Validate Type 11 then Type 10 Character and Transmit Disable MSI Check Characters MSI Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 4-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length 210 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional < Default All GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional Settings > GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional On/Off * On Off GS1 DataBar Limited < Default All GS1 DataBar Limited Settings > GS1 DataBar Limited On/Off * On Off Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 211 GS1 DataBar Expanded < Default All GS1 DataBar Expanded Settings > GS1 DataBar Expanded On/Off * On Off GS1 DataBar Expanded Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 4-74. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 74. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Trioptic Code Note: If you are going to scan Code 32 Pharmaceutical codes (page 183), Trioptic Code must be off. Trioptic Code is used for labeling magnetic storage media. On * Off 212 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Codablock A <Default All Codablock A Settings> Codablock A On/Off On * Off If you are reading Code 39 bar codes, Codablock A should remain disabled. If you are enabling Codablock A, you should disable Code 39 (see Code 39 on page 181). Codablock A Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-600. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 600. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 213 Codablock F <Default All Codablock F Settings> Codablock F On/Off On * Off If you are reading Code 128 bar codes, Codablock F should remain disabled. If you are enabling Codablock F, you should disable Code 128 (see Code 128 on page 193). Codablock F Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-2048. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2048. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Label Code The standard Label Code is used in libraries. Default = Off. On 214 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com *Off PDF417 < Default All PDF417 Settings > PDF417 On/Off * On Off PDF417 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-2750. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2750. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 215 MacroPDF417 MacroPDF417 is an implementation of PDF417 capable of encoding very large amounts of data into multiple PDF417 bar codes. When this selection is enabled, these multiple bar codes are assembled into a single data string. Default = On. * On Off MicroPDF417 < Default All MicroPDF417 Settings > MicroPDF417 On/Off On * Off MicroPDF417 Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-366. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 366. Minimum Message Length 216 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Maximum Message Length GS1 Composite Codes Linear codes are combined with a unique 2D composite component to form a new class called GS1 Composite symbology. GS1 Composite symbologies allow for the co-existence of symbologies already in use. Default = Off. On * Off UPC/EAN Version Scan the UPC/EAN Version On bar code to decode GS1 Composite symbols that have a U.P.C. or an EAN linear component. (This does not affect GS1 Composite symbols with a GS1-128 or GS1 linear component.) Default = UPC/EAN Version Off. UPC/EAN Version On * UPC/EAN Version Off Note: If you scan coupons that have both UPC and GS1 DataBar codes, you may wish to scan and output only the data from the GS1 DataBar code. See Coupon GS1 DataBar Output (page 200) for further information. GS1 Composite Code Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-2435. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2435. Minimum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 217 Maximum Message Length GS1 Emulation The scanner can automatically format the output from any GS1 data carrier to emulate what would be encoded in an equivalent GS1-128 or GS1 DataBar symbol. GS1 data carriers include UPC-A and UPC-E, EAN-13 and EAN-8, ITF-14, GS1128, and GS1-128 DataBar and GS1 Composites. (Any application that accepts GS1 data can be simplified since it only needs to recognize one data carrier type.) If GS1-128 Emulation is scanned, all retail codes (U.P.C., UPC-E, EAN8, EAN13) are expanded out to 16 digits. If the AIM ID is enabled, the value will be the GS1128 AIM ID, ]C1 (see Symbology Charts on page 327). If GS1 DataBar Emulation is scanned, all retail codes (U.P.C., UPC-E, EAN8, EAN13) are expanded out to 16 digits. If the AIM ID is enabled, the value will be the GS1-DataBar AIM ID, ]em (see Symbology Charts on page 327). If GS1 Code Expansion Off is scanned, retail code expansion is disabled, and UPCE expansion is controlled by the UPC-E0 Expand (page 201) setting. If the AIM ID is enabled, the value will be the GS1-128 AIM ID, ]C1 (see Symbology Charts on page 327). If EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion is scanned, all EAN8 bar codes are converted to EAN13 format. Default = GS1 Emulation Off. GS1-128 Emulation GS1 DataBar Emulation GS1 Code Expansion Off EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion * GS1 Emulation Off 218 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39) This code is a composite code since it has a Code 39 linear component and a MicroPDF417 stacked code component. All bar code readers are capable of reading the Code 39 linear component. The MicroPDF417 component can only be decoded if TLC39 On is selected. The linear component may be decoded as Code 39 even if TLC39 is off. Default = Off. On * Off QR Code < Default All QR Code Settings > QR Code On/Off This selection applies to both QR Code and Micro QR Code. * On Off QR Code Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-7089. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 7089. Minimum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 219 Maximum Message Length QR Code Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several QR Code bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner encounters an QR Code bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers the number of QR Code bar codes determined by information encoded in those bar codes. Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the order specified in the bar codes. Default = On. * On Off QR Code Page QR Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. QR Code Page 220 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Data Matrix < Default All Data Matrix Settings > Data Matrix On/Off * On Off Data Matrix Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-3116. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 3116. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Data Matrix Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Data Matrix bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner encounters an Data Matrix bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers the number of Data Matrix bar codes determined by information encoded in those bar codes. Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the order specified in the bar codes. Default = On. * On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 221 Off Data Matrix Code Page Data Matrix Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. Data Matrix Code Page MaxiCode < Default All MaxiCode Settings > MaxiCode On/Off On * Off 222 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com MaxiCode Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-150. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 150. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Aztec Code < Default All Aztec Code Settings > Aztec Code On/Off * On Off Aztec Code Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-3832. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 3832. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 223 Aztec Append This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Aztec bar codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner encounters an Aztec bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers the number of Aztec bar codes determined by information encoded in those bar codes. Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the order specified in the bar codes. Default = On. * On Off Aztec Code Page Aztec Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly. Aztec Code Page Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code < Default All Han Xin Settings > Han Xin Code On/Off On 224 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Off Han Xin Code Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 1-7833. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 7833. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Postal Codes - 2D The following lists the possible 2D postal codes, and 2D postal code combinations that are allowed. Only one 2D postal code selection can be active at a time. If you scan a second 2D postal code selection, the first selection is overwritten. Default = 2D Postal Codes Off. * 2D Postal Codes Off Single 2D Postal Codes: Australian Post On British Post On Canadian Post On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 225 Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Japanese Post On KIX Post On Planet Code On Also see Planet Code Check Digit, page 229. Postal-4i On Postnet On Also see Postnet Check Digit, page 229. Postnet with B and B’ Fields On InfoMail On Combination 2D Postal Codes: InfoMail and British Post On 226 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Intelligent Mail Bar Code and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Postnet and Postal-4i On Postnet and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Postal-4i and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Postal-4i and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Planet Code and Postnet On Planet Code and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Planet Code and Postal-4i On Planet Code and Intelligent Mail Bar Code Planet Code, Postnet, and Postal-4i On Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 227 Planet Code, Postnet, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Planet Code, Postal-4i, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Postnet, Postal-4i, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On Planet Code, Postal-4i, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Planet Code, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On Planet Code, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet On Planet Code, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On 228 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Planet Code Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of Planet Code data. Default = Don’t Transmit. Transmit Check Digit * Don’t Transmit Check Digit Postnet Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of Postnet data. Default = Don’t Transmit. Transmit Check Digit * Don’t Transmit Check Digit Australian Post Interpretation This option controls what interpretation is applied to customer fields in Australian 4-State symbols. Bar Output lists the bar patterns in “0123” format. Numeric N Table causes that field to be interpreted as numeric data using the N Table. Alphanumeric C Table causes the field to be interpreted as alphanumeric data using the C Table. Refer to the Australian Post Specification Tables. Combination C and N Tables causes the field to be interpreted using either the C or N Tables. * Bar Output Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 229 Numeric N Table Alphanumeric C Table Combination C and N Tables Postal Codes - Linear The following lists linear postal codes. Any combination of linear postal code selections can be active at a time. China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) <Default All China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Settings> China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) On/Off On * Off China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80. Minimum Message Length 230 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Maximum Message Length Korea Post <Default All Korea Post Settings> Korea Post On * Off Korea Post Message Length Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48. Minimum Message Length Maximum Message Length Korea Post Check Digit This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted or not. Default = Don’t Transmit. Transmit Check Digit Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 231 * Don’t Transmit Check Digit 232 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 10 IMAGING COMMANDS The scanner is like a digital camera in the way it captures, manipulates, and transfers images. The following commands allow you to alter the way the scanner performs these functions. Note: If you are using the scanner in a stand, you must set the In-Stand Sensor Mode to Off in order to take images (see In-Stand Sensor Mode on page 122). Single-Use Basis Imaging Commands with their modifiers send instructions to the scanner on a single-use basis, and take effect for a single image capture. Once that capture is complete, the scanner reverts to its imaging default settings. If you want to permanently change a setting, you must use the serial default commands (see Chapter 12). When the serial default command is used, that selection becomes the new, permanent setting for the scanner. Command Syntax Multiple modifiers and commands can be issued within one sequence. If additional modifiers are to be applied to the same command, just add the modifiers to that command. For example, to add 2 modifiers to the Image Snap command, such as setting the Imaging Style to 1P and the Wait for Trigger to 1T, you would enter IMGSNP1P1T. Note: After processing an image capture command (IMGSNP or IMGBOX), you must follow it with an IMGSHP command if you want to see it on your terminal. To add a command to a sequence, each new command is separated with a semicolon. For example, to add the Image Ship command to the above sequence, you would enter IMGSNP1P1T;IMGSHP. The imaging commands are: Image Snap - IMGSNP (page 234) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 233 Image Ship - IMGSHP (page 237) Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX (page 247) The modifiers for each of these commands follow the command description. Note: The images included with each command description are examples only. The results you achieve may be different from those included in this manual. The quality of the output you receive will vary depending on lighting, quality of the initial image/object being captured, and distance of the scanner from the image/object. To achieve a high quality image, it is recommended that you position your scanner 4-6" (10.2-15.2 cm) away from the image/object you are capturing. Step 1 - Take a Picture Using IMGSNP Image Snap - IMGSNP An image is taken whenever the hardware trigger is pressed, or when the Image Snap (IMGSNP) command is processed. The image snap command has many different modifiers that can be used to change the look of the image in memory. Any number of modifiers may be appended to the IMGSNP command. Example: You can use the following command to snap an image, increase the gain, and have the beeper sound once the snap is complete: IMGSNP2G1B IMGSNP Modifiers P - Imaging Style This sets the Image Snap style. 234 0P Decoding Style. This processing allows a few frames to be taken until the exposure parameters are met. The last frame is then available for further use. 1P Photo Style (default). This mimics a simple digital camera, and results in a visually optimized image. 2P Manual Style. This is an advanced style that should only be used by an experienced user. It allows you the most freedom to set up the scanner, and has no auto-exposure. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com B - Beeper Causes a beep to sound after an image is snapped. 0B No beep (default) 1B Sounds a beep when the image is captured. T - Wait for Trigger Waits for a hardware trigger press before taking the image. This is only available when using Photo Style (1P). 0T Takes image immediately (default) 1T Waits for a trigger press, then takes the image L - LED State Determines if the LEDs should be on or off, and when. Ambient illumination (0L) is preferred for taking pictures of color documents, such as ID cards, especially when the scanner is in a stand. LED illumination (1L) is preferred when the scanner is handheld. LED State is not available when using Decoding Style (0P). 0L LEDs off (default) 1L LEDs on E - Exposure Exposure is used in Manual Style only (2P), and allows you to set the exposure time. This is similar to setting a shutter speed on a camera. The exposure time determines how long the scanner takes to record an image. On a bright day, exposure times can be very short because plenty of light is available to help record an image. At nighttime, exposure time can increase dramatically due to the near absence of light. Units are 127 microseconds. (Default = 7874) nE Example: Range: 1 - 7874 Exposure at 7874E with fluorescent lighting: Exposure at 100E with fluorescent lighting: Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 235 G - Gain Gain is used in Manual Style only (2P). Like a volume control, the gain modifier boosts the signal and multiplies the pixel value. As you increase the gain, the noise in an image is also amplified. Example: 1G No gain (default) 2G Medium gain 4G Heavy gain 8G Maximum gain Gain at 1G: Gain at 4G: Gain at 8G: W - Target White Value Sets the target for the median grayscale value in the captured image. For capturing close-up images of high contrast documents, a lower setting, such as 75, is recommended. Higher settings result in longer exposure times and brighter images, but if the setting is too high, the image may be overexposed. Target White Value is only available when using Photo Style (1P). (Default = 125) nW Example: Range: 0 - 255 White Value at 75W: White Value at 125W: White Value at 200W: D - Delta for Acceptance This sets the allowable range for the white value setting (see W - Target White Value). Delta is only available when using Photo Style (1P). (Default = 25) nD 236 Range: 0 - 255 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com U - Update Tries This sets the maximum number of frames the scanner should take to reach the D Delta for Acceptance. Update Tries is only available when using Photo Style (1P). (Default = 6) nU Range: 0 - 10 % - Target Set Point Percentage Sets the target point for the light and dark values in the captured image. A setting of 75% means 75% of the pixels are at or below the target white value, and 25% of the pixels are above the target white value. Altering this setting from the default is not recommended under normal circumstances. To alter grayscale values, W Target White Value should be used. (Default = 50) n% Example: Range: 1 - 99 Target Set Point Percentage at 97%: Target Set Point Percentage at 50%: Target Set Point Percentage at 40%: Step 2 - Ship a Picture Using IMGSHP Image Ship - IMGSHP An image is taken whenever the trigger is pressed or when the Image Snap (IMGSNP) command is processed. The last image is always stored in memory. You can “ship” the image by using the IMGSHP command. The image ship commands have many different modifiers that can be used to change the look of the image output. Modifiers affect the image that is transmitted, but do not affect the image in memory. Any number of modifiers may be appended to the IMGSHP command. Example: You can use the following command to snap and ship a bitmap image with gamma correction and document image filtering: IMGSNP;IMGSHP8F75K26U Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 237 IMGSHP Modifiers A - Infinity Filter Enhances pictures taken from very long distances (greater than 10 feet or 3m). The Infinity Filter should not be used with IMGSNP Modifiers (page 234). Example: 0A Infinity filter off (default) 1A Infinity filter on Infinity Filter off (0A) from approximately 12 feet (3.66m) away: nfinity Filter on (1A) from approximately 12 feet (3.66m) away: C - Compensation Flattens the image to account for variations in illumination across the image. Example: 0C Compensation disabled (default) 1C Compensation enabled Compensation at 0C: Compensation at 1C: D - Pixel Depth Indicates the number of bits per pixel in the transmitted image (KIM or BMP format only). 238 8D 8 bits per pixel, grayscale image (default) 1D 1 bit per pixel, black and white image Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com E - Edge Sharpen An edge sharpen filter cleans up the edges of an image, making it look cleaner and sharper. While edge sharpening does make the image look cleaner, it also removes some fine detail from the original image. The strength of the edge sharpen filter can be entered from 1 to 24. Entering a 23E gives the sharpest edges, but also increases noise in the image. Example: 0E Don’t sharpen image (default) 14E Apply edge sharpen for typical image ne Apply edge sharpen using strength n (n = 1-24) Edge Sharpen at 0E: Edge Sharpen at 24E: Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 239 F - File Format Indicates the desired format for the image. 0F KIM format 1F TIFF binary 2F TIFF binary group 4, compressed 3F TIFF grayscale 4F Uncompressed binary (upper left to lower right, 1 pixel/bit, 0 padded end of line) 5F Uncompressed grayscale (upper left to lower right, bitmap format) 6F JPEG image (default) 8F BMP format (lower right to upper left, uncompressed) 10F TIFF color compressed image 11F TIFF color uncompressed image 12F JPEG color image 14F BMP color format 15F BMP Uncompressed raw image H - Histogram Stretch Increases the contrast of the transmitted image. Not available with some image formats. Example: 240 0H No stretch (default) 1H Histogram stretch Histogram Stretch at 0H: Histogram Stretch at 1H: Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com I - Invert Image Invert image is used to rotate the image around the X or Y axis. Example: 1ix Invert around the X axis (flips picture upside down) 1iy Invert around the Y axis (flips picture left to right) Image not inverted: Image with Invert Image set to 1ix: Image with Invert Image set to 1iy: IF- Noise Reduction Used to reduce the salt and pepper noise in an image. Example: 0if No salt and pepper noise reduction (default) 1if Salt and pepper noise reduction Noise Reduction Off (0if): Noise Reduction On (1if): Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 241 IR - Image Rotate Example: 0ir Image as snapped (rightside up) (default) 1ir Rotate image 90 degrees to the right 2ir Rotate image 180 degrees (upside down) 3ir Rotate image 90 degrees to the left Image Rotate set to 0ir: Image Rotate set to 1ir: Image Rotate set to 2ir: Image Rotate set to 3ir: J - JPEG Image Quality Sets the desired quality when the JPEG image format is selected. Higher numbers result in higher quality, but larger files. Smaller numbers result in greater amounts of lossy compression, faster transmission times, lower quality, but smaller files. (Default = 50) nJ Image is compressed as much as possible while preserving quality factor of n (n = 0 - 100) 0J worst quality (smallest file) 100J best quality (largest file) 242 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com K - Gamma Correction Gamma measures the brightness of midtone values produced by the image. You can brighten or darken an image using gamma correction. A higher gamma correction yields an overall brighter image. The lower the setting, the darker the image. The optimal setting for text images is 50K. Example: 0K Gamma correction off (default) 50K Apply gamma correction for brightening typical document image nK Apply gamma correction factor n (n = 0-1,000) Gamma Correction set to 0K: Gamma Correction set to 50K: Gamma Correction set to 255K: L, R, T, B, M - Image Cropping Ships a window of the image by specifying the left, right, top, and bottom pixel coordinates. Device columns are numbered 0 through 1279, and device rows are numbered 0 through 959. nL The left edge of the shipped image corresponds to column n of the image in memory. Range: 000 - 843. (Default = 0) nR The right edge of the shipped image corresponds to column n - 1 of the image in memory. Range: 000 - 843. (Default = all columns) nT The top edge of the shipped image corresponds to row n of the image in memory. Range: 000 - 639. (Default = 0) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 243 nB Example: The bottom edge of the shipped image corresponds to row n - 1 of the image in memory. Range: 000 - 639. (Default = all rows) Uncropped Image: Image Crop set to 300R: Image Crop set to 200B: Image Crop set to 300L: Image Crop set to 200T: Alternately, specify the number of pixels to cut from the outside margin of the image; thus only the center pixels are transmitted. nM Example: Margin: cut n columns from the left, n + 1 columns from the right, n rows from the top, and n + 1 rows from the bottom of the image. Ship the remaining center pixels. Range: 0 - 238. (Default = 0, or full image) Image Crop set to 238M: P - Protocol Used for shipping an image. Protocol covers two features of the image data being sent to the host. It addresses the protocol used to send the data (Hmodem, which is an Xmodem 1K variant that has additional header information), and the format of the image data that is sent. 0P None (raw data) 2P None (default for USB) 3P Hmodem compressed (default for RS232) 4P Hmodem S - Pixel Ship Pixel Ship sizes an image in proportion to its original size. It decimates the image by shipping only certain, regularly spaced pixels. Example: 4S would transmit every fourth pixel from every fourth line. 244 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com The smaller number of pixels shipped, the smaller the image, however, after a certain point the image becomes unusable. Example: 1S ship every pixel (default) 2S ship every 2nd pixel, both horizontally and vertically 3S ship every 3rd pixel, both horizontally and vertically Pixel Ship set to 1S: Pixel Ship set to 2S: Pixel Ship set to 3S: Pixel Ship set to 4S: U - Document Image Filter Allows you to input parameters to sharpen the edges and smooth the area between the edges of text in an image. This filter should be used with gamma correction (see page 243), with the scanner in a stand, and the image captured using the command: IMGSNP1P0L168W90%32D This filter typically provides better JPEG compression than the standard E - Edge Sharpen command (see page 246). This filter also works well when shipping pure black and white images (1 bit per pixel). The optimal setting is 26U. Example: 0U Document image filter off (default) 26U Apply document image filter for typical document image nU Apply document image filter using grayscale threshold n. Use lower numbers when the image contrast is lower. 1U will have a similar effect to setting E - Edge Sharpen (page 239) to 22e. Range: 0-255. Document Image Filter set to 0U: Document Image Filter set to 26U: Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 245 V - Blur Image Smooths transitions by averaging the pixels next to the hard edges of defined lines and shaded areas in an image. Example: 0V Don’t blur (default) 1V Blur Blur Image Off (0V): Blur Image On (1V): W - Histogram Ship A histogram gives a quick picture of the tonal range of an image, or key type. A lowkey image has detail concentrated in the shadows; a high-key image has detail concentrated in the highlights; and an average-key image has detail concentrated in the midtones. This modifier ships the histogram for an image. Example: 0W Don’t ship histogram (default) 1W Ship histogram Image used for histogram: Histogram of image: Image Size Compatibility If you have applications that expect an image ship to return exactly 640x480 pixels, scan the Force VGA Resolution bar code. Default = Native Resolution. Force VGA Resolution 246 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com * Native Resolution Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX IMGBOX allows you to configure the size and location of a signature capture area relative to its proximity to a bar code. This allows you to tailor a signature capture area to a specific form. In order to use IMGBOX, you need a set form where the signature box location is in a known location relative to a bar code. You can input the overall size of the signature area, as well as specify how far the signature area is from the bar code, vertically and horizontally. You can also set the resolution and file format for the final output of the signature capture image. Note: IMGBOX commands can only be triggered by one of the following types of bar codes: PDF417, Code 39, Code 128, Aztec, Codabar, and Interleaved 2 of 5. Once one of these symbologies has been read, the image is retained for a possible IMGBOX command. Signature Capture Optimize If you will be using your scanner to capture signatures frequently, you should optimize it for this purpose. However, the speed of scanning bar codes may be slowed when this mode is enabled. Default = Off. Optimize On * Optimize Off Below is an example of a signature capture application. In this example, the aimer is centered over the signature capture area and the trigger is pressed. A single beep is emitted, indicating that the scanner has read a Code 128 bar code and the data has been transferred to the host. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. An IMGBOX command may now be sent from the host to specify the coordinates of the signature capture area below that code, and indicating that only that area containing the signature should be transferred as an image to the host. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 247 To see this example, align the aimer with the signature area (not with the bar code), then press the trigger. Send the following IMGBOX command string after the trigger press: Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y. Note: Case is not important in the command string. It is used here only for clarity. The following image is captured: The IMGBOX commands have many different modifiers that can be used to change the size and appearance of the signature image output by the scanner. Modifiers affect the image that is transmitted, but do not affect the image in memory. Any number of modifiers may be appended to the IMGBOX command. Note: The IMGBOX command will return a NAK unless a window size (width and height) are specified. See H - Height of Signature Capture Area (page 250) and W - Width of Signature Capture Area (page 251). IMGBOX Modifiers A - Output Image Width This option is used to size the image horizontally. If using this option, set the resolution (R) to zero. Example: Image Width set to 200A: Image Width set to 600A: 248 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com B - Output Image Height This option is used to size the image vertically. If using this option, set the resolution (R) to zero. Example: Image Height set to 50B: Image Height set to 100B: D - Pixel Depth This indicates the number of bits per pixel in the transmitted image, which defines whether it will be grayscale or black and white. 8D 8 bits per pixel, grayscale image (default) 1D 1 bit per pixel, black and white image F - File Format This option indicates the type of file format in which to save the image. 0F KIM format 1F TIFF binary 2F TIFF binary group 4, compressed 3F TIFF grayscale 4F Uncompressed Binary 5F Uncompressed grayscale 6F JPEG image (default) 7F Outlined image 8F BMP format Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 249 H - Height of Signature Capture Area The height of the signature capture area must be measured in inches divided by .01. In the example, the height of the area to be captured is 3/8 inch, resulting in a value of H = .375/0.01 = 37.5. Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y. K - Gamma Correction Gamma measures the brightness of midtone values produced by the image. You can brighten or darken an image using gamma correction. A higher gamma correction yields an overall brighter image. The lower the setting, the darker the image. The optimal setting for text images is 50K. Example: 0K Gamma correction off (default) 50K Apply gamma correction for brightening typical document image nK Apply gamma correction factor n (n = 1-255) Gamma Correction set to 0K: Gamma Correction set to 50K: Gamma Correction set to 255K: R - Resolution of Signature Capture Area The resolution is the number of pixels that the scanner outputs per each minimum bar width. The higher the value for R, the higher the quality of the image, but also the larger the file size. Values begin at 1000. The scanner automatically inserts a 250 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com decimal point between the first and second digit. For example, use 2500 to specify a resolution of 2.5. Set to zero when using the A and B modifiers (see A - Output Image Width and B - Output Image Height on page 249). Example: Resolution set to 0R: Resolution set to 1000R: Resolution set to 2000R: S - Bar Code Aspect Ratio All dimensions used in IMGBOX are measured as multiples of the minimum element size of the bar code. The bar code aspect ratio allows you to set the ratio of the bar code height to the narrow element width. In the example, the narrow element width is .010 inches and the bar code height is 0.400 inches, resulting in a value of S = 0.4/0.01 = 40. W - Width of Signature Capture Area The width of the signature capture area must be measured in inches divided by .01. In the example, the width of the area to be captured is 2.4 inches, resulting in a value of W = 2.4/0.01 = 240. (A value of 245 was used in the example to accommodate a slightly wider image area.) Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y. X - Horizontal Bar Code Offset The horizontal bar code offset allows you to offset the horizontal center of the signature capture area. Positive values move the horizontal center to the right and negative values to the left. Measurements are in multiples of the minimum bar width. Example: Horizontal Offset set to 75X: Horizontal Offset set to -75X: Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 251 Y - Vertical Bar Code Offset The vertical bar code offset allows you to offset the vertical center of the signature capture area. Negative numbers indicate that the signature capture is above the bar code, and positive numbers indicate that the area is below the bar code. Measurements are in multiples of the minimum bar width Example: . Vertical Offset set to -7Y: Vertical Offset set to 65Y: RF Default Imaging Device The scanner supports imaging command processing (IMGSHP, IMGSNP, IMGBOX) so that EZConfig-Scanning (see page 255) and other applications are able to perform imaging functions as if they were communicating directly with a scanner. To accomplish this, the scanner uses a menu command called RF_DID (RF Default Imaging Device). RF_DID is the name of the scanner (BT_NAM) that is to receive imaging commands. The default for RF_DID is “*”indicating that imaging commands are to be sent to all associated scanners. Change this setting to RF_DIDscanner_name to ensure that they are sent to a particular scanner. Refer to "Page" on page 3-51 to generate a report containing the port, work group, scanner name, and address for each scanner. Refer to "Scanner Name" on page 3-65 set a unique name for each scanner. 252 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 11 UTILITIES To Add a Test Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies This selection allows you to turn on transmission of a Code I.D. before the decoded symbology. (See the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327) for the single character code that identifies each symbology.) This action first clears all current prefixes, then programs a Code I.D. prefix for all symbologies. This is a temporary setting that will be removed when the unit is power cycled. Add Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies (Temporary) Show Decoder Revision Scan the bar code below to output the decoder revision. Show Decoder Revision Show Scan Driver Revision Scan the bar code below to output the scan driver revision. The scan driver controls image capture. Show Scan Driver Revision Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 253 Show Software Revision Scan the bar code below to output the current software revision, unit serial number, and other product information for both the scanner and base. Show Software Revision Show Data Format Scan the bar code below to show current data format settings. DFMBK3?. Data Format Settings Test Menu When you scan the Test Menu On code, then scan a programming code in this manual, the scanner displays the content of a programming code. The programming function will still occur, but in addition, the content of that programming code is output to the terminal. Note: This feature should not be used during normal scanner operation. On * Off TotalFreedom TotalFreedom is an open system architecture that makes it possible for you create applications that reside on your scanner. Decoding apps and Data Formatting apps can be created using TotalFreedom. For further information about TotalFreedom, go to our website at www.honeywellaidc.com. 254 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Application Plug-Ins (Apps) Any apps that you are using can be turned off or on by scanning the following bar codes. Apps are stored in groups: Decoding, and Formatting. You can enable and disable these groups of apps by scanning that group’s On or Off bar code below. You can also scan the List Apps bar code to output a list of all your apps. * Decoding Apps On Decoding Apps Off * Formatting Apps On Formatting Apps Off List Apps Note: You must reset your device in order for the apps setting to take effect. EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Introduction EZConfig Cloud for Scanning provides a wide range of PC-based programming functions that can be performed on a scanner connected to your PC. EZConfig Cloud for Scanning allows you to download upgrades to the scanner's firmware, change programmed parameters, and create and print programming bar codes. Using EZConfig Cloud for Scanning, you can even save/open the programming parameters for a scanner. This saved file can be e-mailed or, if required, you can create a single bar code that contains all the customized programming parameters and mail or fax that bar code to any location. Users in other locations can scan the bar code to load in the customized programming. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 255 EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Operations The EZConfig Cloud for Scanning software performs the following operations: Scan Data Scan Data allows you to scan bar codes and display the bar code data in a window. Scan Data lets you send serial commands to the scanner and receive scanner response that can be seen in the Scan Data window. The data displayed in the Scan Data window can either be saved in a file or printed. Configure Configure displays the programming and configuration data of the scanner. The scanner's programming and configuration data is grouped into different categories. Each category is displayed as a tree item under the "Configure" tree node in the application explorer. When one of these tree nodes is clicked, the right-hand side is loaded with the parameters' form belonging to that particular category. The "Configure" tree option has all the programming and configuration parameters specified for a scanner. You can set or modify these parameters as required. You can later write the modified settings to the scanner, or save them to a dcf file. Imaging Imaging provides all the image-related functions that a 2D Scanner can perform. You can capture an image using the current settings, and the image will be displayed in an image window. Images captured from the scanner can be saved to files in different image formats. You can modify the image settings and save the image settings to an INI file, which can be loaded later to capture new images. Imaging also lets you preview the images continuously captured by the scanner. Install EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Use the EZConfig Cloud for Scanning tool to configure your scanner online: 1. Access the Honeywell web site at www.honeywellaidc.com 2. Click on the Browse Products tab. Under Software, select Device Management. 3. Click on EZConfig Cloud for Scanning. 4. Scroll to the bottom of the page and click on Register for free access now to sign up. 256 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Reset the Factory Defaults Caution: This selection erases all your settings and resets the scanner to the original factory defaults. It also disables all plugins. If you aren’t sure what programming options are in your scanner, or you’ve changed some options and want to restore the scanner to factory default settings, first scan the Remove Custom Defaults bar code, then scan Activate Defaults. This resets the scanner to the factory default settings. Remove Custom Defaults Activate Defaults Note: If using a cordless system, scanning the Activate Defaults bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base to re-establish the link before any setup codes are entered. If using an Access Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information. The Menu Commands, beginning on page 264, list the factory default settings for each of the commands (indicated by an asterisk (*) on the programming pages). Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 257 258 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 12 SERIAL PROGRAMMING COMMANDS The serial programming commands can be used in place of the programming bar codes. Both the serial commands and the programming bar codes will program the scanner. For complete descriptions and examples of each serial programming command, refer to the corresponding programming bar code in this manual. The device must be set to an RS232 interface (see page 16). The following commands can be sent via a PC COM port using terminal emulation software. Conventions The following conventions are used for menu and query command descriptions: parameter A label representing the actual value you should send as part of a command. [option] An optional part of a command. {Data} Alternatives in a command. bold Names of menus, menu commands, buttons, dialog boxes, and windows that appear on the screen. Menu Command Syntax Menu commands have the following syntax (spaces have been used for clarity only): Prefix [:Name:] Tag SubTag {Data} [, SubTag {Data}] [; Tag SubTag {Data}] […] Storage Prefix Three ASCII characters: SYN M CR (ASCII 22,77,13). :Name: This command is only used with cordless devices. It is used to specify whether you’re communicating with the base or the scanner. To send information to the scanner (with the base connected to host), use :Xenon: The default factory setting for a Xenon scanner is Xenon Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 259 scanner. This setting is changed by using the BT_NAM command, which accepts alphanumeric values. If the name is not known, a wildcard (*) can be used :* Note: Since the base stores all work group settings and transfers to them to scanner once they are linked, changes are typically done to the base and not to the scanner. Tag A 3 character case-insensitive field that identifies the desired menu command group. For example, all RS232 configuration settings are identified with a Tag of 232. SubTag A 3 character case-insensitive field that identifies the desired menu command within the tag group. For example, the SubTag for the RS232 baud rate is BAD. Data The new value for a menu setting, identified by the Tag and SubTag. Storage A single character that specifies the storage table to which the command is applied. An exclamation point (!) performs the command’s operation on the device’s volatile menu configuration table. A period (.) performs the command’s operation on the device’s non-volatile menu configuration table. Use the non-volatile table only for semipermanent changes you want saved through a power cycle. Query Commands Several special characters can be used to query the device about its settings. ^ What is the default value for the setting(s). ? What is the device’s current value for the setting(s). * What is the range of possible values for the setting(s). (The device’s response uses a dash (-) to indicate a continuous range of values. A pipe (|) separates items in a list of non-continuous values.) :Name: Field Usage (Optional) This command returns the query information from the scanner. Tag Field Usage When a query is used in place of a Tag field, the query applies to the entire set of commands available for the particular storage table indicated by the Storage field of the command. In this case, the SubTag and Data fields should not be used because they are ignored by the device. 260 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SubTag Field Usage When a query is used in place of a SubTag field, the query applies only to the subset of commands available that match the Tag field. In this case, the Data field should not be used because it is ignored by the device. Data Field Usage When a query is used in place of the Data field, the query applies only to the specific command identified by the Tag and SubTag fields. Concatenation of Multiple Commands Multiple commands can be issued within one Prefix/Storage sequence. Only the Tag, SubTag, and Data fields must be repeated for each command in the sequence. If additional commands are to be applied to the same Tag, then the new command sequence is separated with a comma (,) and only the SubTag and Data fields of the additional command are issued. If the additional command requires a different Tag field, the command is separated from previous commands by a semicolon (;). Responses The device responds to serial commands with one of three responses: ACK Indicates a good command which has been processed. ENQ Indicates an invalid Tag or SubTag command. NAK Indicates the command was good, but the Data field entry was out of the allowable range for this Tag and SubTag combination, e.g., an entry for a minimum message length of 100 when the field will only accept 2 characters. When responding, the device echoes back the command sequence with the status character inserted directly before each of the punctuation marks (the period, exclamation point, comma, or semicolon) in the command. Examples of Query Commands In the following examples, a bracketed notation [ ] depicts a non-displayable response. Example: What is the range of possible values for Codabar Coding Enable? Enter: cbrena*. Response: CBRENA0-1[ACK] Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 261 This response indicates that Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) has a range of values from 0 to 1 (off and on). Example: What is the default value for Codabar Coding Enable? Enter: cbrena^. Response: CBRENA1[ACK] This response indicates that the default setting for Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) is 1, or on. Example: What is the device’s current setting for Codabar Coding Enable? Enter: cbrena?. Response: CBRENA1[ACK] This response indicates that the device’s Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) is set to 1, or on. Example: What are the device’s settings for all Codabar selections? Enter: cbr?. Response: CBRENA1[ACK], SSX0[ACK], CK20[ACK], CCT1[ACK], MIN2[ACK], MAX60[ACK], DFT[ACK]. This response indicates that the device’s Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) is set to 1, or on; the Start/Stop Character (SSX) is set to 0, or Don’t Transmit; the Check Character (CK2) is set to 0, or Not Required; concatenation (CCT) is set to 1, or Enabled; the Minimum Message Length (MIN) is set to 2 characters; the Maximum Message Length (MAX) is set to 60 characters; and the Default setting (DFT) has no value. Trigger Commands You can activate and deactivate the scanner with serial trigger commands. First, the scanner must be put in Manual Trigger Mode by scanning a Manual Trigger Mode bar code (page 117), or by sending a serial menu command for triggering (page 119). Once the scanner is in serial trigger mode, the trigger is activated and deactivated by sending the following commands: 262 Activate: SYN T CR Deactivate: SYN U CR Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com The scanner scans until a bar code has been read, until the deactivate command is sent, or until the serial time-out has been reached (see Read Time-Out on page 119 for a description, and the serial command on page 276). Reset the Custom Defaults If you want the custom default settings restored to your scanner, scan the Activate Custom Defaults bar code below. This resets the scanner to the custom default settings. If there are no custom defaults, it will reset the scanner to the factory default settings. Any settings that have not been specified through the custom defaults will be defaulted to the factory default settings. Activate Custom Defaults Note: If using a cordless system, scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base to re-establish the link. If using an Access Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information. The charts on the following pages list the factory default settings for each of the commands (indicated by an asterisk (*) on the programming pages). Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 263 Menu Commands Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Set Custom Defaults MNUCDP 12 Save Custom Defaults MNUCDS 12 Reset the Custom Defaults Activate Custom Defaults DEFALT 13 Reset the Factory Defaults cordless scanners Factory Default Settings: All Application Groups PAPDFT& 68 Reset the Custom Defaults cordless scanners Custom Default Settings: All Application Groups PAPDFT 69 Keyboard Wedge: IBM PC AT and Compatibles with CR suffix (not supported by Granit 1980i) PAP_AT 15 Laptop Direct Connect with CR suffix (not supported by Granit 1980i) PAPLTD 16 RS232 Serial Port PAP232 16 IBM Port 5B Interface PAPP5B 16 IBM Port 9B HHBCR-1 Interface PAP9B1 16 IBM Port 17 Interface PAPP17 17 IBM Port 9B HHBCR-2 Interface PAP9B2 17 RS485 Packet Mode On RTLPDF1 17 RS485 Packet Mode Off RTLPDF0 17 RS485 Packet Length (20-256) RTLMPS 18 USB IBM SurePos Handheld PAPSPH 18 USB IBM SurePos Tabletop PAPSPT 18 USB Keyboard (PC) PAP124 18 USB Keyboard (Mac) PAP125 19 USB Japanese Keyboard (PC) TRMUSB134 19 USB HID PAP131 19 USB Serial TRMUSB130 19 CTS/RTS Emulation On USBCTS1 19 CTS/RTS Emulation Off* USBCTS0 20 ACK/NAK Mode On USBACK1 20 ACK/NAK Mode Off* USBACK0 20 ReM Off REMIFC0 20 ReM On REMIFC1 20 Selection Product Default Settings Set Custom Defaults Program the Interface Plug and Play Codes Plug and Play Codes: RS485 Plug and Play Codes: IBM SurePos Plug and Play Codes: USB Remote MasterMind for USB 264 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Plug and Play Codes Verifone Ruby Terminal PAPRBY 20 Gilbarco Terminal PAPGLB 21 Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port PAPBIO 21 Datalogic Magellan Aux Port PAPMAG 21 NCR Bioptic Aux Port PAPNCR 22 Wincor Nixdorf Terminal PAPWNX 22 Wincor Nixdorf Beetle PAPBTL 22 Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A (not supported by all Granit models) PAPWMA 23 *U.S.A. KBDCTY0 23 Albania KBDCTY35 23 Azeri (Cyrillic) KBDCTY81 24 Azeri (Latin) KBDCTY80 24 Belarus KBDCTY82 24 Belgium KBDCTY1 24 Bosnia KBDCTY33 24 Brazil KBDCTY16 24 Brazil (MS) KBDCTY59 24 Bulgaria (Cyrillic) KBDCTY52 24 Bulgaria (Latin) KBDCTY53 24 Canada (French legacy) KBDCTY54 24 Canada (French) KBDCTY18 24 Canada (Multilingual) KBDCTY55 24 Croatia KBDCTY32 25 Czech KBDCTY15 25 Czech (Programmers) KBDCTY40 25 Czech (QWERTY) KBDCTY39 25 Czech (QWERTZ) KBDCTY38 25 Denmark KBDCTY8 25 Dutch (Netherlands) KBDCTY11 25 Estonia KBDCTY41 25 Faroese KBDCTY83 25 Finland KBDCTY2 25 France KBDCTY3 25 Gaelic KBDCTY84 25 Germany KBDCTY4 26 Program Keyboard Country Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 265 Selection 266 Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Greek KBDCTY17 26 Greek (220 Latin) KBDCTY64 26 Greek (220) KBDCTY61 26 Greek (319 Latin) KBDCTY65 26 Greek (319) KBDCTY62 26 Greek (Latin) KBDCTY63 26 Greek (MS) KBDCTY66 26 Greek (Polytonic) KBDCTY60 26 Hebrew KBDCTY12 26 Hungarian (101 key) KBDCTY50 26 Hungary KBDCTY19 26 Iceland KBDCTY75 27 Irish KBDCTY73 27 Italian (142) KBDCTY56 27 Italy KBDCTY5 27 Japan ASCII KBDCTY28 27 Kazakh KBDCTY78 27 Kyrgyz (Cyrillic) KBDCTY79 27 Latin America KBDCTY14 27 Latvia KBDCTY42 27 Latvia (QWERTY) KBDCTY43 27 Lithuania KBDCTY44 27 Lithuania (IBM) KBDCTY45 27 Macedonia KBDCTY34 28 Malta KBDCTY74 28 Mongolian (Cyrillic) KBDCTY86 28 Norway KBDCTY9 28 Poland KBDCTY20 28 Polish (214) KBDCTY57 28 Polish (Programmers) KBDCTY58 28 Portugal KBDCTY13 28 Romania KBDCTY25 28 Russia KBDCTY26 28 Russian (MS) KBDCTY67 28 Russian (Typewriter) KBDCTY68 28 SCS KBDCTY21 29 Serbia (Cyrillic) KBDCTY37 29 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Keyboard Conversion Keyboard Style Control Character Output Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Serbia (Latin) KBDCTY36 29 Slovakia KBDCTY22 29 Slovakia (QWERTY) KBDCTY49 29 Slovakia (QWERTZ) KBDCTY48 29 Slovenia KBDCTY31 29 Spain KBDCTY10 29 Spanish variation KBDCTY51 29 Sweden KBDCTY23 29 Switzerland (French) KBDCTY29 29 Switzerland (German) KBDCTY6 29 Tatar KBDCTY85 30 Turkey F KBDCTY27 30 Turkey Q KBDCTY24 30 Ukrainian KBDCTY76 30 United Kingdom KBDCTY7 30 United Stated (Dvorak right) KBDCTY89 30 United States (Dvorak left) KBDCTY88 30 United States (Dvorak) KBDCTY87 30 United States (International) KBDCTY30 30 Uzbek (Cyrillic) KBDCTY77 30 *Keyboard Conversion Off KBDCNV0 32 Convert all Characters to Upper Case KBDCNV1 32 Convert all Characters to Lower Case KBDCNV2 32 *Regular KBDSTY0 31 Caps Lock KBDSTY1 31 Shift Lock KBDSTY2 31 Automatic Caps Lock KBDSTY6 31 Emulate External Keyboard KBDSTY5 31 *Control Character Output Off KBDNPE0 32 *Control Character Output On KBDNPE1 32 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 267 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Keyboard Modifiers *Control + X Off KBDCAS0 33 DOS Mode Control + X KBDCAS1 33 Windows Mode Control + X KBDCAS2 33 Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix Off KBDCAS3 33 *Turbo Mode Off KBDTMD0 33 Turbo Mode On KBDTMD1 33 *Numeric Keypad Off KBDNPS0 34 Numeric Keypad On KBDNPS1 34 *Auto Direct Connect Off KBDADC0 34 Auto Direct Connect On KBDADC1 34 300 BPS 232BAD0 34 600 BPS 232BAD1 34 1200 BPS 232BAD2 34 2400 BPS 232BAD3 34 4800 BPS 232BAD4 35 9600 BPS 232BAD5 35 19200 BPS 232BAD6 35 38400 BPS 232BAD7 35 57600 BPS 232BAD8 35 *115200 BPS 232BAD9 35 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even 232WRD3 35 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None 232WRD0 35 7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd 232WRD6 35 7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Even 232WRD4 36 7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity None 232WRD1 36 7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Odd 232WRD7 36 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even 232WRD5 36 *8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None 232WRD2 36 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd 232WRD8 36 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Mark 232WRD14 36 Range 0 - 300 seconds 232LPT### 36 Baud Rate Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits, and Parity RS232 Receiver Time-out 268 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page RS232 Handshaking *RTS/CTS Off 232CTS0 37 Flow Control, No Timeout 232CTS1 37 Two-Direction Flow Control 232CTS2 37 Flow Control with Timeout 232CTS3 37 RS232 Timeout 232DEL#### 37 *XON/XOFF Off 232XON0 38 XON/XOFF On 232XON1 38 *ACK/NAK Off 232ACK0 38 ACK/NAK On 232ACK1 38 *Packet Mode Off 232PKT0 39 Packet Mode On 232PKT2 39 *Bioptic ACK/NAK Off 232NAK0 39 Bioptic ACK/NAK On 232NAK1 39 ACK/NAK Timeout *5100 232DLK##### 39 Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i This section applies only to cordless systems. It does not apply to corded scanners or Xenon 1902g-BF scanners. Replace a Linked Scanner Override locked Scanner (Single Scanner) BT_RPL1 43 Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode *Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode On BEPPGE2 46 *10 Second Timeout TRGTPM10000 46 60 Second Timeout TRGTPM60000 46 *On :*:BASRED1 50 Off :*:BASRED0 50 Reset Scanner Reset Scanner RESET_ 50 Scan While in Base Cradle Scan in Cradle Off BT_SIC0 50 *Scan in Cradle On (CCB01010BT default) BT_SIC1 50 Shut Down Scanner in Cradle BT_SIC2 50 Base Charge Off BASCHG0 51 *External or Interface Cable Power BASCHG1 51 External Power Only BASCHG2 51 *On BEPPGE1 51 Off BEPPGE0 51 Range 400 - 9000 Hz (*1000) BEPPFQ#### 51 Base Power Communication Indicator Base Charge Modes Page Mode Page Pitch Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 269 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Beeper Pitch - Base Error *Razz (250) (min 200Hz) BASFQ2250 53 Medium (3250) BASFQ23250 53 High (4200) (max 9000Hz) BASFQ24200 53 *1 BASERR3 53 Range 1 - 9 BASERR# 53 Scanner Report Scanner Report RPTSCN 53 Scanner Address Scanner Address BT_LDA 53 Base Address Base Address :*:BASLDA 54 Scanner Modes Charge Only Mode :*:BASLNK0 54 *Charge and Link Mode :*:BASLNK1 54 Locked Link Mode BASCON0,DNG1 55 *Open Link Mode BASCON1,DNG1 55 Unlink Scanner BT_RMV 55 Override Locked Scanner BT_RPL1 56 Base Alarm Duration (Range 1 3000 sec (*0)) BASORD 56 Scanner Alarm Duration (Range 1 - 3000 sec (*0)) BT_ORD 56 Base Alarm Type BASORW 57 Scanner Alarm Type BT_ORW 57 Timer (0-7200 seconds) BT_LPT0 58 200 Seconds BT_LPT200 58 400 Seconds BT_LPT400 58 900 Seconds BT_LPT900 58 3600 Seconds BT_LPT3600 58 7200 Seconds BT_LPT7200 58 *Full Power BT_TXP100 59 Medium Power BT_TXP35 59 Medium Low Power BT_TXP5 59 Low Power BT_TXP1 59 Automatic Batch Mode BATENA1 60 *Batch Mode Off BATENA0 60 Inventory Batch Mode BATENA2 60 Persistent Batch Mode BATENA3 60 Off BATBEP0 60 *On BATBEP1 60 *Flash Storage BATNVS1 61 RAM Storage BATNVS0 61 Number of Beeps - Base Error Out-of-Range Alarm Alarm Sound Type Scanner Power Time-Out Timer Flexible Power Management Batch Mode Batch Mode Beep Batch Mode Storage 270 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Batch Mode Quantity *Off BATQTY0 61 On BATQTY1 61 0 BATNUM0 62 *1 BATNUM1 62 2 BATNUM2 62 3 BATNUM3 62 4 BATNUM4 63 5 BATNUM5 63 6 BATNUM6 63 7 BATNUM7 63 8 BATNUM8 63 9 BATNUM9 63 *FIFO BATLIF0 63 LIFO BATLIF1 63 Total Records Total Records BATNRC 64 Delete Last Code Delete Last Code BATUND 64 Clear All Codes Clear All Codes BATCLR 64 Transmit Records to Host Transmit Inventory Records BAT_TX 64 Batch Mode Transmit Delay *Off BATDLY0 64 Short (ms) BATDLY250 65 Medium (ms) BATDLY500 65 Long (ms) BATDLY1000 65 Multiple Scanner Operation Multiple Scanner Operation BASCON2,DNG3 65 Scanner Name Name 1-7 BT_NAM##### 66 Reset RESET_ 66 Scanner Name BT_NAM 67 Application Work Group Selections *Group 0 GRPSEL0 67 Group 1-6 GRPSEL# 68 Reset the Factory Defaults: All Application Work Groups Factory Default Settings: All Work Groups PAPDFT& 68 Reset the Custom Defaults: All Application Work Groups Custom Default Settings: All Work Groups PAPDFT 69 Bluetooth Connection *Bluetooth SSP On BT_SSP1 69 Bluetooth SSP Off BT_SSP0 69 Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect PAPBTH 70 Bluetooth HID Japanese Keyboard Connect PAPJKB 70 Quantity Codes Batch Mode Output Order Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 271 Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect PAPSPP 71 Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/ Laptops BT_TRM0;BT_DNG5 72 BT Connection - PDA/Mobility Systems Device BT_TRM0;BT_DNG1 72 Bluetooth PIN Code BT_PIN 72 *Auto Reconnect On BT_ACM1 73 Auto Reconnect Off BT_ACM0 73 Maximum Link Attempts Maximum Link Attempts BT_MLA### 74 Relink Time-Out Relink Time-Out (*3) BT_RLT### 74 Host Command Acknowledgment Host ACK On HSTACK1 77 *Host ACK Off HSTACK0 77 Host ACK Timeout HSTATO## 77 Setting * Indicates default Selection Auto Reconnect Mode Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF This section applies only to Xenon 1902g-BF systems. It does not apply to corded scanners or other cordless systems. Replace a Linked Scanner Override locked Scanner (Single Scanner) BT_RPL1 80 Low Power Alert Range *Low Power Alert 10-30% LPIRAG0 85 Low Power Alert 10-50% LPIRAG1 85 Low Power Alert Flash Number Range 1-9 (*3) LPIFNO 85 Interval Between Flashes Range 1-9 seconds (*2) LPIFDL 85 Low Power Alert Repeat Range 1-5 (*1) LPI_NO 85 Interval Between Alerts Range 10-120 seconds (*10) LPI_DL 86 Low Power Alert Beep Low Power Alert Beep Off LPIBEP0 86 *Low Power Alert Beep On LPIBEP1 86 Range 0 - 300000 ms (*10000) TRGTPM###### 89 *10 Second Timeout TRGTPM10000 89 30 Second Timeout TRGTPM30000 89 1 minute Timeout TRGTPM60000 89 2 Minute Timeout TRGTPM120000 89 3 Minute Timeout TRGTPM180000 89 Base Power Communication Indicator *On :*:BASRED1 87 Off :*:BASRED0 87 Reset Scanner Reset Scanner RESET_ 87 Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout 272 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Scan While in Base Cradle Scan in Cradle Off BT_SIC0 90 *Scan in Cradle On BT_SIC1 90 Shut Down Scanner in Cradle BT_SIC2 90 Base Charge Off BASCHG0 88 *External or Interface Cable Power BASCHG1 88 External Power Only BASCHG2 88 *On BEPPGE1 90 Off BEPPGE0 90 Range 400 - 9000 Hz (*1000) BEPPFQ#### 91 *Low (1000 Hz) BEPPFQ1000 91 Medium (3250 Hz) BEPPFQ3250 91 High (4200 Hz) BEPPFQ4200 91 *Linking Sound BT_ACS1 91 Silent Linking BT_ACS0 91 *Razz (250) (min 200Hz) BASFQ2250 92 Medium (3250) BASFQ23250 92 High (4200) (max 9000Hz) BASFQ24200 92 Number of Beeps - Base Error Range 1 - 9 (*1) BASERR# 92 Scanner Report Scanner Report RPTSCN 92 Scanner Address Scanner Address BT_LDA 92 Base or Access Point Address Base Address :*:BASLDA 93 Scanner Modes Charge Only Mode :*:BASLNK0 93 *Charge and Link Mode :*:BASLNK1 93 Locked Link Mode BASCON0,DNG1 94 *Open Link Mode BASCON1,DNG1 94 Unlink Scanner BT_RMV 94 Override Locked Scanner BT_RPL1 95 Base Alarm Duration (Range 1 3000 sec (*0)) BASORD 95 Scanner Alarm Duration (Range 1 - 3000 sec (*0)) BT_ORD 95 Base Alarm Type BASORW 95 Scanner Alarm Type BT_ORW 95 Base Charge Modes Page Mode Page Pitch Linking Sound Beeper Pitch - Base Error Out-of-Range Alarm Alarm Sound Type Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 273 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Scanner Power Time-Out Timer Timer (0-7200 seconds) BT_LPT0 96 200 Seconds BT_LPT200 97 *400 Seconds BT_LPT400 97 900 Seconds BT_LPT900 97 3600 Seconds BT_LPT3600 97 7200 Seconds BT_LPT7200 97 Full Power BT_TXP8 98 *Medium High Power BT_TXP7 98 Medium Power BT_TXP4 98 Low Power BT_TXP1 98 Automatic Batch Mode BATENA1 99 *Batch Mode Off BATENA0 98 Inventory Batch Mode BATENA2 99 Persistent Batch Mode BATENA3 99 Off BATBEP0 99 *On BATBEP1 99 *Flash Storage BATNVS1 99 RAM Storage BATNVS0 99 *Off BATQTY0 100 On BATQTY1 100 0 BATNUM0 101 *1 BATNUM1 101 2 BATNUM2 101 3 BATNUM3 101 4 BATNUM4 101 5 BATNUM5 101 6 BATNUM6 101 7 BATNUM7 101 8 BATNUM8 102 9 BATNUM9 102 *FIFO BATLIF0 102 LIFO BATLIF1 102 Total Records Total Records BATNRC 102 Delete Last Code Delete Last Code BATUND 102 Clear All Codes Clear All Codes BATCLR 103 Transmit Records to Host Transmit Inventory Records BAT_TX 103 Flexible Power Management Batch Mode Batch Mode Beep Batch Mode Storage Batch Mode Quantity Quantity Codes Batch Mode Output Order 274 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Batch Mode Transmit Delay *Off BATDLY0 103 Short (ms) BATDLY250 103 Medium (ms) BATDLY500 103 Long (ms) BATDLY1000 103 Name 1-7 BT_NAM##### 105 Reset RESET_ 104 Scanner Name BT_NAM 105 Bluetooth Connection Bluetooth PIN Code BT_PIN 105 Auto Reconnect Mode *Auto Reconnect On BT_ACM1 105 Auto Reconnect Off BT_ACM0 105 Maximum Link Attempts Maximum Link Attempts (*4) BT_MLA### 106 Relink Time-Out Relink Time-Out (*2) BT_RLT### 107 Host Command Acknowledgment Host ACK On HSTACK1 109 *Host ACK Off HSTACK0 109 Host ACK Timeout HSTATO## 109 Power Up Beeper Off - Scanner BEPPWR0 111 *Power Up Beeper On - Scanner BEPPWR1 111 Power Up Beeper Off - Cordless Base BASPWR0 111 Power Up Beeper On - Cordless Base BASPWR1 111 Beep on BEL On BELBEP1 112 *Beep on BEL Off BELBEP0 112 On BEPTRG1 112 *Off BEPTRG0 112 Off BEPBEP0 112 *On BEPBEP1 112 Off BEPLVL0 112 *Low (Default-Xenon HC) BEPLVL1 113 Medium BEPLVL2 113 *High BEPLVL3 113 Low (1600) (min 400Hz) BEPFQ11600 113 *Medium - Xenon (2700 Hz) BEPFQ12700 113 *Medium - Granit (3200 Hz) BEPFQ13200 113 High (4200) (max 9000Hz) BEPFQ14200 113 Vibrate - Good Read Off TFBGRD0 113 *Vibrate - Good Read On TFBGRD1 113 Scanner Name Input/Output Selections Power Up Beeper Beep on BEL Character Trigger Click Beeper - Good Read Beeper Volume - Good Read Beeper Pitch - Good Read (Frequency) Vibrate - Good Read Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 275 Setting * Indicates default Selection Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Vibrate Duration Duration (100 - 2,000 ms) *300 TFBDUR#### 114 Beeper Pitch - Error (Frequency) *Razz (250) (min 200Hz) BEPFQ2800 114 Medium (3250) BEPFQ23250 114 High (4200) (max 9000Hz) BEPFQ24200 114 *Normal Beep BEPBIP0 115 Short Beep BEPBIP1 115 Off BEPLED0 115 *On BEPLED1 115 *1 BEPERR3 115 Range 1 - 9 BEPERR# 115 *1 BEPRPT1 115 Range 1 - 9 BEPRPT# 115 Beeper Volume Max Beeper Volume Max PAPBLM 116 Good Read Delay *No Delay DLYGRD0 116 Short Delay (500 ms) DLYGRD500 116 Medium Delay (1000 ms) DLYGRD1000 116 Long Delay (1500 ms) DLYGRD1500 116 User-Specified Good Read Delay Range 0 - 30,000 ms DLYGRD##### 117 Trigger Modes *Manual Trigger - Normal PAPHHF 117 Manual Trigger - Enhanced (not supported by Granit 1980i and 1981i) PAPHHS 117 *Trigger Toggle Off TRGTGM0 118 Trigger Toggle - Image Capture TRGTGM1 118 Trigger Toggle Off - Cell Phone Read TRGTGM2 118 Trigger Toggle Off - Centering TRGTGM3 118 2 Quick Triggers TRGTPC2 118 3 Quick Triggers TRGTPC3 118 Beeper Duration - Good Read LED - Good Read Number of Beeps - Error Number of Beeps - Good Read Trigger Toggle Trigger Number 4 Quick Triggers TRGTPC4 118 Trigger Timing Trigger Timing (Range 50 - 2000) *400 TRGTTI#### 118 Trigger Toggle Timeout Trigger Toggle Timeout (Range 0 65) *5 TRGTGT## 119 Serial Trigger Mode Read Time-Out (0 - 300,000 ms) *30,000 TRGSTO#### 119 Presentation Mode Presentation Mode PAPTPR 120 Presentation LED Behavior After Decode *LEDs On TRGPCK1 120 LEDs Off TRGPCK0 120 276 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Presentation Sensitivity (not supported by Granit 1980i and 1981i) Range 0-20 (*1) TRGPMS## 120 Presentation Centering Window Presentation Centering On PDCWIN1 122 *Presentation Centering Off PDCWIN0 122 Left of Presentation Centering Window (*40%) PDCLFT### 122 Right of Presentation Centering Window (*60%) PDCRGT### 122 Top of Presentation Centering Window (*40%) PDCTOP### 122 Bottom of Presentation Centering Window (*60%) PDCBOT### 122 Sensor On TRGSSW1 123 Sensor Off TRGSSW0 123 Poor Quality 1D Reading On DECLDI1 123 *Poor Quality 1D Reading Off DECLDI0 123 Poor Quality PDF Reading On PDFXPR1 124 *Poor Quality PDF Reading Off PDFXPR0 124 *CodeGate Off Out-of-Stand AOSCGD0. 124 CodeGate On Out-of-Stand AOSCGD1. 124 Streaming Presentation Mode Normal PAPSPN 125 Streaming Presentation Mode Enhanced (not supported by Granit 1980i and 1981i) PAPSPE 125 Hand Held Scanning - Mobile Phone PAPHHC 125 Streaming Presentation - Mobile Phone PAPSPC 125 Hands Free Time-Out Range 0 - 300,000 ms TRGPTO###### 126 Reread Delay Short (500 ms) DLYRRD500 126 *Medium (750 ms) DLYRRD750 126 Long (1000 ms) DLYRRD1000 126 Extra Long (2000 ms) DLYRRD2000 126 User-Specified Range 0 - 30,000 ms DLYRRD##### 127 2D Reread Delay *2D Reread Delay Off DLY2RR0 127 Short (1000ms) DLY2RR1000 127 Medium (2000ms) DLY2RR2000 127 Long (3000ms) DLY2RR3000 127 Extra Long (4000ms) DLY2RR4000 127 Selection In-Stand Sensor Mode Poor Quality Codes CodeGate Streaming Presentation Mobile Phone Read Mode (not supported by Granit 1980i and 1981i) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 277 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Character Activation Mode *Off HSTCEN0 127 On HSTCEN1 127 Activation Character (Range 0255) *12 [DC2] HSTACH### 128 Do Not End Character Activation After Good Read HSTCGD0 128 End Character Activation After Good Read HSTCGD1 128 Character Activation Timeout (Range 1 - 300,000) *30,000 ms HSTCDT###### 129 *Off HSTDEN0 129 On HSTDEN1 129 Deactivation Character (Range 0255) *14 [DC4] HSTDCH### 129 *Lights On SCNLED1 130 Lights Off SCNLED0 130 200 milliseconds SCNDLY200 130 400 milliseconds SCNDLY400 130 *Off (no delay) SCNDLY0 130 User-Specified Aimer Delay Range 0 - 4,000 ms SCNDLY#### 131 Aimer Mode (not supported by Granit 1980i and 1981i) Off SCNAIM0 131 *Interlaced SCNAIM2 131 Single Code Centering Single Code Centering DECWIN1;DECTOP49;DECBOT 51;DECRGT51;DECLFT49 132 Centering Window Centering On DECWIN1 133 *Centering Off DECWIN0 133 Left of Centering Window (*40%) DECLFT### 134 Right of Centering Window (*60%) DECRGT### 134 Top of Centering Window (*40%) DECTOP### 134 Bottom of Centering Window (*60%) DECBOT### 134 On PRFENA1 134 *Off PRFENA0 135 High Priority Symbology PRFCOD## 135 Low Priority Symbology PRFBLK## 135 Preferred Symbology Timeout (*500) Range 100-3000 PRFPTO#### 135 Preferred Symbology Default PRFDFT 136 Enter Sequence SEQBLK 138 Default Sequence SEQDFT 138 Character Deactivation Mode Illumination Lights Aimer Delay Preferred Symbology Output Sequence Editor 278 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Partial Sequence Transmit Partial Sequence SEQTTS1 139 *Discard Partial Sequence SEQTTS0 139 Required SEQ_EN2 139 On/Not Required SEQ_EN1 139 *Off SEQ_EN0 139 On SHOTGN1 139 *Off SHOTGN0 139 On SHWNRD1 140 *Off SHWNRD0 140 Video Reverse Only VIDREV1 141 Video Reverse and Standard Bar Codes VIDREV2 141 *Video Reverse Off VIDREV0 141 *Upright ROTATN0 141 Vertical, Bottom to Top (Rotate CCW 90°) ROTATN1 142 Upside Down ROTATN2 142 Vertical, Top to Bottom (Rotate CW 90°) ROTATN3 142 Silent Mode with Flashing LED Cordless Scanner and Base beplfn5;beplfr50;beppar0;basp wr0;beppwr0;baslvl0;beplvl0;be pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot0. 143 Silent Mode with Flashing LED Corded Scanner beplfn5;beplfr50;beppwr0;beplv l0;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot 0. 143 Silent Mode with Long LED Cordless Scanner and Base beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar0;basp wr0;beppwr0;baslvl0;beplvl0;be pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot1. 144 Silent Mode with Long LED Corded Scanner beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr0;beplv l0;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot 1. 144 Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode) - Cordless Scanner and Base beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar0;basp wr0;beppwr1;baslvl1;beplvl1;be pbip1;bepFQ14200;beplot0. 144 Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode) - Corded Scanner beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr1;beplv l1;bepbip1;bepFQ14200;beplot 0. 144 Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) Cordless Scanner and Base beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar1;basp wr1;beppwr1;baslvl1;beplvl1;be pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot0. 145 Require Output Sequence Multiple Symbols No Read Video Reverse Working Orientation Healthcare Selections Quiet Operations - Combination Codes Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 279 Setting * Indicates default Selection Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) Corded Scanner Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr1;beplv l1;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot 0. 145 *Green LED Flashes/Sound BEPPAR1 145 Red LED Flashes/Silent BEPPAR0 145 *1 LED Flash BEPLFN0 146 5 LED Flashes BEPLFN5 146 10 LED Flashes BEPLFN10 146 25 LED Flashes BEPLFN25 146 *Fast Flash BEPLFR50 146 Medium Flash BEPLFR250 146 Slow Flash BEPLFR500 146 *LED Solid Off (Resume Flash) BEPLOT0 147 LED Solid 1 Second BEPLOT1 147 LED Solid 3 Seconds BEPLOT3 147 LED Solid 5 Seconds BEPLOT5 147 Page Volume Off BEPPGV0 147 *Page Volume Low BEPPGV1 147 Page Volume Medium BEPPGV2 148 Page Volume High BEPPGV3 148 Base Alarm Volume Off BASORV0 148 Scanner Alarm Volume Off BT_ORV0 148 *Base Alarm Volume Low BASORV1 148 *Scanner Alarm Volume Low BT_ORV1 148 Base Alarm Volume Medium BASORV2 148 Scanner Alarm Volume Medium BT_ORV2 149 Base Alarm Volume High BASORV3 149 Scanner Alarm Volume High BT_ORV3 149 Out-of-Range Delay (*0 No Delay) Range 0-3000 BT_ORY#### 149 VSUFCR 153 Add Prefix PREBK2## 153 Clear One Prefix PRECL2 153 Clear All Prefixes PRECA2 153 Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings Linking LED Colors and Sound Number of LED Flashes LED Flash Rate LED Solid (No Flash) Page Volume Control Out-of-Range Alarm Volume Out-of-Range Delay Prefix/Suffix Selections Add CR Suffix to All Symbologies Prefix 280 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Suffix Add Suffix SUFBK2## 153 Clear One Suffix SUFCL2 153 Clear All Suffixes SUFCA2 153 *Enable RMVFNC0 154 Disable RMVFNC1 154 Intercharacter Delay Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments) DLYCHR## 154 User Specified Intercharacter Delay Delay Length 0 - 1000 (5ms increments) DLYCRX## 155 Character to Trigger Delay DLY_XX## 155 Interfunction Delay Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments) DLYFNC## 155 Intermessage Delay Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments) DLYMSG## 156 *Default Data Format (None) DFMDF3 158 Enter Data Format DFMBK3## 159 Clear One Data Format DFMCL3 159 Clear All Data Formats DFMCA3 159 Data Formatter Off DFM_EN0 173 *Data Formatter On, Not Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix DFM_EN1 174 Data Format Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix DFM_EN2 174 Data Formatter On, Not Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix DFM_EN3 174 Data Format Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix DFM_EN4 174 *Data Format Non-Match Error Tone On DFMDEC0 174 Data Format Non-Match Error Tone Off DFMDEC1 174 Primary Data Format ALTFNM0 175 Data Format 1 ALTFNM1 175 Data Format 2 ALTFNM2 175 Data Format 3 ALTFNM3 175 Single Scan-Primary Data Format VSAF_0 175 Single Scan-Data Format 1 VSAF_1 175 Single Scan-Data Format 2 VSAF_2 175 Single Scan-Data Format 3 VSAF_3 176 Function Code Transmit Data Formatter Selections Data Format Editor Data Formatter Data Format Non-Match Error Tone Primary/Alternate Data Formats Single Scan Data Format Change Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 281 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page All Symbologies Off ALLENA0 178 All Symbologies On ALLENA1 178 Default All Codabar Settings CBRDFT 179 Off CBRENA0 179 *On CBRENA1 179 *Don’t Transmit CBRSSX0 179 Transmit CBRSSX1 179 *No Check Char. CBRCK20 179 Validate, But Don’t Transmit CBRCK21 179 Validate, and Transmit CBRCK22 179 *Off CBRCCT0 180 On CBRCCT1 180 Require CBRCCT2 180 Minimum (2 - 60) *4 CBRMIN## 181 Maximum (2 - 60) *60 CBRMAX## 181 Default All Code 39 Settings C39DFT 181 Off C39ENA0 181 *On C39ENA1 181 *Don’t Transmit C39SSX0 181 Transmit C39SSX1 181 *No Check Char. C39CK20 182 Validate, But Don’t Transmit C39CK21 182 Validate, and Transmit C39CK22 182 Minimum (0 - 48) *0 C39MIN## 182 Maximum (0 - 48) *48 C39MAX## 182 *Off C39APP0 183 On C39APP1 183 *Off C39B320 183 On C39B321 183 *Off C39ASC0 183 On C39ASC1 183 Code 39 Code Page C39DCP 183 Symbologies All Symbologies Codabar Codabar Start/Stop Char. Codabar Check Char. Codabar Concatenation Codabar Message Length Code 39 Code 39 Start/Stop Char. Code 39 Check Char. Code 39 Message Length Code 39 Append Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF) Code 39 Full ASCII 282 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Default All Interleaved 2 of 5 Settings I25DFT 185 Off I25ENA0 185 *On I25ENA1 185 *No Check Char. I25CK20 185 Validate, But Don’t Transmit I25CK21 185 Validate, and Transmit I25CK22 185 Minimum (2 - 80) *4 I25MIN## 186 Maximum (2 - 80) *80 I25MAX## 186 Default All NEC 2 of 5 Settings N25DFT 186 Off N25ENA0 186 *On N25ENA1 186 *No Check Char. N25CK20 186 Validate, But Don’t Transmit N25CK21 186 Validate, and Transmit N25CK22 186 Minimum (2 - 80) *4 N25MIN## 187 Maximum (2 - 80) *80 N25MAX## 187 Default All Code 93 Settings C93DFT 187 Off C93ENA0 187 *On C93ENA1 187 Minimum (0 - 80) *0 C93MIN## 188 Maximum (0 - 80) *80 C93MAX## 188 On C93APP1 188 *Off C93APP0 188 Code 93 Code Page Code 93 Code Page C93DCP 188 Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Default All Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Settings R25DFT 189 *Off R25ENA0 189 On R25ENA1 189 Minimum (1 - 48) *4 R25MIN## 189 Maximum (1 - 48) *48 R25MAX## 189 Straight 2 of 5 IATA Default All Straight 2 of 5 IATA Settings A25DFT 190 Straight 2 of 5 IATA *Off A25ENA0 190 On A25ENA1 190 Range (0 - 10) *0 A25VOT## 190 Setting * Indicates default Selection Interleaved 2 of 5 Interleaved 2 of 5 Check Digit Interleaved 2 of 5 Message Length NEC 2 of 5 NEC 2 of 5 Check Digit NEC 2 of 5 Message Length Code 93 Code 93 Message Length Code 93 Append Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Message Length Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 283 Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Straight 2 of 5 IATA Message Length Minimum (1 - 48) *4 A25MIN## 190 Maximum (1 - 48) *48 A25MAX## 190 Matrix 2 of 5 Default All Matrix 2 of 5 Settings X25DFT 191 *Off X25ENA0 191 On X25ENA1 191 Minimum (1 - 80) *4 X25MIN## 191 Maximum (1 - 80) *80 X25MAX## 191 Default All Code 11 Settings C11DFT 192 *Off C11ENA0 192 On C11ENA1 192 1 Check Digit C11CK20 192 *2 Check Digits C11CK21 192 Minimum (1 - 80) *4 C11MIN## 192 Maximum (1 - 80) *80 C11MAX## 192 Default All Code 128 Settings 128DFT 193 Off 128ENA0 193 *On 128ENA1 193 *Off ISBENA0 193 On ISBENA1 193 Code 128 Redundancy Range (0 - 10) *0 128VOT## 193 Code 128 Message Length Minimum (0 - 80) *0 128MIN## 194 Maximum (0 - 80) *80 128MAX## 194 *On 128APP1 194 Off 128APP0 194 Code 128 Code Page Code 128 Code Page (*2) 128DCP## 194 GS1-128 Default All GS1-128 Settings GS1DFT 195 *On GS1ENA1 195 Off GS1ENA0 195 Minimum (1 - 80) *1 GS1MIN## 195 Maximum (0 - 80) *80 GS1MAX## 195 Default All Telepen Settings TELDFT 196 *Off TELENA0 196 On TELENA1 196 *AIM Telepen Output TELOLD0 196 Original Telepen Output TELOLD1 196 Selection Matrix 2 of 5 Message Length Code 11 Code 11 Check Digits Required Code 11 Message Length Code 128 ISBT Concatenation Code 128 Append GS1-128 Message Length Telepen Telepen Output 284 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Telepen Message Length Minimum (1 - 60) *1 TELMIN## 196 Maximum (1 - 60) *60 TELMAX## 196 Default All UPC-A Settings UPADFT 197 Off UPBENA0 197 *On UPBENA1 197 Off UPACKX0 197 *On UPACKX1 197 Off UPANSX0 198 *On UPANSX1 198 *Off UPAAD20 198 On UPAAD21 198 *Off UPAAD50 198 On UPAAD51 198 *Not Required UPAARQ0 198 Required UPAARQ1 198 Addenda Timeout Range (0 - 120) *500 DLYADD##### 199 UPC-A Addenda Separator Off UPAADS0 199 *On UPAADS1 199 UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code *Off CPNENA0 199 Allow Concatenation CPNENA1 199 Require Concatenation CPNENA2 199 Addenda Timeout Range (0 - 120) *500 DLYADD##### 200 Coupon GS1 DataBar Output GS1 Output Off CPNGS10 200 GS1 Output On CPNGS11 200 Default All UPC-E Settings UPEDFT 201 Off UPEEN00 201 *On UPEEN01 201 *Off UPEEXP0 201 On UPEEXP1 201 Required UPEARQ1 201 *Not Required UPEARQ0 201 Addenda Timeout Range (0 - 120) *500 DLYADD##### 202 UPC-E0 Addenda Separator *On UPEADS1 202 Off UPEADS0 202 Off UPECKX0 202 *On UPECKX1 202 UPC-A UPC-A Check Digit UPC-A Number System UPC-A 2 Digit Addenda UPC-A 5 Digit Addenda UPC-A Addenda Required UPC-E0 UPC-E0 Expand UPC-E0 Addenda Required UPC-E0 Check Digit Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 285 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page UPC-E0 Leading Zero Off UPENSX0 203 *On UPENSX1 203 2 Digit Addenda On UPEAD21 203 *2 Digit Addenda Off UPEAD20 203 5 Digit Addenda On UPEAD51 203 *5 Digit Addenda Off UPEAD50 203 *Off UPEEN10 203 On UPEEN11 203 Default All EAN/ JAN Settings E13DFT 204 Off E13ENA0 204 *On E13ENA1 204 UPC-A Converted to EAN-13 UPAENA0 204 Do not Convert UPC-A UPAENA1 204 Off E13CKX0 205 *On E13CKX1 205 2 Digit Addenda On E13AD21 205 *2 Digit Addenda Off E13AD20 205 5 Digit Addenda On E13AD51 205 *5 Digit Addenda Off E13AD50 205 *Not Required E13ARQ0 205 Required E13ARQ1 205 Addenda Timeout Range (0 - 120) *500 DLYADD##### 206 EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Separator Off E13ADS0 206 *On E13ADS1 206 *Off E13ISB0 206 On E13ISB1 206 Default All EAN/ JAN 8 Settings EA8DFT 207 Off EA8ENA0 207 *On EA8ENA1 207 Off EA8CKX0 207 *On EA8CKX1 207 *2 Digit Addenda Off EA8AD20 207 2 Digit Addenda On EA8AD21 207 *5 Digit Addenda Off EA8AD50 207 5 Digit Addenda On EA8AD51 207 UPC-E0 Addenda UPC-E1 EAN/JAN-13 Convert UPC-A to EAN-13 EAN/JAN-13 Check Digit EAN/JAN-13 2 Digit Addenda EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Required ISBN Translate EAN/JAN-8 EAN/JAN-8 Check Digit EAN/JAN-8 Addenda 286 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Required *Not Required EA8ARQ0 208 Required EA8ARQ1 208 Addenda Timeout Range (0 - 120) *500 DLYADD##### 208 EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Separator Off EA8ADS0 208 *On EA8ADS1 208 Default All MSI Settings MSIDFT 209 *Off MSIENA0 209 On MSIENA1 209 *Validate Type 10, but Don’t Transmit MSICHK0 209 Validate Type 10 and Transmit MSICHK1 209 Validate 2 Type 10 Chars, but Don’t Transmit MSICHK2 210 Validate 2 Type 10 Chars and Transmit MSICHK3 210 Validate Type 11 then Type 10 Char, but Don’t Transmit MSICHK4 210 Validate Type 11 then Type 10 Char and Transmit MSICHK5 210 Disable MSI Check Characters MSICHK6 210 Minimum (4 - 48) *4 MSIMIN## 210 Maximum (4 - 48) *48 MSIMAX## 210 Default All GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional Settings RSSDFT 211 Off RSSENA0 211 *On RSSENA1 211 Default All GS1 DataBar Limited Settings RSLDFT 211 Off RSLENA0 211 *On RSLENA1 211 Default All GS1 DataBar Expanded Settings RSEDFT 212 Off RSEENA0 212 *On RSEENA1 212 Minimum (4 - 74) *4 RSEMIN## 212 Maximum (4 - 74) *74 RSEMAX## 212 *Off TRIENA0 212 On TRIENA1 212 MSI MSI Check Character MSI Message Length GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional GS1 DataBar Limited GS1 DataBar Expanded GS1 DataBar Expanded Msg. Length Trioptic Code Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 287 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Codablock A Default All Codablock A Settings CBADFT 213 *Off CBAENA0 213 On CBAENA1 213 Minimum (1 - 600) *1 CBAMIN### 213 Maximum (1 - 600) *600 CBAMAX### 213 Default All Codablock F Settings CBFDFT 214 *Off CBFENA0 214 On CBFENA1 214 Minimum (1 - 2048) *1 CBFMIN#### 214 Maximum (1 - 2048) *2048 CBFMAX#### 214 On LBLENA1 214 * Off LBLENA0 214 Default All PDF417 Settings PDFDFT 215 *On PDFENA1 215 Off PDFENA0 215 Minimum (1-2750) *1 PDFMIN#### 215 Maximum (1-2750) *2750 PDFMAX#### 215 *On PDFMAC1 216 Off PDFMAC0 216 Default All Micro PDF417 Settings MPDDFT 216 On MPDENA1 216 *Off MPDENA0 216 Minimum (1-366) *1 MPDMIN### 216 Maximum (1-366) *366 MPDMAX### 216 On COMENA1 217 *Off COMENA0 217 On COMUPC1 217 *Off COMUPC0 217 Minimum (1-2435) *1 COMMIN#### 217 Maximum (1-2435) *2435 COMMAX#### 217 GS1-128 Emulation EANEMU1 218 GS1 DataBar Emulation EANEMU2 217 GS1 Code Expansion Off EANEMU3 218 EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion EANEMU4 218 *GS1 Emulation Off EANEMU0 218 On T39ENA1 219 *Off T39ENA0 219 Codablock A Msg. Length Codablock F Codablock F Msg. Length Label Code PDF417 PDF417 Msg. Length MacroPDF417 MicroPDF417 MicroPDF417 Msg. Length GS1 Composite Codes UPC/EAN Version GS1 Composite Codes Msg. Length GS1 Emulation TCIF Linked Code 39 288 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page QR Code Default All QR Code Settings QRCDFT 219 *On QRCENA1 219 Off QRCENA0 219 Minimum (1-7089) *1 QRCMIN#### 219 Maximum (1-7089) *7089 QRCMAX#### 219 *On QRCAPP1 220 Off QRCAPP0 220 QR Code Page QR Code Page (*3) QRCDCP## 220 Data Matrix Default All Data Matrix Settings IDMDFT 221 *On IDMENA1 221 Off IDMENA0 221 Minimum (1-3116) *1 IDMMIN#### 221 Maximum (1-3116) *3116 IDMMAX#### 221 *On IDMAPP1 221 Off IDMAPP0 221 Data Matrix Code Page Data Matrix Code Page (*51) IDMDCP## 222 MaxiCode Default All MaxiCode Settings MAXDFT 222 On MAXENA1 222 *Off MAXENA0 222 Minimum (1-150) *1 MAXMIN### 223 Maximum (1-150) *150 MAXMAX### 223 Default All Aztec Code Settings AZTDFT 223 *On AZTENA1 223 Off AZTENA0 223 Minimum (1-3832) *1 AZTMIN#### 223 Maximum (1-3832) *3832 AZTMAX#### 223 *On AZTAPP1 224 Off AZTAPP0 224 Aztec Code Page Aztec Code Page (*51) AZTDCP## 224 Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code Default All Han Xin Code Settings HX_DFT 224 On HX_ENA1 224 *Off HX_ENA0 224 Minimum (1-7833) *1 HX_MIN#### 225 Maximum (1-7833) *7833 HX_MAX#### 225 *Off POSTAL0 225 QR Code Msg. Length QR Code Append Data Matrix Msg. Length Data Matrix Append MaxiCode Msg. Length Aztec Code Aztec Code Msg. Length Aztec Append Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code Msg. Length Postal Codes - 2D 2D Postal Codes Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 289 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Single 2D Postal Codes Australian Post On POSTAL1 225 British Post On POSTAL7 225 Canadian Post On POSTAL30 225 Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL10 226 Japanese Post On POSTAL3 226 KIX Post On POSTAL4 226 Planet Code On POSTAL5 226 Postal-4i On POSTAL9 226 Postnet On POSTAL6 226 Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL11 226 InfoMail On POSTAL2 226 InfoMail and British Post On POSTAL8 226 Intelligent Mail Bar Code and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL20 227 Postnet and Postal-4i On POSTAL14 227 Postnet and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL16 227 Postal-4i and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL17 227 Postal-4i and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL19 227 Planet and Postnet On POSTAL12 227 Planet and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL18 227 Planet and Postal-4i On POSTAL13 227 Planet and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL15 227 Planet, Postnet, and Postal-4i On POSTAL21 227 Planet, Postnet, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL22 228 Planet, Postal-4i, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL23 228 Postnet, Postal-4i, and Intelligent Mail Bar Code On POSTAL24 228 Planet, Postal-4i, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL25 228 Planet, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL26 228 Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL27 228 Combination 2D Postal Codes 290 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Planet, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet On POSTAL28 228 Planet, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and Postnet with B and B’ Fields On POSTAL29 228 Transmit PLNCKX1 229 *Don’t Transmit PLNCKX0 229 Transmit NETCKX1 229 *Don’t Transmit NETCKX0 229 Bar Output AUSINT0 229 Numeric N Table AUSINT1 230 Alphanumeric C Table AUSINT2 230 Combination N and C Tables AUSINT3 230 Default All China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Settings CPCDFT 230 *Off CPCENA0 230 On CPCENA1 230 Minimum (2 - 80) *4 CPCMIN## 230 Maximum (2 - 80) *80 CPCMAX## 230 Default All Korea Post Settings KPCDFT 231 *Off KPCENA0 231 On KPCENA1 231 Minimum (2 - 80) *4 KPCMIN## 231 Maximum (2 - 80) *48 KPCMAX## 231 Transmit Check Digit KPCCHK1 231 *Don’t Transmit Check Digit KPCCHK0 231 Default all Imaging Commands IMGDFT 233 Imaging Style - Decoding SNPSTY0 234 *Imaging Style - Photo SNPSTY1 234 Imaging Style - Manual SNPSTY2 234 Beeper On SNPBEP1 234 *Beeper Off SNPBEP0 234 *Wait for Trigger Off SNPTRG0 235 Wait for Trigger On SNPTRG1 235 *LED State - Off SNPLED0 235 LED State - On SNPLED1 235 Exposure (1-7874 microseconds) SNPEXP 235 Setting * Indicates default Selection Planet Code Check Digit Postnet Check Digit Australian Post Interpretation Postal Codes - Linear China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Msg. Length Korea Post Korea Post Msg. Length Korea Post Check Digit Imaging Default Commands Image Snap Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 291 Selection Image Ship 292 Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page *Gain - None SNPGAN1 236 Gain - Medium SNPGAN2 236 Gain - Heavy SNPGAN4 236 Gain - Maximum SNPGAN8 236 Target White Value (0-255) *125 SNPWHT### 236 Delta for Acceptance (0-255) *25 SNPDEL### 236 Update Tries (0-10) *6 SNPTRY## 237 Target Set Point Percentage (199) *50 SNPPCT## 237 *Infinity Filter - Off IMGINF0 238 Infinity Filter - On IMGINF1 238 *Compensation Off IMGCOR0 238 Compensation On IMGCOR1 238 *Pixel Depth - 8 bits/pixel (grayscale) IMGBPP8 238 Pixel Depth - 1 bit/pixel (B&W) IMGBPP1 238 *Don’t Sharpen Edges IMGEDG0 239 Sharpen Edges (0-23) IMGEDG## 239 *File Format - JPEG IMGFMT6 240 File Format - KIM IMGFMT0 240 File Format - TIFF binary IMGFMT1 240 File Format - TIFF binary group 4, compressed IMGFMT2 240 File Format - TIFF grayscale IMGFMT3 240 File Format - Uncompressed binary IMGFMT4 240 File Format - Uncompressed grayscale IMGFMT5 240 File Format - BMP IMGFMT8 240 *Histogram Stretch Off IMGHIS0 240 Histogram Stretch On IMGHIS1 240 *Noise Reduction Off IMGFSP0 241 Noise Reduction On IMGFSP1 241 Invert Image around X axis IMGNVX1 241 Invert Image around Y axis IMGNVY1 241 Rotate Image none IMGROT0 242 Rotate Image 90° right IMGROT1 242 Rotate Image 180° right IMGROT2 242 Rotate Image 90° left IMGROT3 242 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page JPEG Image Quality (0-100) *50 IMGJQF### 242 *Gamma Correction Off IMGGAM0 243 Gamma Correction On (0-1000) IMGGAM### 243 Image Crop - Left (0-843) *0 IMGWNL### 243 Image Crop - Right (0-843) *843 IMGWNR### 243 Image Crop - Top (0-639) *0 IMGWNT### 243 Image Crop - Bottom (0-639) *639 IMGWNB### 244 Image Crop - Margin (1-238) *0 IMGMAR### 244 Protocol - None (raw) IMGXFR0 244 Protocol - None (default USB) IMGXFR2 244 Protocol - Hmodem Compressed IMGXFR3 244 Protocol - Hmodem IMGXFR4 244 Ship Every Pixel IMGSUB1 245 Ship Every 2nd Pixel IMGSUB2 245 Ship Every 3rd Pixel IMGSUB3 245 *Document Image Filter Off IMGUSH0 245 Document Image Filter On (0255) IMGUSH### 245 *Don’t Ship Histogram IMGHST0 246 Ship Histogram IMGHST1 246 Force VGA Resolution IMGVGA1 246 *Native Resolution IMGVGA0 247 Optimize On DECBND1 247 *Optimize Off DECBND0 247 Add Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies (Temporary) PRECA2,BK2995C80! 253 Show Decoder Revision REV_DR 253 Show Scan Driver Revision REV_SD 253 Show Software Revision REVINF 254 Show Data Format DFMBK3? 254 On TSTMNU1 254 *Off TSTMNU0 254 *Decoding Apps On PLGDCE1 255 Decoding Apps Off PLGDCE0 255 *Formatting Apps On PLGFOE1 255 Formatting Apps Off PLGFOE0 255 List Apps PLGINF 255 Selection Image Size Compatibility Intelligent Signature Capture Utilities Test Menu Application Plug-Ins (Apps) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 293 Selection Setting * Indicates default Serial Command # Indicates a numeric entry Page Reset the Factory Defaults Remove Custom Defaults DEFOVR 257 Activate Defaults DEFALT 257 294 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 13 PRODUCT SPECIFICATIONS Xenon 1900/1900h/1910 Corded Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 6.3 inches (160mm) Length 4.1 inches (104.1mm) Width 2.8 inches (71.1mm) Weight 5.2 ounces (147.42g) Electrical Voltage Requirements 4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector Current Draw @5VDC B&W Color ScanningStandby 470mA, 2.35W90mA, .45W 490mA, 2.45W90mA, .45W Power Supply Noise Rejection Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 624nm + 18nm (red LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” 442nm, 552nm (white LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Peak Wavelength LED 624nm + 18nm (red LED) 520nm + 18nm (green LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Optical Power Laser <1mW Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating +32F to +122F (0C to 50C) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 295 Parameter (Continued) Specification Storage -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity 0 to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6 feet (1.83m) to concrete at 23°C Vibration Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz ESD Tolerance Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Image Image Size 838 x 640 pixels Scan Performance Skew Angle +65° Pitch Angle +45° Motion Tolerance: Streaming Presentation Trigger up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC Symbol Contrast Grade 1.0 (20% or greater) Xenon 1902/1902h/1912 Cordless Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 6.3 inches (160mm) Length 4.1 inches (104.1mm) Width 2.8 inches (71.1mm) Weight 7.5 ounces (212.62g) Electrical Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 624nm + 18nm (red LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” 442nm, 552nm (white LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Peak Wavelength LED 624nm + 18nm (red LED) 520nm + 18nm (green LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Optical Power Laser <1mW Battery Lithium Ion 296 2400 mAHr minimum Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Parameter (Continued) Number of Scans Specification Up to 50,000 per charge Expected Hours of Operation 14 Expected Charge Time 4.5 hours Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 33 ft. (10 m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating 32 F to +122 F (0 C to 50 C) Storage with battery* -4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90 days -4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365 days Storage without battery -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6 feet (1.8 m) to concrete Vibration Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz ESD Sensitivity Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP41 Image Image Size 838 x 640 pixels Scan Performance Skew Angle +65° Pitch Angle +45° Motion Tolerance: Streaming Presentation Trigger up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC Symbol Contrast Grade 1.0 (20% or greater) *Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 297 Xenon 1902g-BF Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 6.3 inches (160mm) Length 4.1 inches (104.1mm) Width 2.8 inches (71.1mm) Weight 6.9 ounces (195g) Electrical Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 624nm + 18nm (red LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” 442nm, 552nm (white LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Peak Wavelength LED 624nm + 18nm (red LED) 520nm + 18nm (green LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Optical Power Laser <1mW Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 33 ft. (10 m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating 32 F to +122 F (0 C to 50 C) Storage -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.3 feet (1 m) to concrete Vibration Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz ESD Sensitivity Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP41 Image Image Size 838 x 640 pixels Scan Performance 298 Skew Angle +65° Pitch Angle +45° Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Parameter (Continued) Specification Motion Tolerance: Up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC Symbol Contrast Grade 1.0 (20% or greater) Granit 1910i Industrial Corded Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 7.7 in. (195.6mm) Length 5.2 in. (132.1mm) Width 2.9 in. (73.7mm) Weight 10.6 oz. (300g) Electrical Voltage Requirements 4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector Current Draw @5VDC ScanningStandby 470mA, 2.35W100mA, 5W Power Supply Noise Rejection Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 624nm + 18nm (red LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Optical Power Laser <1mW Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating -22F to +122F (-30C to 50C) Storage -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity 0 to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet (1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Tolerance Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP65 Image Image Size 838 x 640 pixels Scan Performance Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 299 Parameter (Continued) Specification Skew Angle +65° Pitch Angle +45° Motion Tolerance: Streaming Presentation Trigger: 13 mil UPC 240 inches per second at 6.5 in. (16.5cm) 150 inches per second at 10 in. (25.4cm) Symbol Contrast Grade 1.0 (20% or greater) Granit 1911i Industrial Cordless Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 7.7 in. (195.6mm) Length 5.2 in. (132.1mm) Width 2.9 in. (73.7mm) Weight 13.8 oz. (390g) Electrical Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 624nm + 18nm (red LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Optical Power Laser <1mW Battery Lithium Ion Number of Scans 1800 mAHr minimum Up to 50,000 per charge Expected Hours of Operation 14 Expected Charge Time 4.5 hours Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 330 ft. (100m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental 300 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Parameter (Continued) Specification Temperature Ranges: Operating while not charging -4F to + 122F (-20C to 50C) Operating while charging 41F to + 104F (5C to 40C) Storage with battery* -4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90 days -4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365 days Storage without battery -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet (1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Sensitivity Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP65 Image Image Size 838 x 640 pixels Scan Performance Skew Angle +65° Pitch Angle +45° Motion Tolerance: Streaming Presentation Trigger: 13 mil UPC 240 inches per second at 6.5 in. (16.5cm) 150 inches per second at 10 in. (25.4cm) Symbol Contrast Grade 1.0 (20% or greater) *Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life. Granit 1980i Industrial Full Range Corded Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 7.7 in. (195.6mm) Length 5.2 in. (132.1mm) Width 2.9 in. (73.7mm) Weight 11.8 oz. (335g) Electrical Voltage Requirements 4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 301 Parameter (Continued) Specification Current Draw @5VDC ScanningStandby 470mA, 2.35W100mA, 0.5W Power Supply Noise Rejection Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 617nm + 18nm (amber LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Optical Power Laser <1mW Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating -22F to +122F (-30C to 50C) Storage -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity 0 to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet (1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Tolerance Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP65 Image Image Size 1280 x 800 pixels Scan Performance Skew Angle +80° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC Pitch Angle +70°typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC Motion Tolerance: 30 inches per second typical on 13 mil UPC/EAN bar code 8 in. from scanner nose Symbol Contrast 1D codes 30% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 13 mil) 2D codes 40% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 20 mil) Granit 1981i Industrial Full Range Cordless Scanner Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical 302 Height 7.7 in. (195.6mm) Length 5.2 in. (132.1mm) Width 2.9 in. (73.7mm) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Parameter (Continued) Specification Weight 14.8 oz. (420g) Electrical Illumination LED: Peak Wavelength 617nm + 18nm (amber LED) IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group” Aiming: Peak Wavelength Laser 650nm IEC 60825-1: “Class 2” Optical Power Laser <1mW Battery Battery: Lithium Ion Number of Scans 1800 mAHr minimum at least 7200 scans (1 scan every 4 seconds for 8 hours) Expected Hours of Operation 8 Expected Charge Time 4.5 hours Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 330 ft. (100m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating while not charging -4F to + 122F (-20C to 50C) Operating while charging 41F to + 104F (5C to 40C) Storage with battery* -4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90 days -4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365 days Storage without battery -40F to +158F (-40C to 70C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet (1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Sensitivity Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Sealant Rating IP65 Image Image Size 1280 x 800 pixels Scan Performance Skew Angle +80° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 303 Parameter (Continued) Specification Pitch Angle +70° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC Motion Tolerance: 30 inches per second typical on 13 mil UPC/EAN bar code 8 in. from scanner nose Symbol Contrast 1D codes 30% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 13 mil) 2D codes 40% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 20 mil) *Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life. CCB01-010BT Charge Base Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 3.2 inches (81.3mm) Length 5.19 inches (131.8mm) Width 3.98 inches (101.1mm) Weight 6.3 oz (179g) Electrical Voltage: 4.5 to 5.5 volts Current Draw: Host Terminal Port 500mA Aux Power Port 1A Charge Time 5 hours Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 33 ft. (10 m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental Temperature Ranges: 304 Operating 32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C) Storage -40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet (1 m) to concrete Vibration 5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz ESD Sensitivity Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 3.2 inches (81.3mm) Length 5.19 inches (131.8mm) Width 3.98 inches (101.1mm) Weight 6.3 oz (179g) Electrical Voltage: 4.5 to 5.5 volts Current Draw: Host Terminal Port 500mA Aux Power Port 1A Charge Time From shut down to fully charged: 3 minutes via standard USB only 1 minute via powered USB with external power Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.4.2 Range 33 ft. (10 m) typical Data Rate Up to 130 kbps Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating 32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C) Battery Charge 32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C) Storage without battery -40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet (1 m) to concrete Vibration 5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz ESD Sensitivity Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Industrial Charge Base Product Specifications Parameter Specification Mechanical Height 2.6 in. (66mm) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 305 Parameter (Continued) Specification Length 9.8 in. (248.9mm) Width 4.05 in. (102.9cm) Weight 10.05 oz. (285g) Electrical Voltage: 4.5 to 5.5 volts Current Draw: Host Terminal Port 500mA Aux Power Port 1A Charge Time 5 hours Radio Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range 330 ft. (100m) typical Data Rate Up to 1 MBps Environmental Temperature Ranges: Operating -4 F to +122 F (-20 C to +50 C) Battery Charge 41 F to +104 F (5 C to +40 C) Storage without battery -40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.94 feet (1.2m) to concrete Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Sensitivity Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane Depth of Field Charts Xenon B&W Scanner Typical Performance Focus High Density (HD) Standard Range (SR) Extended Range (ER) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance in. .2 3.8 1.6 5.3 3.7 8 mm 5.1 96.5 40.6 134.6 94 203.2 in. .5 6.5 .3 16.7 1 20.7 mm 12.7 165.1 7.6 424.2 25.4 525.8 5 mil Code 39 13 mil UPC 306 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Focus (Continued) High Density (HD) Standard Range (SR) Extended Range (ER) Symbology (Continued) Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance 20 mil Code 39 in. .6 8.6 .4 24.6 1 23.5 mm 15.2 218.4 10.2 624.8 25.4 596.9 in. .4 4 .7 6 2.8 9.2 mm 10.2 101.6 17.8 152.4 71.1 233.7 in. .3 4.2 .8 7 2.5 11.3 mm 7.6 106.7 20.3 177.8 63.5 287 in. .7 7 .5 14.8 .7 19 mm 17.8 177.8 12.7 375.9 17.8 482.6 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 3 mil (.076mm) 5 mil (.127mm) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 5 mil (.127mm) 6.7 mil (.170mm) 7.5 mil (.191mm) Xenon B&W Scanner Guaranteed Performance Focus High Density (HD) Standard Range (SR) Extended Range (ER) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance in. .3 3.3 2.1 5.1 4.2 7.8 mm 7.62 83.8 53.3 129.5 106.7 198.1 in. .7 6.1 .4 15.6 1.1 19.7 mm 17.8 154.9 10.2 396.2 27.9 500.4 in. .7 7.8 .5 20.2 1.5 25 mm 17.8 198.1 12.7 513.1 38.1 635 in. .5 3.8 .9 5.8 3.3 8.7 mm 12.7 96.5 22.9 147.3 83.8 221 in. .4 3.8 .9 6.6 3.4 10.3 mm 10.2 96.5 22.9 167.6 86.4 261.6 in. 1.2 6.4 .7 13 .9 18 mm 30.5 162.6 17.8 330.2 22.9 457.2 5 mil Code 39 13 mil UPC 20 mil Code 39 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 3 mil (.076mm) 5 mil (.127mm) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 5 mil (.127mm) 6.7 mil (.170mm) 7.5 mil (.191mm) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 307 Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Typical Performance Focus High Density (HD) Standard Range (SR) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance in. 0 3.6 1.1 5.2 mm 0 91.4 27.9 132.1 in. .4 5.9 .4 16.2 mm 10.2 149.9 10.2 411.5 in. .4 8.4 .5 22 mm 10.2 213.4 12.7 558.8 in. 0 3.8 .4 6 mm 0 96.5 10.2 152.4 in. 0 4.2 .5 7 mm 0 106.7 12.7 177.8 in. .4 6.8 .6 13.4 mm 10.2 172.7 15.2 340.4 5 mil Code 39 13 mil UPC 20 mil Code 39 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 3 mil (.076mm) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 5 mil (.127mm) 6.7 mil (.170mm) Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Guaranteed Performance Focus High Density (HD) Standard Range (SR) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance Near Distance Far Distance in. 0 3.3 1.7 4.9 mm 0 83.8 43.2 124.5 in. .6 5.2 .4 14.5 mm 15.2 132.1 10.2 368.3 in. .5 7.4 .5 17.5 mm 12.7 188 12.7 444.5 in. 0 3.4 .5 5.7 mm 0 86.4 12.7 144.8 in. 0 4 .8 6.4 mm 0 101.6 20.3 162.6 in. .7 6.2 .7 12.3 mm 17.8 157.5 17.8 312.4 5 mil Code 39 13 mil UPC 20 mil Code 39 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 3 mil (.076mm) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 5 mil (.127mm) 6.7 mil (.170mm) 308 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Typical Performance Focus Extended Range (ER) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance in. 3.6 7.4 mm 91.4 188 in. .6 29.5 mm 15.2 749.3 in. .6 21.4 mm 15.2 543.6 in. 2.7 8.9 mm 68.6 226.1 in. 2.8 10.3 mm 71.1 261.6 in. .8 19.5 mm 20.3 495.3 5 mil Code 39 20 mil Code 39 100% UPC 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 7.5 mil (.191mm) Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Guaranteed Performance Focus Extended Range (ER) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance in. 3.8 7.2 mm 96.5 182.9 in. 1 28.7 mm 25.4 729 in. .6 21.7 mm 15.2 551.2 in. 3 8.5 mm 76.2 215.9 in. 3.1 9.7 mm 78.7 246.4 in. .9 19.8 mm 22.9 502.9 5 mil Code 39 20 mil Code 39 100% UPC 6.7 mil PDF417 10 mil Data Matrix 20 mil QR Code Resolution (1D Code 39) 5 mil (.127mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 7.5 mil (.191mm) Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 309 Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Typical Performance (200 lux) Focus Full Range (FR) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance in. 3.9 64.9 cm 10.0 164.9 in. 3.9 85.0 cm 10.0 216.0 in. 6.0 171.1 cm 15.2 434.5 in. 14.3 389.4 cm 36.4 989.1 in. 20.6 521.0 cm 52.2 1322.4 in. 40.7 more than 629.9 cm 103.4 more than 1600.0 in. 4.8 90.5 cm 12.2 229.8 in. 3.9 29.9 cm 10.0 75.9 in. 3.9 40.3 cm 10.0 102.3 in. 16.9 232.8 cm 42.8 591.3 in. 31.8 406.5 cm 80.7 1032.5 7.5 mil Code 39 10 mil Code 39 20 mil Code 39 40 mil Code 39 55 mil Code 39 100 mil Code 39 100% UPC 7.5 mil Data Matrix 10 mil Data Matrix 55 mil Data Matrix 100 mil Data Matrix Resolution (1D Code 39) 2 mil (.051mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 2 mil (.051mm) Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Guaranteed Performance (200 lux) Focus Full Range (FR) Symbology Near Distance Far Distance in. 3.9 62.4 cm 10.0 158.6 in. 3.9 82.1 cm 10.0 208.6 in. 6.2 165.8 cm 15.8 421.2 7.5 mil Code 39 10 mil Code 39 20 mil Code 39 310 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Focus (Continued) Full Range (FR) Symbology (Continued) Near Distance Far Distance in. 15 371.7 cm 38.1 944.1 in. 22.2 461.2 cm 56.5 1171.4 in. 47.5 more than 629.9 cm 120.7 more than 1600.0 in. 5.0 85.3 cm 12.7 216.7 in. 3.9 26.9 cm 10.0 68.3 in. 3.9 35.8 cm 10.0 90.8 in. 19.2 213.1 cm 48.7 541.2 in. 35.7 357.2 cm 90.6 907.3 40 mil Code 39 55 mil Code 39 100 mil Code 39 100% UPC 7.5 mil Data Matrix 10 mil Data Matrix 55 mil Data Matrix 100 mil Data Matrix Resolution (1D Code 39) 2 mil (.051mm) Resolution (2D Data Matrix) 2 mil (.051mm) Standard Connector Pinouts Note: The following pin assignments are not compatible with Honeywell legacy products. Use of a cable with improper pin assignments may lead to damage to the unit. Use of any cables not provided by the manufacturer may result in damage not covered by your warranty. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 311 Keyboard Wedge 10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base 1 Cable shield 2 Cable select 3 Supply ground 4 Terminal data 5 Terminal clock 6 Keyboard clock 7 +5V power 8 Keyboard data 9 10 Serial Output 10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base 1 Cable shield 2 Cable select 3 Supply ground 4 Transmit data 5 Receive data - serial data to scanner 6 CTS 7 +5V power 8 RTS 9 10 RS485 Output 10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base Note: RS485 signal conversion is performed in the cable. 312 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 1 Cable shield 2 Cable select 3 Supply ground 4 Transmit data 5 Receive data - serial data to scanner 6 7 +5V power 8 Transmit Enable 9 10 USB 10 Pin Modular Plug - connects to the base 1 Cable shield 2 Cable select 3 Supply ground 4 5 6 7 +5V power 8 9 Data + 10 Data - Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 313 Required Safety Labels Xenon 1900/1910/1902/1912 Scanner LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Illumination output Part Number, Serial Number and Revision Information location 314 Compliance Label location Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base Part Number, Serial Number and Revision Information location Compliance Label locations Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 315 Granit 1910i/1911i/1980i/1981i Scanner LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Illumination output Laser Label location Part Number, Serial Number and Revision Information location 316 Compliance label location Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base Compliance Label locations Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 317 318 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CHAPTER 14 MAINTENANCE AND TROUBLESHOOTING Repairs Repairs and/or upgrades are not to be performed on this product. These services are to be performed only by an authorized service center (see Customer Support on page xvii). Maintenance Your device provides reliable and efficient operation with a minimum of care. Although specific maintenance is not required, the following periodic checks ensure dependable operation: Cleaning the Scanner The scanner or base’s housing may be cleaned with a soft cloth or tissue dampened with water (or a mild detergent-water solution.) If a detergent solution is used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with water only. Caution: Do not submerge the scanner in water. The scanner’s housing is not watertight. Do not use abrasive wipes or tissues on the scanner’s window. Abrasive wipes may scratch the window. Never use solvents (e.g., acetone) on the housing or window. Solvents may damage the finish or the window. Cleaning the Window Reading performance may degrade if the scanner’s window is not clean. If the window is visibly dirty, or if the scanner isn’t operating well, clean the window with one of the cleaning solutions listed for Health Care Housing, below. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 319 Health Care Housing Some configurations of Xenon scanners are available with an external plastic housing that is designed to resist the effects of harsh chemicals in a health care environment. The plastic is crystalline in nature, which helps prevent chemicals from seeping through the housing. Important! The following cleaning solutions have been tested to assure safe cleaning of your scanner’s disinfectant-ready housing. They are the only solutions approved for use with these scanners. Damage caused by the use of cleaners other than those listed below may not be covered by the warranty. • ® Sani-Cloth® Plus wipes Super Sani-Cloth® wipes • Isopropyl Alcohol wipes (70%) • CaviWipes • • ® 256 409® Glass and Surface Cleaner Windex ® Blue Clorox ® Bleach – 10% • Gentle dish soap and water • • • • Sani-Cloth HB wipes ™ Virex Inspecting Cords and Connectors Inspect the interface cable and connector for wear or other signs of damage. A badly worn cable or damaged connector may interfere with scanner operation. Contact your distributor for information about cable replacement. Cable replacement instructions are on page 320. Replacing Cables in Corded Scanners The standard interface cable is attached to the scanner with an 10-pin modular connector. When properly seated, the connector is held in the scanner’s handle by a flexible retention tab. The interface cable is designed to be field replaceable. 320 • Order replacement cables from Honeywell or from an authorized distributor. • When ordering a replacement cable, specify the cable part number of the original interface cable. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Replacing a Xenon Interface Cable 1. Turn the power to the host system OFF. 2. Disconnect the scanner’s cable from the terminal or computer. 3. Locate the small hole on the back of the scanner’s handle. This is the cable release. 4. Straighten one end of a paper clip. 5. Insert the end of the paper clip into the small hole and press in. This depresses the retention tab, releasing the connector. Pull the connector out while maintaining pressure on the paper clip, then remove the paper clip. Cable Release 6. Replace with the new cable. Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly. The connector is keyed to go in only one way, and will click into place. Replacing a Granit Interface Cable 1. Turn the power to the host system OFF. 2. Disconnect the scanner’s cable from the terminal or computer. 3. Unscrew the locking plate on the bottom of the scanner. 4. Slide the locking plate away from the connector and pull the cable out of the scanner. 5. Replace with the new cable. Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly. 6. Slide the locking plate over the base of the connector to secure the cable, and screw the plate into place. Replacing Cables and Batteries in Cordless Systems Replacing an Interface Cable in a Base 1. Turn the power to the host system OFF. 2. Disconnect the base’s cable from the terminal or computer. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 321 3. Turn the base upside down. 4. Pull the connector out while maintaining pressure on the connector release clip. CCB01-010BT Base: CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base: 5. Replace with the new cable. Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly. The connector is keyed to go in only one way, and will click into place. Changing a Xenon Scanner Battery End Cap 1. Use a Phillips head screwdriver to remove the screw from the end cap. 2. Remove the end cap and remove the battery from the handle. 3. Insert replacement battery. 4. Replace end cap and screw. 322 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Changing a Granit Scanner Battery 1. Twist the tab in the bottom of the end cap and open the hinged battery door. (When new, the battery door may stick. Use pliers to twist the tab and open the door until it loosens up.) 2. Remove the battery from the handle. 3. Insert replacement battery. 4. Close the battery door and twist the tab to lock it. Note: The battery door is designed to pop off the hinge if the scanner is dropped while changing a battery. If this occurs, simply snap it back on. Troubleshooting a Corded Scanner The scanner automatically performs self-tests whenever you turn it on. If your scanner is not functioning properly, review the following Troubleshooting Guide to try to isolate the problem. Is the power on? Is the aimer on? If the aimer isn’t illuminated, check that: • The cable is connected properly. • The host system power is on (if external power isn’t used). • The trigger works. Is the scanner having trouble reading your symbols? If the scanner isn’t reading symbols well, check that the symbols: • Aren’t smeared, rough, scratched, or exhibiting voids. • Aren’t coated with frost or water droplets on the surface. • Are enabled in the scanner or in the decoder to which the scanner connects. Is the bar code displayed but not entered? Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 323 The bar code is displayed on the host device correctly, but you still have to press a key to enter it (the Enter/Return key or the Tab key, for example). • You need to program a suffix. Programming a suffix enables the scanner to output the bar code data plus the key you need (such as “CR”) to enter the data into your application. Refer to Prefix/Suffix Overview on page 151 for further information. The scanner won’t read your bar code at all. 1. Scan the sample bar codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner reads the sample bar codes, check that your bar code is readable. Verify that your bar code symbology is enabled (see Chapter 9). 2. If the scanner still can’t read the sample bar codes, scan All Symbologies On, page 178. If you aren’t sure what programming options have been set in the scanner, or if you want the factory default settings restored, refer to Reset the Factory Defaults on page 257. Troubleshooting a Cordless System Troubleshooting a Base Note: Visit the Services and Support section of our website (www.honeywellaidc.com) to check for the latest software for both the scanner and the base. If your base is not functioning properly, review the following troubleshooting guidelines to try to isolate the problem. Is the red LED on? If the red LED isn’t illuminated, check that: • The power cable is connected properly and there is power at the power source. • The host system power is on (if external power isn’t used). Is the green LED on? If the green LED isn’t illuminated, check that: 324 • The scanner is correctly placed in the base. • There is external power or 12 volt host power. • Charge mode is turned on. (See "Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning" on page 48) • The battery is not bad or deeply discharged. In some cases, the scanner’s battery may trickle charge to bring it into an acceptable level and then transition to a normal charge cycle. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Troubleshooting a Cordless Scanner Note: Make sure that your scanner’s battery is charged. Visit the Services and Support section of our website (www.honeywellaidc.com) to check for the latest software for both the scanner and the base or Access Point. Is the scanner having trouble reading your symbols? If the scanner isn’t reading symbols well, check that the symbols: • Aren’t smeared, rough, scratched, or exhibiting voids. • Aren’t coated with frost or water droplets on the surface. • Are enabled in the base or Access Point to which the scanner connects. Is the bar code displayed but not entered into the application? The bar code is displayed on the host device correctly, but you still have to press a key to enter it (the Enter/Return key or the Tab key, for example). • You need to program a suffix. Programming a suffix enables the scanner to output the bar code data plus the key you need (such as “CR”) to enter the data into your application. Refer to Prefix/Suffix Overview on page 151 for further information. The scanner won’t read your bar code at all. • Scan the sample bar codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner reads the sample bar codes, check that your bar code is readable. • Verify that your bar code symbology is enabled (see Chapter 9). • If the scanner still can’t read the sample bar codes, scan All Symbologies on page 178. Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 325 326 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com APPENDIX A REFERENCE CHARTS Symbology Charts Note: “m” represents the AIM modifier character. Refer to International Technical Specification, Symbology Identifiers, for AIM modifier character details. Prefix /Suffix entries for specific symbologies override the universal (All Symbologies, 99) entry. Refer to Data Edit beginning on page 151 and Data Format beginning on page 157 for information about using Code ID and AIM ID. Linear Symbologies AIM Symbology ID Honeywell Possible modifiers (m) ID All Symbologies Hex 99 Codabar ]Fm Code 11 ]H3 Code 128 ]Cm Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF) ]X0 Code 39 (supports Full ASCII mode) ]Am TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39) ]L2 0-1 0, 1, 2, 4 0, 1, 3, 4, 5, 7 a 61 h 68 j 6A < 3C b 62 T 54 Code 93 and 93i ]Gm 0-9, A-Z, a-m i 69 EAN ]Em 0, 1, 3, 4 d 64 EAN-13 (including Bookland EAN) ]E0 d 64 EAN-13 with Add-On ]E3 d 64 EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code ]E3 d 64 EAN-8 ]E4 D 44 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 327 AIM Symbology ID EAN-8 with Add-On Honeywell Possible modifiers (m) ]E3 ID Hex D 44 y 79 GS1 GS1 DataBar ]em GS1 DataBar Limited ]em { 7B GS1 DataBar Expanded ]em } 7D GS1-128 ]C1 I 49 China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) ]X0 Q 51 Interleaved 2 of 5 ]Im e 65 Matrix 2 of 5 ]X0 m 6D NEC 2 of 5 ]X0 Y 59 Straight 2 of 5 IATA ]Rm f 66 Straight 2 of 5 Industrial ]S0 f 66 g 67 t 74 0 2 of 5 MSI ]Mm Telepen ]Bm UPC 0, 1, 3 0, 1, 3 0, 1 0, 1, 2, 3, 8, 9, A, B, C UPC-A ]E0 c 63 UPC-A with Add-On ]E3 c 63 UPC-A with Extended Coupon Code ]E3 c 63 UPC-E ]E0 E 45 UPC-E with Add-On ]E3 E 45 UPC-E1 ]X0 E 45 Add Honeywell Code ID 5C80 Add AIM Code ID 5C81 Add Backslash 5C5C Batch mode quantity 5 35 2D Symbologies AIM Symbology ID Honeywell Possible modifiers (m) ID All Symbologies Aztec Code 328 Hex 99 ]zm 0-9, A-C z 7A Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com AIM Symbology ID Chinese Sensible Code (Han Xin Code) ]X0 Codablock A ]O6 Codablock F Honeywell Possible modifiers (m) ID Hex H 48 0, 1, 4, 5, 6 V 56 ]Om 0, 1, 4, 5, 6 q 71 Code 49 ]Tm 0, 1, 2, 4 l 6C Data Matrix ]dm 0-6 w 77 GS1 ]em 0-3 y 79 GS1 Composite ]em 0-3 y 79 GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional ]em 0-3 y 79 MaxiCode ]Um 0-3 x 78 PDF417 ]Lm 0-2 r 72 ]Lm 0-5 R 52 ]Qm 0-6 s 73 ]Qm s 73 AIM Honeywell MicroPDF417 QR Code Micro QR Code Postal Symbologies Symbology ID Possible modifiers (m) ID All Symbologies Hex 99 Australian Post ]X0 A 41 British Post ]X0 B 42 Canadian Post ]X0 C 43 China Post ]X0 Q 51 InfoMail ]X0 , 2c Intelligent Mail Bar Code ]X0 M 4D Japanese Post ]X0 J 4A KIX (Netherlands) Post ]X0 K 4B Korea Post ]X0 ? 3F Planet Code ]X0 L 4C Postal-4i ]X0 N 4E Postnet ]X0 P 50 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 329 ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252) In keyboard applications, ASCII Control Characters can be represented in 3 different ways, as shown below. The CTRL+X function is OS and application dependent. The following table lists some commonly used Microsoft functionality. This table applies to U.S. style keyboards. Certain characters may differ depending on your Country Code/PC regional settings. Non-printable ASCII control characters DEC 330 HEX Char Keyboard Control + ASCII (CTRL+X) Mode Control + X Mode Off (KBDCAS0) Windows Mode Control + X Mode On (KBDCAS2) CTRL + X CTRL + X function 0 00 NUL Reserved CTRL+ @ 1 01 SOH NP Enter CTRL+ A 2 02 STX Caps Lock CTRL+ B Bold 3 03 ETX ALT Make CTRL+ C Copy 4 04 EOT ALT Break CTRL+ D Bookmark 5 05 ENQ CTRL Make CTRL+ E Center 6 06 ACK CTRL Break CTRL+ F Find 7 07 BEL Enter / Ret CTRL+ G 8 08 BS (Apple Make) CTRL+ H 9 09 HT Tab CTRL+ I Italic 10 0A LF (Apple Break) CTRL+ J Justify 11 0B VT Tab CTRL+ K hyperlink CTRL+ L list, left align Select all History 12 0C FF Delete 13 0D CR Enter / Ret CTRL+ M 14 0E SO Insert CTRL+ N New 15 0F SI ESC CTRL+ O Open 16 10 DLE F11 CTRL+ P Print 17 11 DC1 Home CTRL+ Q Quit 18 12 DC2 PrtScn CTRL+ R 19 13 DC3 Backspace CTRL+ S 20 14 DC4 Back Tab CTRL+ T 21 15 NAK F12 CTRL+ U 22 16 SYN F1 CTRL+ V 23 17 ETB F2 CTRL+ W 24 18 CAN F3 CTRL+ X 25 19 EM F4 CTRL+ Y 26 1A SUB F5 CTRL+ Z 27 1B ESC F6 CTRL+ [ 28 1C FS F7 CTRL+ \ 29 1D GS F8 CTRL+ ] 30 1E RS F9 CTRL+ ^ 31 1F US F10 CTRL+ - 127 7F ⌂ NP Enter Save Paste ? ? ? ? ? ? ? ? Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Lower ASCII Reference Table Note: Windows Code page 1252 and lower ASCII use the same characters. Printable Characters DEC HEX Character 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F <SPACE> ! " # $ % & ' ( ) * + , . / 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 : ; < = > ? DEC HEX 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 4A 4B 4C 4D 4E 4F 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 5A 5B 5C 5D 5E 5F Extended ASCII Characters DEC HEX CP 1252 ASCII Character DEC @ A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z [ \ ] ^ _ 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 Alternate Extended HEX 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 6A 6B 6C 6D 6E 6F 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E 7F up arrow ↑ 0x48 ü down arrow ↓ 0x50 ‚ é right arrow → 0x4B 83 ƒ â left arrow ← 0x4D 84 85 86 87 88 89 8A 8B „ … † ‡ ˆ ‰ Š ‹ ä à å ç ê ë è ï Insert Delete Home End Page Up Page Down Right ALT Right CTRL 0x52 0x53 0x47 0x4F 0x49 0x51 0x38 0x1D 80 129 81 130 82 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 € Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com ` a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z { | } ~ ⌂ PS2 Scan Code Ç 128 Character 331 Extended ASCII Characters (Continued) DEC HEX CP 1252 ASCII Alternate Extended 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 193 332 8C 8D 8E 8F 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 9A 9B 9C 9D 9E 9F A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 AA AB AC AD AE AF B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 BA BB BC BD BE BF C0 C1 Œ Ž ‘ ’ “ ” • – — ˜ ™ š › œ ž Ÿ ¡ ¢ £ ¤ ¥ ¦ § ¨ © ª « ¬ ® ¯ ° ± ² ³ ´ µ ¶ · ¸ ¹ º » ¼ ½ ¾ ¿ À Á î ì Ä Å É æ Æ ô ö ò û ù ÿ Ö Ü ¢ £ ¥ ₧ ƒ á í ó ú ñ Ñ ª º ¿ ⌐ ¬ ½ ¼ ¡ « » ░ ▒ ▓ │ ┤ ╡ ╢ ╖ ╕ ╣ ║ ╗ ╝ ╜ ╛ ┐ └ ┴ Reserved Reserved Numeric Keypad Enter Numeric Keypad / F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F10 F11 F12 Numeric Keypad + Numeric Keypad Numeric Keypad * Caps Lock Num Lock Left Alt Left Ctrl Left Shift Right Shift Print Screen Tab Shift Tab Enter Esc Alt Make Alt Break Control Make Control Break Alt Sequence with 1 Character Ctrl Sequence with 1 Character PS2 Scan Code n/a n/a 0x1C 0x35 0x3B 0x3C 0x3D 0x3E 0x3F 0x40 0x41 0x42 0x43 0x44 0x57 0x58 0x4E 0x4A 0x37 0x3A 0x45 0x38 0x1D 0x2A 0x36 n/a 0x0F 0x8F 0x1C 0x01 0x36 0xB6 0x1D 0x9D 0x36 0x1D Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Extended ASCII Characters (Continued) DEC HEX CP 1252 ASCII Alternate Extended 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 228 229 230 231 232 233 234 235 236 237 238 239 240 241 242 243 244 245 246 247 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 CA CB CC CD CE CF D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 DA DB DC DD DE DF E0 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 EA EB EC ED EE EF F0 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 Â Ã Ä Å Æ Ç È É Ê Ë Ì Í Î Ï Ð Ñ Ò Ó Ô Õ Ö × Ø Ù Ú Û Ü Ý Þ ß à á â ã ä å æ ç è é ê ë ì í î ï ð ñ ò ó ô õ ö ÷ PS2 Scan Code ┬ ├ ─ í ╞ ╟ ╚ ╔ ╩ ╦ ╠ ═ ╬ ╧ ╨ ╤ ╥ ╙ ╘ ╒ ╓ ╫ ╪ ┘ ┌ █ ▄ ▌ ▐ ▀ α ß Γ π Σ σ µ τ Φ Θ Ω δ ∞ φ ε ∩ ≡ ± ≥ ≤ ⌠ ⌡ ÷ ≈ Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 333 Extended ASCII Characters (Continued) DEC HEX CP 1252 ASCII Alternate Extended 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 255 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF ø ù ú û ü ý þ ÿ PS2 Scan Code ° · · √ ⁿ ² ■ ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, select the code page with which the bar codes were created. The data characters should then appear properly. Standard Keyboard Country Honeywell Code Page Option United States (standard ASCII) ISO/IEC 646-IRV n/a 1 Automatic National Character Replacement ISO/IEC 2022 n/a 2 (default) Binary Code page n/a n/a 3 Code Page Selection Method/ Country Default “Automatic National Character replacement” will select the below Honeywell Code Page options for Code128, Code 39 and Code 93. 334 United States ISO/IEC 646-06 0 1 Canada ISO /IEC 646-121 54 95 Canada ISO /IEC 646-122 18 96 Japan ISO/IEC 646-14 28 98 China ISO/IEC 646-57 92 99 Great Britain (UK) ISO /IEC 646-04 7 87 France ISO /IEC 646-69 3 83 Germany ISO/IEC646-21 4 84 Switzerland ISO /IEC 646-CH 6 86 Sweden / Finland (extended Annex C) ISO/IEC 646-11 2 82 Ireland ISO /IEC 646-207 73 97 Denmark ISO/IEC 646-08 8 88 Norway ISO/IEC 646-60 9 94 Italy ISO/IEC 646-15 5 85 Portugal ISO/IEC 646-16 13 92 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Standard Keyboard Country Honeywell Code Page Option Spain ISO/IEC 646-17 10 90 Spain ISO/IEC 646-85 51 91 Code Page Selection Method/ Country Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 335 64 91 92 93 94 96 123 124 125 126 Hex 23 24 40 5B 5C 5D 5E 60 7B 7C 7D 7E US 0 1 # $ @ [ \ ] ^ ` { | } ~ CA 54 95 # $ à â ç ê î ô é ù è û CA 18 96 # $ à â ç ê É ô é ù è û JP 28 98 # $ @ [ ¥ ] ^ ` { | } ⎯ CN 92 99 # ¥ @ [ \ ] ^ ` { | } ⎯ GB 7 87 £ $ @ [ \ ] ^ ` { | } ˜ FR 3 83 £ $ à ° ç § ^ µ é ù è ¨ DE 4 84 # $ § Ä Ö Ü ^ ` ä ö ü ß CH 6 86 ù $ à é ç ê î ô ä ö ü û SE/FI 2 82 # ¤ É Ä Ö Å Ü é ä ö å ü DK 8 88 # $ @ Æ Ø Å ^ ` æ ø å ˜ NO 9 94 # $ @ Æ Ø Å ^ ` æ ø å ¯ IE 73 97 £ $ Ó É Í Ú Á ó é í ú á IT 5 85 £ $ § ° ç é ^ ù à ò è ì PT 13 92 # $ § Ã Ç Õ ^ ` ã ç õ ° ES 10 90 # $ § ¡ Ñ ¿ ^ ` ° ñ ç ˜ ES 51 91 # $ · ¡ Ñ Ç ¿ ` ´ ñ ç ¨ Honeywell CodePage 36 Country Keyboard 35 COUNTRY Dec 336 ISO / IEC 646 National Character Replacements Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Key References 6E 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2B 4B 50 55 4C 51 56 2C 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 39 3D 3A 3B 3C 3E 3F 38 40 53 4F 54 59 5A 5F 5B 60 5C 61 5D 62 63 64 69 65 6A 66 67 6C 68 5A 5F 5B 60 5C 61 5D 62 63 64 69 65 6A 66 67 6C 68 104 Key U.S. Style Keyboard 6E 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 2B 1E 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2A 4B 50 55 4C 51 56 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 39 3D 3A 3B 3C 3E 3F 38 40 53 4F 54 59 105 Key European Style Keyboard Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 337 338 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Sample Symbols UPC-A Interleaved 2 of 5 0 123456 7890 01234567890 EAN-13 9 780330 290951 Code 128 Code 39 Code 128 BC321 Codabar A13579B Code 93 Straight 2 of 5 Industrial 123456-9$ 123456 Matrix 2 of 5 6543210 RSS-14 PDF417 (01) 00123456789012 Car Registration Code 49 1234567890 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 339 Sample Symbols (Continued) Postnet Data Matrix Zip Code Test Symbol QR Code Numbers MaxiCode Micro PDF417 Test Message Test Message 340 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Programming Chart 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 341 Programming Chart (Continued) A B C D E F Save Discard Reset Note: If you make an error while scanning the letters or digits (before scanning Save), scan Discard, scan the correct letters or digits, and Save again. 342 Xenon/Granit User Guide 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY CBL-020-300-C00 Cable for product : Description: Interface: Connector A: Connector B: Connector C: Cable length: Generic HSM – bar code scanner Standard Serial RS232 DB9 Female coiled RS232 TTL (5V) Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like) Molded DB9 - Female STD HSM Power link 5V (DC Jack with shunt) 2.80 meter (retracted ~1.35 m) Max extended Pin assignment Connector assignment Connector A Connector B NOTE: · WARNING: connecting to 12V host powered systems with these cables will damage the 5V-only scanner when the External Power (PSU) is disconnected from con. C. Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages . Document Revision: 1.3 Last updated June 7, 2011 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Scanning & Mobility CBL-020-500-C00 Cable for: Description: Interface: Connector A: Connector B: Connector C: Xenon 190x series, Hyperion 1300g, Voyager 12xx, Voyager 14xx, Granit 19xxi, Serial 9pin sub D – FEMALE, coiled, black (standard PC) 232TTL, 5VDC RJ41 10pin modular DB9 female Powerlink 5V DC Cable length retracted: minimum ~ 1 m Cable length extended: minimum ~ 5 m This is an entry from the Honeywell Scanning and Mobility Knowledge base. As part of our ongoing effort to improve and enhance the quality of the solutions, we ask you to inform us if you feel that we can improve on the content of this solution.Please send an email to: [email protected] 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Molded RJ41 - 10pin modular DB9 female This is an entry from the Honeywell Scanning and Mobility Knowledge base. As part of our ongoing effort to improve and enhance the quality of the solutions, we ask you to inform us if you feel that we can improve on the content of this solution.Please send an email to: [email protected] 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY CBL-220-300-C00 Cable for product : Description: Interface: Connector A: Connector B: Connector C: Cable length: Generic HSM – bar code scanner Serial RS232 DB9 Male coiled (Wincor / Toshiba ECR’s) RS232 TTL (5V) Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like) Molded DB9 - Male STD HSM Power link 5V (DC Jack with shunt) 2.80 meter (retracted ~1.35 m) Max extended Pin assignment Connector assignment Connector A Connector B NOTE: · WARNING: connecting to 12V host powered systems with these cables will damage the 5V-only scanner when the External Power (PSU) is disconnected from con. C. · Former part number: 42206454-01E. Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages . Document Revision: 1.3 Last updated June 7, 2011 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY CBL-500-300-S00 Cable for product : Description: Interface: Connector A: Connector B: Cable length: Generic HSM – bar code scanner Standard 3 Meter straight USB cable – Type A USB Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like) Molded USB Type A ~3.00 meter Max extended Pin assignment Connector assignment Connector A Connector B NOTE: Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages . Document Revision: 1.3 Last updated June 7, 2011 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY CBL-503-300-S00 Cable for product : Description: Interface: Connector A: Connector B: Cable length: Generic HSM – bar code scanner 3 Meter straight USB Power Plus cable USB Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like) USB Plus Power (12V) ~3.00 meter Max extended Pin assignment Connector assignment Connector A Connector B NOTE: Uses strictly the 5V (pin 1 to 4) lower USB connector, (Teal) Plus power connector suits 12 volt socket only. Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages . Document Revision: 1.3 Last updated June 7, 2011 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY Holder-010-U Granit 191X Wall Mount Holder Dimensional drawing fig 1. PN# has 2 components (1- plastic Ind. Cup and 2- set of Screws) Fig 2.1 (front) Although due to the angle, the official drawing isn't specific on this, the screw holes are more or less vertically centered on the cup and therefore ~31.6 mm from both top or bottom. Fig 3.1 (bottom) Fig 2.2 detail Fig 3.2 (side view - wall mounted) Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages Document Revision: 1.0 Last updated October 8, 2015 Author: E411793 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com SCANNING & MOBILITY Fig 4. (Height / Width in mm) Honeywell currently doesn't provide mounting guidance / measurements for the HOLDER-10-U and hence the support team provides below some rough guidance on the required space for mounting. Fig 5. indicational drawing for required space Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages Document Revision: 1.0 Last updated October 8, 2015 Author: E411793 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Se n s i n g a n d P r o d u c t i v i t y So l u t i o n s VMHOLDERK - Vehicle Mount Holder Kit The Vehicle Mount Holder kit, is a kit that includes all that is needed to have a holder to rest the scanner in, when it is not used. The intention is that the operator can quickly put the scanner in to the holder, and get it out again. The adjustable joint allows mounting the holder in a way the scanner will not fall out the holder, when the vehicle it is mounted to, encounters bumps and sills on its way. The kit is packed in a white box with label; BOX, MOTTLED WHITE W/O LOGO size 7.625 x 4 x 3.25 with label; LABEL, AGENCY PKG LABEL (The standard 4" x 2" Honeywell box label 'J" with item barcode, description en BOM rev indication) It includes the following parts: BRACKET, 3800I VEHICLE MT HOLDER, PN# 100003664 --> MOUNTING BRKET SMALL 7400VB, RAM-B-101U, PN# 8000046 --> SCREW ASSEMBLY FOR VMHOLDERE 4 screws in a plastic bag PN# 50111876-001 --> 10-32 Philips, black zinc, 0.375 NOTE: Granit housing is not hold as tight by the holder as the original 3800i,4800i, IT5800 housings did Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages Document Revision: 1.0 Last updated January 26, 2016 Author: E411793 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Se n s i n g a n d P r o d u c t i v i t y So l u t i o n s Measurements: BRACKET, 3800I VEHICLE MT HOLDER PN# 100003664 Measurements: MOUNTING BRKET SMALL 7400VB, RAM-B-101U (adjustable mount) PN# 8000046 Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages Document Revision: 1.0 Last updated January 26, 2016 Author: E411793 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com INSTALLATION & MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS TOOL BALANCER MOUNT REEL '�@ NOTE: Disregard this step if reel is pre-mounted to Torq-Arm or other equipment. Mount reel to secure structure directly above work. ATTACH TOOL �&) Raise tool and attach to hook on end of cable. j CAUTION: Do not pull cable down. It is spring loaded and could cause injury if allowed to snap back. Be sure tool is securely hooked to cable. Do not drop tool. Tool may be heavier than spring can lift before spring is adjusted. ADJUST TOOL HEIGHT �(8 Determine ideal height for tool when tool is not being used. (DCAUTION 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Access Point AP-010BT/AP-100BT Quick Start Guide Aller à www.honeywellaidc.com pour le français. Vai a www.honeywellaidc.com per l'italiano. Gehe zu www.honeywellaidc.com für Deutsch. Ir a www.honeywellaidc.com para español. Idź na stronę : www.honeywellaidc.com po quick start w języku polskim. Перейти на русскоязычный сайт www.honeywellaidc.com. Pro češtinu jdi na www.honeywellaidc.com. Pre slovenčinu choď na www.honeywellaidc.com Para Português, acesse www.honeywellaidc.com.br. 日本語 : www.honeywellaidc.com をご覧ください。 如要到中国 www.honeywellaidc.com(简体)。 查看繁体版请登陆 www.honeywellaidc.com 한글 www.honeywellaidc.com 로 이동합니다 . .www.honeywellaidc.com ʺʡʥʺʫʡʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤʸʺʠʬʸʥʡʲˬʺʩʸʡʲʡʤʱʸʢʬ ¬íéÑõàÇ ¬úàà www.honeywellaidc.com ˆàÅ á´èäÇ Rev E 7/15 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Connecting the Access Point Note: Refer to your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com to determine which Access Point model is compatible with your scanner. 1. Slide the O-ring into the groove in the connector. Note: If you choose not to install the O-ring, the Access Point will be rated to IP41, instead of IP54. 2. Plug the interface cable into the Access Point first and then into the appropriate port on the computer. The Page button blinks when the Access Point is first connected to the host. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 3. Turn on the computer (laptop/desktop). USB Connection: 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com RS232 Connection: RS485 Connection: 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Keyboard Wedge Connection: Linking a Scanner 4. Scan the linking bar code on the top of the Access Point to establish a connection between the Access Point and the scanner. The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the green LED to confirm a connection with the Access Point. The Access Point’s Page button light turns solid blue. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Linking a 4820 Scanner 5. Remove the 4820 Linking bar code from the Access Point kit and attach it to the Access Point. Scan the 4820 Linking bar code to establish a connection between the Access Point and the 4820 scanner. The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the green LED to confirm a connection with the Access Point. The Access Point’s Page button remains blue. If you have difficulty connecting with your 4820, it may be due to Code XML software in your scanner. Scan the following bar code, then scan the 4820 Linking bar code. These steps may resolve this connection problem. Code XML Off Managing Connections Auto Reconnect Mode By default, the Access Point is set to Auto Reconnect On, so the scanner begins the relink process immediately, when a connection to the Access Point is lost. If you do not want to relink automatically, scan the Auto Reconnect Off bar code. * Auto Reconnect On Auto Reconnect Off 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Changing Batteries If the scanner turns off due to a low battery, you can change the battery without losing the link with the Access Point, provided the scanner is in range. A few seconds after the scanner powers up, the scanner relinks to the Access Point. Refer to your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com for additional information about charging the batteries. Low Power Mode When there is no activity within a specified time period, the scanner enters a low power mode. The default time out period is one hour. Press the scanner’s trigger to power the scanner back up. If the scanner was linked to the Access Point when it went to “sleep,” it will re-link as long as it is in range. If multiple scanners use the same Access Point, it is possible to inadvertently unlink a scanner that is in “sleep” mode, that has a dead battery, or is in the process of getting a new battery. To prevent this from happening, you can disable the sleep mode (time out) by scanning the No Time Out bar code below. No Time Out (0) Unlinking the Scanner from Access Point If you know that your scanner is not going to be used for a while, you can unlink the scanner by scanning the Unlink Scanner bar code below. Unlink Scanner 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Page Button Note: This feature does not apply to 4820 scanners. When you press the Page button on the Access Point, the scanners associated with that Access Point will begin beeping (3 short and 1 long beep). If you press the trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop beeping. Page button LED Dimmer Scan a bar code to set the brightness of your Page button. LED Dimmer Off LED Dimmer - Low LED Dimmer - Bright 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Adding Carriage Return Suffix If you want a carriage return (CR) to display after the bar code data on your output, scan the Add CR Suffix bar code below. Scan the Clear All Suffixes bar code to remove suffixes. Add CR Suffix Clear All Suffixes Standard Product Defaults This bar code resets all standard product default settings. Note: Resetting standard defaults disconnects the scanner from the Access Point. Scan the Linking bar code to re-establish a connection. Refer to your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com for additional information about product defaults. Standard Product Default Settings 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Additional Programming The Access Point has all the programming capability of a Cordless Charge Base. Refer to Cordless System Operation information in your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com for programming information. Required Safety Labels Label location for item number, serial number, revision information, compliance, and safety information 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Product Specifications Parameter Specification Dimensions (Typical): Height 1.1 inch (28mm) Length 4.3 inches (109mm) Width 2.8 inches (71mm) Weight 2.3 ounces (66g) Voltage Requirements 5 VDC + 0.5V Current Draw 100mA @ 5 volts typical 300mA @ 5 volts maximum Temperature Ranges: Operating 32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C) Storage -40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C) Radio: Frequency 2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1 Range - AP-010BT 33 ft. (10m) typical Range - AP-100BT 328 ft. (100m) typical Data Rate Up to 1MBps Humidity 5 to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet (1 m) to concrete Vibration 5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz ESD Sensitivity Up to 15kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Technical Assistance Contact information for technical support and product service can be found at www.honeywellaidc.com. Limited Warranty Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your product’s warranty information. Disclaimer Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII. HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII. 2010-2015 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Charge-Only Base COB02 Installation Guide Rev B 9/15 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Introduction Honeywell’s Charge-Only Base can fully charge an industrial wireless area-imaging scanner in 5 hours, maximizing uptime in any application. Note: When a scanner is placed into the Charge-Only Base, the battery will charge. Please note that the Charge-Only Base will not facilitate communication with the host system or other scanners. Installation Connect the power adapter to the Charge-Only Base, then plug the power supply into an AC power outlet. Make sure the AC power outlet voltage is the same as the power supply. Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type power supply with output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A. We recommend use of Honeywell power adapters. Use of any non-Honeywell power adapters may cause damage not covered by the warranty. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Mounting a COB02 Base The COB02 Base can be mounted on either a horizontal or vertical surface. The cable can be routed through either the top or the bottom of the base. The cable can be routed down through the bottom of the base, securing the cable in the wireway. The cable can also be routed up through the top of the base, but must be crossed over and secured in the wireway. When routing the cable up through the top of the base, be sure to cross the cable over before placing in the wireway. If not, too much strain is placed on the cable connector. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking system is used to secure the scanner when it is in the stand. When mounted on a horizontal surface, the locking mechanism should be set to unlocked (pushed up). When mounted on a vertical surface, the locking mechanism should be set to locked (pushed down). Locked position for vertical mount Unlocked position for horizontal mount 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Use 30mm screws, appropriate for the mounting surface material, to mount the base securely. 2.51 in. 63.7mm 5.31 in. 134.92mm 2 in. 51.17mm 2.36 in. 60mm .84 in. 21.42mm Operation and Indicators 1. Place a scanner into the cradle to charge. 2. When a scanner is inserted, the green LED flashes according to the chart below. If the Green LED does not appear, check to make sure the scanner is seated completely in the charger with the battery contacts touching the contacts on the charger. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 3. When the battery is completely charged, the green charging indicator stops flashing and stays illuminated. LED Indicators Red On Power is on Green Off Battery not detected Slow flash Pre-charge and charge On Charge completed Fast flash Charge suspended due to a fault condition 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com COB02 Product Specifications Dimensions (Typical): Height 2.6 in. (6.6cm) Length 9.8 in. (24.98mm) Width 4.05 in. (10.28cm) Weight 10.05 oz. (285g) Voltage 4.5 to 5.5 volts Current 1A Charge Time 5 hours Charge Temperature 41 F to +104 F (5 C to +40 C) Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Mechanical Drop Operational after 50 drops from 3.94 feet (1.2m) to concrete within the temperature range of -4 F (-20 C) to 122 F (50 C). Vibration Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex C ESD Immunity Up to 20kV direct air Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane IP Rating IP51, immunity of foreign particles and dripping water 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Required Safety Labels Compliance Label locations Cleaning the Charge-Only Base Unplug the Charge-Only Base from the power supply before cleaning. Clean the housing of the Charge-Only Base with a soft cloth or tissue dampened with water (or a mild detergent- water solution). If a detergent solution is used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with water only. ! Never use solvents (e.g., alcohol or acetone) on the housing – solvents may damage the finish. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Technical Assistance Contact information for technical support, product service, and repair can be found at www.honeywellaidc.com. Limited Warranty Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your product’s warranty information. Patents For patent information, please refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/ patents. Disclaimer Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII. HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. HII disclaims all responsibility for the selection and use of software and/or hardware to achieve intended results. This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII. 2012-2015 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Mounting a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base CCB02-100BT/ CCB05-100BT Base The cables can also be routed up through the top of the base, crossing them over and securing the cables in the wireways. The CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base can be mounted on either a horizontal or vertical surface. The cables can be routed through either the bottom or the top of the base. The cables can be routed down through the bottom of the base, securing the cables in the wireways. Installation Guide When routing the cables up through the top of the base, be sure to cross the cables over before placing in the wireways. If not, too much strain is placed on the cable connectors. GRNTBASE-INST Rev B 03/15 When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking system is used to secure the scanner when it is in the stand. When mounted on a horizontal surface, the locking mechanism should be set to unlocked (pushed up). When mounted on a vertical surface, the locking mechanism should be set to locked (pushed down). Use 3 screws, appropriate for the mounting surface material, to mount the base securely. Limited Warranty Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/ warranty_information for your product’s warranty information. Patents For patent information, see www.hsmpats.com. Disclaimer Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII. Unlocked position for horizontal mount HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. Locked position for vertical mount 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII. Copyright 2012–2015 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Multi-Bay Battery Charger Installation Guide MBC-INST Rev C 10/14 For localized language versions of this document, go to www.honeywellaidc.com. Introduction Honeywell’s Multi-Bay Battery Charger can fully charge up to four lithium-ion batteries in less than eight hours (typically 4.5 hours), maximizing uptime in any application. Note: When a battery is placed into the Multi-Bay Battery Charger, the battery will charge. Please note that the Multi-Bay Battery Charger will not facilitate communication with the host system or other imagers. Multi-Bay Battery Charger Operation and Indicators First, connect the right angle power adapter to the Multi-Bay Battery Charger. Then plug the power supply into an AC power outlet. Make sure the AC power outlet voltage is the same as the power supply. Note: Use only a UL/cUL listed power supply with output rated 5Vdc, 4A. We recommend use of Honeywell approved power adapters. Use of any non-Honeywell approved power adapters may cause damage not covered by the warranty. 1. Place a battery into a cradle to charge. 2. When a battery is inserted, the green LED flashes 3 times, then flashes slowly. If the Green LED does not appear, check to make sure the battery pack is seated completely in the charger with the battery contacts facing the contacts on the charger. 3. When the battery is completely charged, the charging indicator stops flashing and stays illuminated. Operational temperature for charging the battery is 41° to 104°F (5° to 40°C). LED Indicators Off Battery not detected 3 flashes Battery inserted into base Slow flash Pre-charge and charge On Charge completed Fast flash Charge suspended due to a fault condition Mounting Mount the Multi-Bay Battery Charger on any smooth surface according to the following dimensions: 3.5 in. (90mm) .18 in. (4.5mm) .29 in. (7.5mm) Back Bottom .29 in. (7.5mm) 3.5 in. (90mm) .18 in. (4.5mm) If a metal or wood stud is present, drill a 3/32 inch (2.38mm) pilot hole into the stud and use the supplied #6 x 1 screw to attach the Multi-Bay Charger to the wall. For any of the screws positioned so that they are going directly into dry wall, use a sheet rock anchor/screw set such as the one listed below. Make sure the weight of the power supply is supported separately. Wall Recommended Anchors Sheet Rock Buildex E-Z Anchor Stud Solver Medium Duty Drywall Anchor (Model #25216); supports 50 lbs. (22.68kg) Wood/Metal #6 x 1 screws included 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com About the Battery Use only Honeywell Li-ion battery packs BAT-SCN01 in this device. Use of any non-Honeywell battery may result in damage not covered by the warranty. Battery Recommendations • Batteries are shipped approximately 30% to 60% charged and should be fully charged for maximum charge capacity. • The battery is a lithium ion cell and can be used without a full charge, and can also be charged without fully discharging without impacting the battery life. There is no need to perform any charge/discharge conditioning on this type of battery. • Do not disassemble the battery. There are no user-serviceable parts in the battery. • Do not allow metallic conductive objects to contact battery terminals. Do not short-circuit a battery or throw it into a fire; it can explode and cause severe personal injury. • Improper battery use may result in a fire, explosion, or other hazard. • Although your battery can be recharged many times, it will eventually be depleted. Replace it after the battery is unable to hold an adequate charge. • If you are not sure if the battery or charger is working properly, send it to Honeywell International Inc. or an authorized service center for inspection. Refer to Technical Assistance on page 2 for additional information. Proper Disposal of the Battery When the battery has reached the end of its useful life, promptly dispose of used batteries in accordance with local regulations. Do not incinerate the battery. This battery pack contains Lithium-ion chemistry. You may send the imager’s battery to us (postage paid). The shipper is responsible for complying with all federal, state, and local laws and regulations related to the packing, labeling, manifesting, and shipping of spent batteries. Contact Technical Assistance, below, for recycling or disposal information. Since you may find that your cost of returning the batteries significant, it may be more cost effective to locate a local recycle/disposal company. Cleaning the Multi-Bay Battery Charger Unplug the Multi-Bay Battery Charger from the power supply before cleaning. Clean the housing of the Multi-Bay Battery Charger with a soft cloth or tissue dampened with water (or a mild detergent- water solution). If a detergent solution is used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with water only. Never use solvents (e.g., alcohol or acetone) on the housing – solvents may damage the finish. Disclaimer Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII. HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII. 2009-2014 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Other product names or marks mentioned in this document may be trademarks or registered trademarks of other companies and are the property of their respective owners. Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com Technical Assistance Contact information for technical support, product service, and repair can be found at www.honeywellaidc.com. Limited Warranty Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your product’s warranty information. MBC-INST Rev C Page 2 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com Rev C FCC Part 15 Subpart B Class B This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. Consult the dealer or an experienced radio or television technician for help. If necessary, the user should consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for additional suggestions. Honeywell is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by unauthorized modifications of this equipment or the substitution or attachment of connecting cables and equipment other than those specified by Honeywell. The correction is the responsibility of the user. Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment. Canadian Compliance Conformité à la règlementation canadienne This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Operation is subject to the following conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Cet appareil numérique de la Classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada. Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes : 1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable. 2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable. Use only shielded data cables with this system. This unit has been tested with cables less than 3 meters. Cables greater than 3 meters may not meet class B performance. Utiliser uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. L’appareil a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Les câbles de longueur supérieure à 3 mètres peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la performance de la classe B. Utilisez uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. Ce dispositif a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Il est possible que les câbles de plus de 3 mètres ne permettent pas d’atteindre des performances de classe B. Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con questo sistema. Questa unità è stata testata con cavi di lunghezza inferiore a 3 metri. I cavi di lunghezza superiore a 3 metri potrebbero non essere conformi alle prestazioni di classe B. Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3 Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien der Klasse B. 此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。 此设 备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。 长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B 级性能。 此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。 此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進 行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無 法達到 B 級裝置效能。 このシステムにはシールド付きデー タケーブルのみを使用してください。 この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル でテストされています。3 m 以上の ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ ない場合があります。 이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블 만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터 미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니 다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사 용하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못 할 수 있습니다 . Используйте с этой системой только экранированные кабели передачи данных. Это устройство прошло испытания с использованием кабелей длиной менее 3 метров. Рабочие характеристики кабелей длиной свыше 3 м могут не соответствовать классу В. The CE marking indicates compliance with the following directives: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive, when shipped with recommended power supply. European contact: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Le marquage CE indique la conformité avec les directives suivantes : • 2014/30/EU CEM • 2011/65/UE – RoHS (Refonte) De plus, ce produit est conforme à la Directive européenne 2014/35/EU relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il est expédié avec le bloc d’alimentation recommandé. Personne-ressource en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Les Pays-Bas Le marquage CE indique la conformité aux directives suivantes : • 2014/30/EUE CEM • 2011/65/UE RoHS (refonte) De plus, indique la conformité à la directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension, lorsque le dispositif est livré avec l’alimentation électrique recommandée. Contact en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Pays-Bas La marcatura CE indica conformità alle seguenti direttive: • 2014/30/EU CEM • Direttiva RoHS 2011/ 65/UE (rifusione) È inoltre conforme ai sensi della Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU, se spedito con l'alimentatore consigliato. Contatto in Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Paesi Bassi Die CE-Kennzeichnung signalisiert die Konformität mit folgenden Richtlinien: • 2014/30/EU EMV • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/ 35/EU, wenn es mit dem empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird. Ansprechpartner Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Niederlande CE 标 记表示 符合以下 指令: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (新版) 此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还 符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要 求。欧洲联系信息: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 標記表示 符合下 列 指令: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (重訂) 此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦 符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲 聯絡資訊: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE マークは、本装置が 次の指令に準拠してい ることを示します。 • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS ( 改正 ) また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive にも準拠しています。欧州 でのお問い合わせ : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 마크는 다음 지침을 준수함을 나타냅니다 . • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) 또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배 송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를 준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Маркировка CE означает соответствие требованиям следующих директив: • 2014/30/EU Директива по электромагнитной совместимости (ЭМС) • 2011/65/EU Директива RoHS (исправленная) Кроме того, соответствует требованиям директивы по низковольтному оборудованию 2014/35/EU при поставке с рекомендованным источником питания. Контактное лицо в Европе: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands LED Safety Statement Norme de sécurité sur les DEL Norme de sécurité DEL Disposizione di sicurezza LED Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit LEDs have been tested and classified as “EXEMPT RISK GROUP” to the standard: IEC 62471:2006. Les DEL ont été testées et classées en tant que « GROUPE DE RISQUE EXEMPT » par rapport à la norme : IEC 62471:2006. Les DEL ont été testées et classées « GROUPE SANS RISQUE » selon la norme : CEI 62471:2006. I LED sono stati testati e classificati come "GRUPPO ESENTE DA RISCHI" rispetto allo standard: IEC 62471:2006. Die LEDs wurden geprüft und gemäß der Norm IEC 62471:2006 unter „EXEMPT RISK GROUP“ eingestuft. Заявление о безопасности светодиода Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha probado con cables de longitud inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los requisitos de rendimiento de la clase B. ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ 3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ .B ʤʢʸʣʮ La marca CE indica el cumplimiento de las siguientes normativas: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Refundida) Asimismo, cumple la normativa de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se envía con la fuente de alimentación recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos CE : ΓϱϝΕϝ έϱϱωϡϝΏ 2014/30/EU EMC 2011/65/EU RoHS )Γύϱιϝ ΓΩω·( Use únicamente cables protegidos para datos con este sistema. Esta unidad ha sido evaluada con cables de menos de 3 metros. Es posible que los cables de más de 3 metros no cumplan con el desempeño de clase B. Use somente cabos de dados blindados com este sistema. Esta unidade foi testada com cabos com menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais de 3 metros não atendem o desempenho de classe B. ﺗﻢ.اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم . أﻣﺘﺎر3 اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ3 ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ .B أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ La indicación CE indica el cumplimiento con las siguientes directivas: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulada) Además, cumple con la directiva de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se envía con la fuente de poder recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos A marca CE indica conformidade com as seguintes diretivas: • 2014/30/EU EMC • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulação) Além disso, o produto está em conformidade com a Diretiva para baixa tensão 2014/35/EU, quando fornecido com a fonte de alimentação recomendada. Contato na Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Holanda CE : 2014/30/EU EMC 2011/65/EU RoHS , 2014/35/EU .ϩΏ ϯιϭϡϝ Γϕρϝ , 2014/35/EU . : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Declaración de seguridad del LED Declaración de seguridad del LED Declaração de segurança do LED Los LED se han probado y clasificado como “GRUPO EXENTO DE RIESGOS” según la normativa: IEC 62471:2006. Las LED han sido evaluadas y clasificadas como “GRUPO LIBRE DE RIESGOS” según la norma: IEC 62471:2006. Os LEDs foram testados e classificados como “GRUPO DE RISCO ISENTO” conforme a norma: IEC 62471:2006. LED ʺʥʸʥʰ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ "ʯʥʫʩʱ ʺʥʬʥʨʰʫ" ʥʢʥʥʱʥ ʥʷʣʡʰ LED-ʤ ʺʥʸʥʰ IEC 62471:2006 :ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ LED ﺑﻴﺎن ﺳﻼﻣﺔ ǀŸǞƵƆƵż)ƾƷƱƸƶƫůȶ LED ljƸŮƾƫžȤƾƃƄųȚƖ :ȤƾƸƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶ(ǍƭƒȚǜžǑƴƈƄŽȚ .IEC 62471:2006 LED 安全声明 LED 安全聲明 LED の安全性について LED 안전 고지 사항 LED 经测试属于 IEC 62471:2006 标 准的 “ 豁免风险组 ”(EXEMPT RISK GROUP)。 LED 經測試被列為 IEC 62471:2006 標準的 「豁免風險組」 (EXEMPT RISK GROUP)。 LED は IEC 62471:2006 安全規格に 対してテスト済みで、「EXEMPT RISK GROUP ( リスクグループ除外 )」に分類されています。 LED 는 표준 IEC 62471:2006 에 대해 테스트되어 "EXEMPT RISK GROUP" 으로 분류되었습니다 . CB Scheme Plan OC (organismes de certification) Schéma OC Schema CB CB-Zertifizierung Esquema CB Esquema CB Esquema CB Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1 seconde édition (schéma OC). Certificato in base allo Schema CB IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione. CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950, Second Edition. Se ha certificado que cumple el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Se ha certificado que cumple con el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição. Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition. Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième édition. Светодиоды прошли испытания и отнесены к «БЕЗРИСКОВОЙ ГРУППЕ» согласно стандарту МЭК 62471:2006. CB Scheme CB ﻣﺨﻄﻂ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ CB 方案 CB Scheme CB Scheme CB Scheme Схема CB 已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版 的认证。 經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1 標準第二版。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition に認定されています。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition 인증을 받았습니다 . Сертификация согласно схеме CB МЭК 60950-1, издание второе. Patents Brevets Brevets Brevetti Patente Patentes Patentes Patentes For patent information, refer to www.hsmpats.com. Veuillez consulter le site www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des renseignements au sujet du brevet. Pour plus d’informations sur les brevets, visitez la page www.hsmpats.com. Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare riferimento al sito Web www.hsmpats.com. Patentinformationen sind unter www.hsmpats.com erhältlich. Para obtener información sobre las patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com. Para obtener información sobre patentes, consulte www.hsmpats.com. Para obter informações sobre patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com. 专利 專利 特許 특허 Патенты 有关专利信息,请参阅 www.hsmpats.com。 相關專利資訊請參閱 www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。 特許情報については、 www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ さい。 특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참 조하십시오 . Информация о патентах приведена на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com. Laser Safety Statement Déclaration de sécurité relative au laser Déclaration de sécurité laser Dichiarazione sulla sicurezza del dispositivo laser Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit If the following label is attached to your product, it indicates the product contains a laser: LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. This device has been tested in accordance with and complies with IEC60825-1:2007 and 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11, except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. LASER LIGHT, DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM, CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT, 1.0 mW MAX OUTPUT: 630-650nM. Caution - use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure. Si l’étiquette suivante est apposée à votre produit, cela signifie que le produit contient un laser : LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Cet appareil a été testé et reconnu conforme aux normes IEC608251:2007 et 21 CFR 1040.10 et 1040.11sauf pour les dérogations en accord avec l'avis de conformité sur les lasers No. 50, en date du 24 juin 2007. LUMIÈRE LASER, NE PAS REGARDER DIRECTEMENT DANS LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2, SORTIE MAX. DE 1,0 MW : 630-650 nm. Mise en garde – l’utilisation de contrôles ou d’ajustements ou de performance de procédures autres que ceux spécifiées dans la présente peut provoquer une exposition dangereuse au rayonnement. Si l'étiquette suivante est attachée à votre produit, elle indique que le produit contient un laser : LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Cet appareil a été testé et certifié conforme aux normes CEI 608251:2007, 21 CFR 1040.10 et 21 CFR 1040.11, à l'exception des déviations selon le document Laser Notice n° 50 en date du 24 juin 2007. ATTENTION, LUMIÈRE LASER : NE PAS FIXER LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2 1 mW SORTIE MAX :630-650 nM. L'utilisation de contrôles ou réglages ou la réalisation de procédures autres que ceux spécifiés dans la documentation utilisateur peut entraîner une exposition à des rayonnements dangereux. La presenza della seguente etichetta sul prodotto indica che il prodotto contiene un laser: LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Questo dispositivo è stato testato in base a ed è conforme agli standard IEC60825-1:2007 e 21, CFR 1040.10 e 1040.11, ad eccezione delle deviazioni ai sensi del documento Laser Notice No. 50, datato 24 giugno 2007. LUCE LASER, NON FISSARE IL RAGGIO LASER, PRODOTTO DI CLASSE 2, POTENZA DI USCITA MAX 1.0 mW : 630-650nM. Un utilizzo dei comandi, dei dispositivi di regolazione o delle procedure non conforme a quanto specificato nella documentazione d'uso può determinare un'esposizione pericolosa alle radiazioni. 激光安全声明 鐳射安全聲明 レーザーの安全性について 레이저 안전 고지 사항 如果您的产品附有以下标签,说明产 品具有激光功能: 若產品上貼有下列之標籤,即表示該 產品具有雷射功能: LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. 製品に次のラベルが添付されている 場合は、製品にレーザーが含まれて いることを示しています。 제품에 다음과 같은 표시가 부착되어 있는 경우 제품에 레이저가 포함되어 있음을 의미합니다 . 此设备已经过测试,符合 IEC608251:2007 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 和 1040.11 标准, 2007 年 6 月 24 日颁 布的第 50 号激光通告所规定的偏离 除外。 激光辐射,不可凝视光束, 2 类激光 产品,最大输出为 1.0 mW:630650nM。 如果使用了用户文档范围之外的操作 步骤控制或调整或执行,可能会导致 危险的辐射暴露。 此裝置已經過測試,符合 IEC608251:2007 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 與 1040.11 標準,但 2007 年 6 月 24 日 發佈的第 50 號鐳射通告中所述的偏 差不在此限。 雷射光,請勿直視雷射光束,CLASS 2 雷射產品,1.0 mW 最大輸出功率: 630-650nM。 若使用的控制、調整或執行等程序並 非依照使用者文件中所指示,可能會 發生危險,導致輻射曝露。 Product Environmental Information LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. この装置は、IEC60825-1:2007 と、 21 CFR 1040.10 および 1040.11 に 従ってテストされ、Laser Notice No. 50 (2007 年 6 月 24 日 ) に従う ことによる逸脱を除き適合していま す。 レーザー光はビームをのぞき込まな いでください。クラス 2 レーザー製 品、1.0 mW 最大出力 : 630-650nM ユーザー マニュアルで指定されてい ない制御や調整の使用または手順の 実行によって、有害な放射線照射が 発生する可能性があります。 LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. 본 장치는 IEC60825-1:2007 과 21 CFR 1040.10 및 1040.11 에 따라 테 스트되었으며 이를 준수하는 것으로 확인되었습니다 . 단 , 2007 년 6 월 24 일자 Laser Notice No. 50 에 의거한 편차는 제외합니다 . 레이저 광선 , 안구에 직접적인 광선 노출 금지 , CLASS 2 레이저 제품 , 1.0mW 최대 출력 : 630-650nM 사용자 설명서에 명시된 내용 이외의 절차를 통해 장치를 조작하거나 조정 하거나 작동하는 경우 인체에 심각한 위해를 끼치는 방사선에 노출될 수 있 습니다 Renseignements relatifs à l’environnement à propos des produits Informations environnementales sur les produits Reportez-vous à la page www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir des renseignements concernant les directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE. Reportez-vous au site www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir les informations sur les directives RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. 产品环境信息 產品環境資訊 製品の環境情報 제품 환경 정보 有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息, 请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 。 請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 以瞭解 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 資訊。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情 報については、 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental を参照してください。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 에서 참조하십시오 . Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. Informazioni ambientali relative al prodotto Consultare il sito web www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental per informazioni su RoHS/REACH/RAEE. Wenn Ihr Produkt mit dem folgenden Etikett gekennzeichnet ist, bedeutet dies, dass das Produkt einen Laser enthält: LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Dieses Gerät wurde geprüft und erfüllt die Anforderungen von IEC60825-1:2007, 21 CFR 1040.10 und 1040.11, mit Ausnahme von Abweichungen gemäß Laser Notice Nr. 50, vom 24. Juni 2007. LASERSTRAHLUNG, NICHT IN DEN STRAHL BLICKEN, LASERPRODUKT DER KLASSE 2, MAXIMALE ENERGIE DER LASERSTRAHLUNG 1,0 mW: 630650 nM. Die Verwendung oder Einstellung von Reglern bzw. die Ausführung von anderen als in dieser Bedienungsanleitung beschriebenen Abläufen kann zu gefährlicher Laserstrahlung führen. IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme .ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1 ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ www.hsmpats.com LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Это устройство прошло испытания согласно следующим стандартам, которым оно соответствует: МЭК 60825-1:2007 и 21 CFR 1040.10 и 1040.11, с учетом разрешений на отступление от требований согласно Уведомлению о лазерах № 50 от 24 июня 2007 г. ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ СВЕТ, НЕ СМОТРИТЕ НА ЛУЧ, ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ ПРОДУКТ КЛАССА 2, 10 МвТ МАКСИМАЛЬНОЙ МОЩНОСТИ: 650nM. 650нМ. Внимание – использование средств управления, регулирования или изменения производительности процедур, отличающихся от указанных в данном документе, может привести к опасному воздействию радиации. Informationen zur Umweltverträglichkeit von Produkten Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental finden Sie Informationen über RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Экологическая информация о продукции Информация о соответствии требованиям RoHS / REACH / WEEE приведена на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع،ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع .www.hsmpats.com إﱃ Declaración de seguridad del láser Declaración de seguridad de láser Declaração de segurança de laser Si la siguiente etiqueta se encuentra adherida al producto, indica que éste contiene un láser: Si la siguiente etiqueta está adherida al producto, indica que éste contiene un láser: Se a seguinte etiquete estiver colada no seu produto, indica que ele contém um laser: LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Este dispositivo se ha probado de acuerdo con las normativas IEC60825-1:2007 y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11 y se ha certificado que las cumple, excepto en lo referente a desviaciones según el aviso sobre láser n.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007. RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO LÁSER DE CLASE 2, POTENCIA MÁXIMA 1 mw: 630-650 nm. El uso de controles, ajustes o procedimientos diferentes a los descritos en la documentación del usuario puede suponer la exposición a radiaciones peligrosas. LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Este dispositivo ha sido evaluado según las normas IEC60825-1:2007 y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11, y cumple con ellas, excepto por las diferencias en virtud del Aviso sobre láser N.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007. RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO LÁSER DE LA CLASE 2, POTENCIA MÁXIMA 1 mW:630-650 nm. El uso de controles, ajustes o procedimientos diferentes a los indicados en la documentación para el usuario puede provocar la exposición a radiaciones peligrosas. Este dispositivo foi testado de acordo e em conformidade com as normas IECC60825-1:2007 e 21 CFR 1040.10 e 1040.11, exceto por divergências de acordo com o Laser Notice nº50, datado de 24 de junho de 2007. LUZ DE LASER, NÃO OLHE FIXAMENTE PARA O FEIXE, PRODUTO A LASER CLASSE 2, SAÍDA MÁXIMA DE 1,0 mW: 630650 nM. A utilização de controles ou ajustes ou a execução de procedimentos de modo diferente do especificado na documentação do usuário pode resultar em exposição nociva à radiação. Información ambiental del producto Información ambiental de producto Informações ambientais sobre produtos Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obtener información sobre RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Consulte la información RoHS/ REACH/WEEE en www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. Consulte a página www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obter informações sobre as normas RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. Заявление о безопасности лазера Если к изделию прикреплена нижеуказанная этикетка, то это означает, что в изделии имеется лазер: . اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ،CB IEC 60950-1 ﻣﺨﻄﻂ :إﱃ أن اﳌﻨﺘﺞ ﻳﺤﺘﻮي ﻋﲆ اﻟﻠﻴﺰر ﻧﴩة اﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ اﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر ﻓﺈﻧﻪ،إذا ﻛﺎن اﳌﻠﺼﻖ اﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﻣﺮﻓﻘًﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﻨﺘﺞ LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. 1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. ،IEC60825-1:2007 ﺗﻢ اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬا اﻟﺠﻬﺎز وﻓﻘًﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎء اﻻﻧﺤﺮاﻓﺎت1040.11 و،CFR 1040.10 21 و ، ﻳﻮﻧﻴﻮ24 ﺑﺘﺎرﻳﺦ،50 اﻹﺷﻌﺎر اﻟﺨﺎص ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر رﻗﻢ .2007 ﻣﻨﺘﺞ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر، ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﻖ ﰲ اﻟﺸﻌﺎع،ﺿﻮء اﻟﻠﻴﺰر .1 ﻣﻦ اﻟﻔﺌﺔ أو، أو اﻟﺘﻌﺪﻳﻼت،ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ – ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆدي اﺳﺘﺨﺪام ﻋﻨﺎﴏ اﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ اﻟﺘﻌﺮض اﻟﻘﻴﺎم ﺑﺈﺟﺮاءات أﺧﺮى ﺗﻠﻚ اﳌﺤﺪدة ﻫﻨﺎ إﱃ .إﱃ اﻹﺷﻌﺎﻋﺎت اﻟﺨﻄﺮة ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳϳΑϟΕΎϔλϭϣϟ ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟϰΟέ˵ϳ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .5R+65($&+:((( 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ :ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. TÜV R Statement Normes TÜV R TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition. Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07, seconde édition. TÜV Rheinland C TÜV Rheinland C US US If the following label is attached to your product, the product meets Korean agency approval: 이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주 로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 , 모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 . This product is EMC B grade equipment, intended for residential use. This equipment can be used in any area. 产品中有害物质的名称及含量 (Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product) 部件名称 (Parts Name) 有害物质 (Hazardous Substances) 铅 (Pb) 汞 (Hg) 镉 (Cd) 六价铬 (Cr6+) 多溴联苯 (PBB) 多溴二苯醚 (PBDE) 成像式二维条码阅读器 (2D Imager) x o o o o o 印刷电路板 (PCB) x o o o o o 外壳 (Housing) o o o o o o 连线 (Cables) o o o o o o 本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。(The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.) o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) This document was prepared and executed in the English language. In the event this document is translated into another language and a conflict arises between the English version and a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being recognized and acknowledged that the English language version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any notice or communication given in connection with this document must include a version in the English language. Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise. Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra, étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en anglais. Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit comporter une version en anglais. Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese. In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in lingua inglese. Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer Sprache erfolgen. Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este documento deve conter a versão em inglês. 本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存 在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最 清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通, 都应包括英文版本。 本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而 英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方 一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所 有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。 本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に 翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係 者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書 に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも のとします。 본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언 어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생 하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의 도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본 문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되 어야 합니다. Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на английском языке. При переводе данного документа на другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным признается, что версия документа на английском языке наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным документом, должны включать в себя версию на английском языке. إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا.ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار، ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي،آﺧﺮ ﻳﺠﺐ أن.اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ .اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and click Resources > Warranty. Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources > Garantie. Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty. Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen > Garantie. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) > Warranty (Garantia). 欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击 Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。 如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按 一下 Resources > Warranty。 保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources > Warranty とクリックしてください。 보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여 Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 . Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty. Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty. Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) > Warranty (Záruka). Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja. Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın. ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com Ωέϭϣϟ< ϥΎϣοϟϕϭϓέϘϧϭwww.honeywellaidc.com 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ ,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ RegSht-1910 Rev C 6/16 Rev E FCC Part 15 Statement This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment. FCC Interference Statement This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. RF Exposure The equipment complies with FCC RF exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. The equipment must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Para su uso en México, la operación de este equipo está sujeta a las siguientes dos condiciones: 1. Es posible que este equipo o dispositivo no cause interferencia perjudicial. 2. Este equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que pueda causar su operación no deseada. Canadian Compliance Conformité à la règlementation canadienne This ISM device complies with Canadian RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Cet appareil ISM est conforme à la norme CNR-210 du Canada. Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes : 1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable. 2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable. Use only shielded data cables with this system. This unit has been tested with cables less than 3 meters. Cables greater than 3 meters may not meet class B performance. Utiliser uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. L’appareil a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Les câbles de longueur supérieure à 3 mètres peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la performance de la classe B. Utilisez uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. Ce dispositif a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Il est possible que les câbles de plus de 3 mètres ne permettent pas d’atteindre des performances de classe B. Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con questo sistema. Questa unità è stata testata con cavi di lunghezza inferiore a 3 metri. I cavi di lunghezza superiore a 3 metri potrebbero non essere conformi alle prestazioni di classe B. Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3 Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien der Klasse B. 此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。此设 备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。 长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B 级性能。 此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。 此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進 行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無 法達到 B 級裝置效能。 このシステムにはシールド付きデー タケーブルのみを使用してください。 この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル でテストされています。3 m 以上の ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ ない場合があります。 이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블 만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터 미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니 다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사용 하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못할 수 있습니다 . Используйте с этой системой только экранированные кабели передачи данных. Это устройство прошло испытания с использованием кабелей длиной менее 3 метров. Рабочие характеристики кабелей длиной свыше 3 м могут не соответствовать классу В. The CE marking indicates compliance with the following directives: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive, when shipped with recommended power supply. European contact: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Le marquage CE indique la conformité avec les directives suivantes : • 1995/5/CE R & TTE • 2011/65/UE – RoHS (Refonte) De plus, ce produit est conforme à la Directive européenne 2014/35/EU relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il est expédié avec le bloc d’alimentation recommandé. Personne-ressource en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Les Pays-Bas Le marquage CE indique la conformité aux directives suivantes : • 1995/5/CE R & TTE • 2011/65/UE RoHS (refonte) De plus, indique la conformité à la directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension, lorsque le dispositif est livré avec l’alimentation électrique recommandée. Contact en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Pays-Bas La marcatura CE indica conformità alle seguenti direttive: • Direttiva R&TTE 1995/5/CE • Direttiva RoHS 2011/65/UE (rifusione) È inoltre conforme ai sensi della Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU, se spedito con l'alimentatore consigliato. Contatto in Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Paesi Bassi Die CEKennzeichnung signalisiert die Konformität mit folgenden Richtlinien: • 1995/5/EG R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/ 35/EU, wenn es mit dem empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird. Ansprechpartner Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Niederlande CE 标记表示符合以 下指令: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (新版) 此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还 符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要 求。欧洲联系信息: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 標記表示符合下 列指令: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (重訂) 此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦 符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲 聯絡資訊: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE マークは、本装置 が次の指令に準拠し ていることを示しま す。 • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS ( 改正 ) また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive にも準拠しています。欧州 でのお問い合わせ : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 마크는 다음 지침 을 준수함을 나타냅 니다 . • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) 또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배 송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를 준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Маркировка CE означает соответствие требованиям следующих директив: • 1995/5/EC Директива о радио- и телекоммуникацион ном оборудовании • 2011/65/EU Директива RoHS (исправленная) Кроме того, соответствует требованиям директивы по низковольтному оборудованию 2014/35/EU при поставке с рекомендованным источником питания. Контактное лицо в Европе: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Class I Catégorie I Classe I Klasse I Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha probado con cables de longitud inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los requisitos de rendimiento de la clase B. ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ 3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ .B ʤʢʸʣʮ La marca CE indica el cumplimiento de las siguientes normativas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Refundida) Asimismo, cumple la normativa de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se envía con la fuente de alimentación recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos Use únicamente cables protegidos para datos con este sistema. Esta unidad ha sido evaluada con cables de menos de 3 metros. Es posible que los cables de más de 3 metros no cumplan con el desempeño de clase B. ﺗﻢ.اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم . أﻣﺘﺎر3 اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ3 ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ .B أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ La indicación CE indica el cumplimiento con las siguientes directivas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulada) Además, cumple con la directiva de bajo voltaje 2006/95/EC cuando se envía con la fuente de poder recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos A marca CE indica conformidade com as seguintes diretivas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulação) Além disso, o produto está em conformidade com a Diretiva para baixa tensão 2014/35/EU, quando fornecido com a fonte de alimentação recomendada. Contato na Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Holanda CE CE : بالمعايير التالية ϭϵϵϱͬϱͬZΘdd v 2011/65/EU RoHS v )(إعادة الصياغة تلتزم بمعيار الجهد المنخفض : 1995/5/EC R&TTE 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) , , 2014/35/EU . : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands 2014/35/EU .الطاقة الموصى به Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands 第I類 I类 Clase I Use somente cabos de dados blindados com este sistema. Esta unidade foi testada com cabos com menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais de 3 metros não atendem o desempenho de classe B. Class I 1 اﻟﻔﺌﺔ CAUTION: Improper battery replacement or incompatible device usage may result in risk of burns, fire, explosion, or other hazard. Dispose of lithium-ion batteries according to local regulations. ! ! 注意:电池更换不当或者用 于不兼容的设备可能导致燃 烧、起火、爆炸或其他危 险。请按照当地规定处置锂 电池。 LED Safety Statement LEDs have been tested and classified as “EXEMPT RISK GROUP” to the standard: IEC 62471:2006. ATTENTION : Un remplacement inadéquat de la batterie ou une utilisation incompatible de l'appareil peut présenter des risques de brulures, d'incendie, d'explosion ou d'autres dangers. Jetez les piles en lithium-ion conformément aux régulations locales. ! ! 注意:不適當的電池更換或 者與不相容的裝置搭配使 用,可能導致燃燒、火災、 爆炸或其他危險。請依照當 地法規處置鋰電池。 Norme de sécurité sur les DEL Les DEL ont été testées et classées en tant que « GROUPE DE RISQUE EXEMPT » par rapport à la norme : IEC 62471:2006. MISE EN GARDE : Le remplacement incorrect de la pile ou l'usage d'un appareil non compatible peut représenter des risques de brûlures, d'incendie, d'explosion ou d'autres dangers. Éliminez les piles lithium-ion usagées conformément aux réglementations locales. Attenzione. La sostituzione inadeguata delle batterie o un uso incompatibile del dispositivo possono causare rischi di ustioni, incendi, esplosioni o altri pericoli. Smaltire le batterie agli ioni di litio in conformità ai regolamenti locali. VORSICHT. Ungeeignete Ersatz-Akkus oder nicht kompatible Gerätenutzung kann zu Verbrennungen, Feuer, Explosion oder anderen Gefahren führen. Entsorgen Sie die Lithium-Ionen-Batterien gemäß den lokalen Richtlinien. 注意 : 誤った電池交換また は互換性の無いデバイスの 使用により、やけど、発 火、爆発などの危険をお引 きおこす可能性がありま す。リチウムイオン電池の廃棄につ いては、地域の規則に従ってくださ い。 주의 : 배터리를 부적절하게 교체하거나 호환되지 않는 장비를 사용하게 되면 , 화 상 , 화재 , 폭발 , 기타 위험 이 발생할 수 있습니다 . 지 역 규정에 따라 리튬 이온 배터리를 처 분하십시오 . ВНИМАНИЕ: В случае неправильной замены аккумулятора или использования несовместимого устройства существует опасность ожога, пожара, взрыва, а также других несчастных случаев. Утилизация литий‐ионных аккумуляторов должна производиться в соответствии с местными нормативами. Norme de sécurité DEL Disposizione di sicurezza LED Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit ! ! Les DEL ont été testées et classées « GROUPE SANS RISQUE » selon la norme : CEI 62471:2006. ! ! I LED sono stati testati e classificati come "GRUPPO ESENTE DA RISCHI" rispetto allo standard: IEC 62471:2006. ! ! Die LEDs wurden geprüft und gemäß der Norm IEC 62471:2006 unter „EXEMPT RISK GROUP“ eingestuft. Заявление о безопасности светодиода PRECAUCIÓN: El reemplazo inadecuado de la batería o el uso de un dispositivo incompatible pueden dar como resultado quemaduras, un incendio, explosión u otros riesgos. Descarte todas las baterías de litio según las regulaciones locales. ! ʤʰʩʠʹ ʤʬʬʥʱʡ ʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʴʬʧʤ :ʺʥʸʩʤʦ ʬʲ .ʵʥʶʩʴ ʺʰʫʱʬ ʭʥʸʢʬ ʤʬʥʬʲ ʤʮʩʠʺʮ ʤʧʮʥʮ ʩʣʩʡ ʲʶʡʺʤʬ ʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʫʬʹʤ ʬʲ ʥʠ ʭʩʸʦʧʥʮʮ ʭʩʸʮʥʧʡ ʬʥʴʩʨʡ ʤʸʹʫʤ ʸʡʲʹ ʯʩʠ .ʭʩʰʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʸʮʥʧ ʺʫʬʹʤʡ ʬʴʨʮʤ ʤʧʮʥʮ ʩʣʩ ʤʴʹʠʡ ʤʺʥʠʪʩʬʹʤʬ ʥʠʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʠʳʥʸʹʬ .ʤʬʩʢʸʤ ! PRECAUCIÓN: El reemplazo inadecuado de la batería o el uso de un dispositivo incompatible puede presentar riesgo de quemaduras, incendio, explosión, u otro tipo de riesgos. Deseche las baterías de iones de litio de acuerdo a las normativas locales. ! CUIDADO: a substituição incorreta da bateria ou o uso de um dispositivo incompatível pode resultar em riscos de queimaduras, incêndio, explosão ou outros perigos. Descarte as baterias de íon de lítio de acordo com as regulamentações locais. ! ﻗﺪ ﺗﻨﻔﺠﺮ اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ إذا ﺗﻢ اﺳﺘﺒﺪاﻟﻬﺎ ﺑﻨﻮع:ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ ﻳﺠﺐ اﻟﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻦ اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺎن.ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻣﺆﻫﻞ ﻹﻋﺎدة اﻟﺘﺪوﻳﺮ أو ﺟﻬﺔ ﻣﺴﺆوﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ اﻟﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺤﺮق اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ أو ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ.ﻣﻊ اﳌﻮاد اﻟﺨﻄﺮة .اﳌﺨﻠﻔﺎت اﻟﻌﺎدﻳﺔ اﻷﺧﺮى ! Declaración de seguridad del LED Declaración de seguridad del LED Declaração de segurança do LED Los LED se han probado y clasificado como “GRUPO EXENTO DE RIESGOS” según la normativa: IEC 62471:2006. Las LED han sido evaluadas y clasificadas como “GRUPO LIBRE DE RIESGOS” según la norma: IEC 62471:2006. Os LEDs foram testados e classificados como “GRUPO DE RISCO ISENTO” conforme a norma: IEC 62471:2006. LED 安全声明 LED 安全聲明 LED の安全性について LED 안전 고지 사항 LED 经测试属于 IEC 62471:2006 标 准的 “ 豁免风险组 ”(EXEMPT RISK GROUP)。 LED 經測試被列為 IEC 62471:2006 標準的 「豁免風險組」 (EXEMPT RISK GROUP)。 LED は IEC 62471:2006 安全規格に 対してテスト済みで、「EXEMPT RISK GROUP ( リスクグループ除外 )」に分類されています。 LED 는 표준 IEC 62471:2006 에 대해 테스트되어 "EXEMPT RISK GROUP" 으로 분류되었습니다 . CB Scheme Plan OC (organismes de certification) Schéma OC Schema CB CB-Zertifizierung Esquema CB Esquema CB Esquema CB Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1 seconde édition (schéma OC). Certificato in base allo Schema CB IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione. CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950, Second Edition. Se ha certificado que cumple el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Se ha certificado que cumple con el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição. Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition. Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième édition. Светодиоды прошли испытания и отнесены к «БЕЗРИСКОВОЙ ГРУППЕ» согласно стандарту МЭК 62471:2006. LED ʺʥʸʥʰ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ "ʯʥʫʩʱ ʺʥʬʥʨʰʫ" ʥʢʥʥʱʥ ʥʷʣʡʰ LED-ʤ ʺʥʸʥʰ IEC 62471:2006 :ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ LED ﺑﻴﺎن ﺳﻼﻣﺔ ǀŸǞƵƆƵż)ƾƷƱƸƶƫůȶ LED ljƸŮƾƫžȤƾƃƄųȚƖ :ȤƾƸƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶ(ǍƭƒȚǜžǑƴƈƄŽȚ .IEC 62471:2006 CB 方案 CB Scheme CB Scheme CB Scheme Схема CB 已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版 的认证。 經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1 標準第二版。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition に認定されています。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition 인증을 받았습니다 . Сертификация согласно схеме CB МЭК 60950-1, издание второе. Patents Brevets Brevets Brevetti Patente Patentes Patentes Patentes For patent information, refer to www.hsmpats.com. Veuillez consulter le site www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des renseignements au sujet du brevet. Pour plus d’informations sur les brevets, visitez la page www.hsmpats.com. Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare riferimento al sito Web www.hsmpats.com. Patentinformationen sind unter www.hsmpats.com erhältlich. Para obtener información sobre las patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com. Para obtener información sobre patentes, consulte www.hsmpats.com. Para obter informações sobre patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com. 专利 專利 特許 특허 Патенты 有关专利信息,请参阅 www.hsmpats.com。 相關專利資訊請參閱 www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。 特許情報については、 www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ さい。 특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참 조하십시오 . Информация о патентах приведена на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com. Laser Safety Statement Déclaration de sécurité relative au laser Déclaration de sécurité laser Dichiarazione sulla sicurezza del dispositivo laser Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit If the following label is attached to your product, it indicates the product contains a laser: LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. This device has been tested in accordance with and complies with IEC60825-1 ed2.0 and 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11, except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. LASER LIGHT, DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM, CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT, 1.0 mW MAX OUTPUT: 630-680nM. Caution - use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure. Si l’étiquette suivante est apposée à votre produit, cela signifie que le produit contient un laser : LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Cet appareil a été testé et reconnu conforme aux normes IEC60825-1 ed2.0 et 21 CFR 1040.10 et 1040.11sauf pour les dérogations en accord avec l'avis de conformité sur les lasers No. 50, en date du 24 juin 2007. LUMIÈRE LASER, NE PAS REGARDER DIRECTEMENT DANS LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2, SORTIE MAX. DE 1,0 MW : 630-680 nm. Mise en garde – l’utilisation de contrôles ou d’ajustements ou de performance de procédures autres que ceux spécifiées dans la présente peut provoquer une exposition dangereuse au rayonnement. Si l'étiquette suivante est attachée à votre produit, elle indique que le produit contient un laser : LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Cet appareil a été testé et certifié conforme aux normes CEI 60825-1 ed2.0, 21 CFR 1040.10 et 21 CFR 1040.11, à l'exception des déviations selon le document Laser Notice n° 50 en date du 24 juin 2007. ATTENTION, LUMIÈRE LASER : NE PAS FIXER LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2 1 mW SORTIE MAX :630-680 nM. L'utilisation de contrôles ou réglages ou la réalisation de procédures autres que ceux spécifiés dans la documentation utilisateur peut entraîner une exposition à des rayonnements dangereux. La presenza della seguente etichetta sul prodotto indica che il prodotto contiene un laser: LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Questo dispositivo è stato testato in base a ed è conforme agli standard IEC60825-1 ed. 2.0 e 21, CFR 1040.10 e 1040.11, ad eccezione delle deviazioni ai sensi del documento Laser Notice No. 50, datato 24 giugno 2007. LUCE LASER, NON FISSARE IL RAGGIO LASER, PRODOTTO DI CLASSE 2, POTENZA DI USCITA MAX 1.0 mW : 630-680nM. Un utilizzo dei comandi, dei dispositivi di regolazione o delle procedure non conforme a quanto specificato nella documentazione d'uso può determinare un'esposizione pericolosa alle radiazioni. Wenn Ihr Produkt mit dem folgenden Etikett gekennzeichnet ist, bedeutet dies, dass das Produkt einen Laser enthält: LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Dieses Gerät wurde geprüft und erfüllt die Anforderungen von IEC60825-1 ed2.0, 21 CFR 1040.10 und 1040.11, mit Ausnahme von Abweichungen gemäß Laser Notice Nr. 50, vom 24. Juni 2007. LASERSTRAHLUNG, NICHT IN DEN STRAHL BLICKEN, LASERPRODUKT DER KLASSE 2, MAXIMALE ENERGIE DER LASERSTRAHLUNG 1,0 mW: 630680 nM. Die Verwendung oder Einstellung von Reglern bzw. die Ausführung von anderen als in dieser Bedienungsanleitung beschriebenen Abläufen kann zu gefährlicher Laserstrahlung führen. CB Scheme IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme .ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1 ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ www.hsmpats.com . اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ،CB IEC 60950-1 ﻣﺨﻄﻂ CB ﻣﺨﻄﻂ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع،ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع .www.hsmpats.com إﱃ Declaración de seguridad del láser Declaración de seguridad de láser Declaração de segurança de laser Si la siguiente etiqueta se encuentra adherida al producto, indica que éste contiene un láser: Si la siguiente etiqueta está adherida al producto, indica que éste contiene un láser: Se a seguinte etiquete estiver colada no seu produto, indica que ele contém um laser: LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Este dispositivo se ha probado de acuerdo con las normativas IEC60825-1 ed2.0 y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11 y se ha certificado que las cumple, excepto en lo referente a desviaciones según el aviso sobre láser n.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007. RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO LÁSER DE CLASE 2, POTENCIA MÁXIMA 1 mw: 630-680 nm. El uso de controles, ajustes o procedimientos diferentes a los descritos en la documentación del usuario puede suponer la exposición a radiaciones peligrosas. 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Este dispositivo ha sido evaluado según las normas IEC60825-1 ed2.0 y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11, y cumple con ellas, excepto por las diferencias en virtud del Aviso sobre láser N.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007. RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO LÁSER DE LA CLASE 2, POTENCIA MÁXIMA 1 mW:630-680 nm. El uso de controles, ajustes o procedimientos diferentes a los indicados en la documentación para el usuario puede provocar la exposición a radiaciones peligrosas. LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. Este dispositivo foi testado de acordo e em conformidade com as normas IECC60825-1 ed2.0 e 21 CFR 1040.10 e 1040.11, exceto por divergências de acordo com o Laser Notice nº50, datado de 24 de junho de 2007. LUZ DE LASER, NÃO OLHE FIXAMENTE PARA O FEIXE, PRODUTO A LASER CLASSE 2, SAÍDA MÁXIMA DE 1,0 mW: 630-680 nM. A utilização de controles ou ajustes ou a execução de procedimentos de modo diferente do especificado na documentação do usuário pode resultar em exposição nociva à radiação. 激光安全声明 鐳射安全聲明 レーザーの安全性について 레이저 안전 고지 사항 如果您的产品附有以下标签,说明产 品具有激光功能: 若產品上貼有下列之標籤,即表示該 產品具有雷射功能: 製品に次のラベルが添付されている 場合は、製品にレーザーが含まれて いることを示しています。 제품에 다음과 같은 표시가 부착되어 있는 경우 제품에 레이저가 포함되어 있음을 의미합니다 . LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. 此设备已经过测试,符合 IEC608251 ed2.0 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 和 1040.11 标准, 2007 年 6 月 24 日颁 布的第 50 号激光通告所规定的偏离 除外。 激光辐射,不可凝视光束, 2 类激光 产品,最大输出为 1.0 mW:630680nM。 此裝置已經過測試,符合 IEC608251 ed2.0 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 與 1040.11 標準,但 2007 年 6 月 24 日 發佈的第 50 號鐳射通告中所述的偏 差不在此限。 雷射光,請勿直視雷射光束,CLASS 2 雷射產品,1.0 mW 最大輸出功率: 630-680nM。 如果使用了用户文档范围之外的操作 步骤控制或调整或执行,可能会导致 危险的辐射暴露。 若使用的控制、調整或執行等程序並 非依照使用者文件中所指示,可能會 發生危險,導致輻射曝露。 Product Environmental Information LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. この装置は、IEC60825-1: 1993+A1+A2 と、21 CFR 1040.10 お よび 1040.11 に従ってテストされ、 Laser Notice No. 50 (2007 年 6 月 24 日 ) に従うことによる逸脱を除き 適合しています。 LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. 본 장치는 IEC60825-1 ed2.0 과 21 CFR 1040.10 및 1040.11 에 따라 테 스트되었으며 이를 준수하는 것으로 확인되었습니다 . 단 , 2007 년 6 월 24 일자 Laser Notice No. 50 에 의거한 편 차는 제외합니다 . レーザー光はビームをのぞき込まな いでください。クラス 2 レーザー製 品、1.0 mW 最大出力 : 630-680nM 레이저 광선 , 안구에 직접적인 광선 노출 금지 , CLASS 2 레이저 제품 , 1.0mW 최대 출력 : 630-680nM ユーザー マニュアルで指定されてい ない制御や調整の使用または手順の 実行によって、有害な放射線照射が 発生する可能性があります。 사용자 설명서에 명시된 내용 이외의 절차를 통해 장치를 조작하거나 조정 하거나 작동하는 경우 인체에 심각한 위해를 끼치는 방사선에 노출될 수 있 습니다 . Renseignements relatifs à l’environnement à propos des produits Informations environnementales sur les produits Reportez-vous à la page www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir des renseignements concernant les directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE. Reportez-vous au site www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir les informations sur les directives RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. 产品环境信息 產品環境資訊 製品の環境情報 제품 환경 정보 有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息, 请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 。 請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 以瞭解 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 資訊。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情 報については、 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental を参照してください。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 에서 참조하십시오 . Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. Normes TÜV R TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition. Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07, seconde édition. TÜV Rheinland C US US ʸʦʩʩʬ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. Это устройство прошло испытания согласно следующим стандартам, которым оно соответствует: МЭК 60825-1 ред. 2.0 и 21 CFR 1040.10 и 1040.11, с учетом разрешений на отступление от требований согласно Уведомлению о лазерах № 50 от 24 июня 2007 г. ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ СВЕТ, НЕ СМОТРИТЕ НА ЛУЧ, ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ ПРОДУКТ КЛАССА 2, 10 МвТ МАКСИМАЛЬНОЙ МОЩНОСТИ: 630-680нМ. Внимание – использование средств управления, регулирования или изменения производительности процедур, отличающихся от указанных в данном документе, может привести к опасному воздействию радиации. Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental finden Sie Informationen über RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Экологическая информация о продукции ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. ʯʷʺ ʭʲ ʤʮʠʺʤʡʥ ʩʴ-ʬʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ 21 CFR 1040.10 ʯʫʥ IEC60825-1 ed2.0 Notice No. 50, -ʮ ʺʥʩʨʱ ʨʲʮʬ ,1040.11 -ʥ .2007 ,ʩʰʥʩʡ 24 ʸʦʩʩʬ ʸʶʥʮ ,ʯʸʷʤ ʪʥʺʬ ʨʩʡʤʬ ʯʩʠ ,ʸʦʩʩʬ ʸʥʠ mW: 1.0 ʬʹ ʺʩʡʸʮ ʤʷʥʴʺ ,CLASS 2 ʢʥʱʮ .630-680nM ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡ ʥʠ ʤʮʠʺʤ ʥʠ ʭʩʸʷʡʡ ʹʥʮʩʹʤ - ʺʥʸʩʤʦ ʭʩʬʥʬʲ ʺʠʦʡ ʯʩʥʶʮʤ ʩʴ-ʬʲ ʭʰʩʠʹ ʭʩʫʩʬʤʺʤ ʬʹ .ʤʰʩʸʷʬ ʺʰʫʥʱʮ ʤʴʩʹʧʬ ʭʥʸʢʬ IEC60825- ǍƸƁƾƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶȥƾƷƐȚȚnjƀȤƾƃƄųȚƖ ȔƾƶƅƄŴƾŮ 1040.11ȶȆCFR 1040.10 21 ȶȆ1:2007 Ȇ50ǛŻȤȤǎƸƴŽƾŮȨƾƒȚȤƾƯŵȁȚƿűǞƙȝƾźȚǍƇſǽȚ .2007ȆǞƸſǞƁ 24NJƁȤƾƄŮ ǃƄƶž .ȬƾƯƪŽȚǠźǘƁNjƇƄŽƾŮǛƲůǽ .ȤǎƸƴŽȚȔǞǤ ȟȚǍųȂŽǟƫŻLjȚNjƑȚ .2ǀƂƱŽȚǜžȤǎƸƴŽƾŮǚƵƯƁ .ǍŽǞžǞſƾſ 630-680 :ȝȚȶǠƴƴž 1.0 ȶȖȆǛƳƇƄŽȚǍǧƾƶŸȳȚNjƈƄŴȚȸȢƻƁNjŻ –ǍƁnjƎ ȜȢNjƤȚǙƴůǍƸŹȷǍųȖȝȚȔȚǍűƼŮȳƾƸƲŽȚȶȖȆȝǾƁNjƯƄŽȚ .ȜǍƭƒȚȝƾŸƾƯŵȁȚǟŽȘȩǍƯƄŽȚȲƾƵƄŲȚǟŽȘƾƶƀ Información ambiental del producto Información ambiental de producto Informações ambientais sobre produtos Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obtener información sobre RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Consulte la información RoHS/ REACH/WEEE en www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. Consulte a página www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obter informações sobre as normas RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ :ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳϳΑϟΕΎϔλϭϣϟ ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟϰΟέ˵ϳ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .5R+65($&+:((( Информация о соответствии требованиям RoHS / REACH / WEEE приведена на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. 이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주 로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 , 모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 . LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. ᧨ ᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS 曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮 REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW: 630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007. If the following label is attached to your product, the product meets Korean agency approval: ȤǎƸƴŽƾŮǀǧƾƒȚǀžǾƉŽȚȜǍƪſ ǃƄƶƓȚȴȖǟŽȘǍƸƪƁǝſƼźȆǃƄƶƓƾŮƾ ȹƲźǍžǠŽƾƄŽȚǘƫƴƓȚȴƾżȚȣȘ :ȤǎƸƴŽȚǟƴŸȸǞƄƇƁ ʸʶʥʮʬʺʴʸʥʶʮʤʠʡʤʺʩʥʥʺʤʭʠ ʸʦʩʬʬʩʫʮʸʶʥʮʤʹʤʠʸʮʤʦʪʬʹ Если к изделию прикреплена нижеуказанная этикетка, то это означает, что в изделии имеется Informationen zur Umweltverträglichkeit von Produkten Consultare il sito web www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental per informazioni su RoHS/REACH/RAEE. TÜV R Statement TÜV Rheinland C Informazioni ambientali relative al prodotto Заявление о безопасности лазера Este produto está homologado pela ANATEL, de acordo com os procedimentos regulamentados pela Resolução No. 242/2000 e atende aos requisitos técnicos aplicados. Para maiores informações, consulte o site da ANATEL – www.anatel.gov.br This product is EMC B grade equipment, intended for residential use. This equipment can be used in any area. Modelo: 1911i 1931-14-1571 (01)07898927490133 " Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário, isto é, não tem direito a proteção contra interferência prejudicial, mesmo de estações do mesmo tipo, e não pode causar interferência a sistemas operando em caráter primário." 产品中有害物质的名称及含量 (Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product) 有害物质 (Hazardous Substances) 部件名称 (Parts Name) 铅 (Pb) 汞 (Hg) 镉 (Cd) 六价铬 (Cr6+) 多溴联苯 (PBB) 多溴二苯醚 (PBDE) 成像式二维条码阅读器 (2D Imager) x o o o o o 印刷电路板 (PCB) x o o o o o 外壳 (Housing) o o o o o o 连线 (Cables) o o o o o o 本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。(The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.) o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) This document was prepared and executed in the English language. In the event this document is translated into another language and a conflict arises between the English version and a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being recognized and acknowledged that the English language version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any notice or communication given in connection with this document must include a version in the English language. Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise. Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra, étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en anglais. Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit comporter une version en anglais. Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese. In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in lingua inglese. Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer Sprache erfolgen. Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este documento deve conter a versão em inglês. 本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存 在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最 清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通, 都应包括英文版本。 本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而 英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方 一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所 有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。 本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に 翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係 者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書 に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも のとします。 본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언 어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생 하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의 도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본 문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되 어야 합니다. Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на английском языке. При переводе данного документа на другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным признается, что версия документа на английском языке наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным документом, должны включать в себя версию на английском языке. For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and click Resources > Warranty. Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources > Garantie. Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty. Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen > Garantie. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) > Warranty (Garantia). 欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击 Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。 如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按 一下 Resources > Warranty。 保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources > Warranty とクリックしてください。 보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여 Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 . Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty. Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty. Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) > Warranty (Záruka). Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja. Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın. ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com Ωέϭϣϟ< ϥΎϣοϟϕϭϓέϘϧϭwww.honeywellaidc.com ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ ,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا.ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار، ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي،آﺧﺮ ﻳﺠﺐ أن.اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ .اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ RegSht-1911 Rev E 6/16 Rev B FCC Part 15 Statement This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment. FCC Interference Statement This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. RF Exposure The equipment complies with FCC RF exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. The equipment must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Para su uso en México, la operación de este equipo está sujeta a las siguientes dos condiciones: 1. Es posible que este equipo o dispositivo no cause interferencia perjudicial. 2. Este equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que pueda causar su operación no deseada. Canadian Compliance Conformité à la règlementation canadienne This ISM device complies with Canadian RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Cet appareil ISM est conforme à la norme CNR-210 du Canada. Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes : 1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable. 2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable. Use only shielded data cables with this system. This unit has been tested with cables less than 3 meters. Cables greater than 3 meters may not meet class B performance. Utiliser uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. L’appareil a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Les câbles de longueur supérieure à 3 mètres peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la performance de la classe B. Utilisez uniquement des câbles de données blindés avec ce système. Ce dispositif a été testé avec des câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Il est possible que les câbles de plus de 3 mètres ne permettent pas d’atteindre des performances de classe B. Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con questo sistema. Questa unità è stata testata con cavi di lunghezza inferiore a 3 metri. I cavi di lunghezza superiore a 3 metri potrebbero non essere conformi alle prestazioni di classe B. Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3 Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien der Klasse B. 此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。 此设 备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。 长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B 级性能。 此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。 此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進 行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無 法達到 B 級裝置效能。 このシステムにはシールド付きデー タケーブルのみを使用してください。 この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル でテストされています。3 m 以上の ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ ない場合があります。 이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블 만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터 미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니 다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사용 하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못할 수 있습니다 . Используйте с этой системой только экранированные кабели передачи данных. Это устройство прошло испытания с использованием кабелей длиной менее 3 метров. Рабочие характеристики кабелей длиной свыше 3 м могут не соответствовать классу В. The CE marking indicates compliance with the following directives: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive, when shipped with recommended power supply. European contact: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Le marquage CE indique la conformité avec les directives suivantes : • 1995/5/CE R & TTE • 2011/65/UE – RoHS (Refonte) De plus, ce produit est conforme à la Directive européenne 2014/35/EU relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il est expédié avec le bloc d’alimentation recommandé. Personne-ressource en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Les Pays-Bas Le marquage CE indique la conformité aux directives suivantes : • 1995/5/CE R & TTE • 2011/65/UE RoHS (refonte) De plus, indique la conformité à la directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension, lorsque le dispositif est livré avec l’alimentation électrique recommandée. Contact en Europe : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Pays-Bas La marcatura CE indica conformità alle seguenti direttive: • Direttiva R&TTE 1995/5/CE • Direttiva RoHS 2011/65/UE (rifusione) È inoltre conforme ai sensi della Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU, se spedito con l'alimentatore consigliato. Contatto in Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Paesi Bassi Die CEKennzeichnung signalisiert die Konformität mit folgenden Richtlinien: • 1995/5/EG R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/ 35/EU, wenn es mit dem empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird. Ansprechpartner Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Niederlande CE 标记表示符合以 下指令: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (新版) 此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还 符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要 求。欧洲联系信息: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 標記表示符合下 列指令: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (重訂) 此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦 符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲 聯絡資訊: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE マークは、本装置 が次の指令に準拠し ていることを示しま す。 • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS ( 改正 ) また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive にも準拠しています。欧州 でのお問い合わせ : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands CE 마크는 다음 지침 을 준수함을 나타냅 니다 . • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) 또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배 송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를 준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Маркировка CE означает соответствие требованиям следующих директив: • 1995/5/EC Директива о радио- и телекоммуникацио нном оборудовании • 2011/65/EU Директива RoHS (исправленная) Кроме того, соответствует требованиям директивы по низковольтному оборудованию 2014/35/EU при поставке с рекомендованным источником питания. Контактное лицо в Европе: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Class I Catégorie I Classe I Klasse I Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha probado con cables de longitud inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los requisitos de rendimiento de la clase B. ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ 3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ .B ʤʢʸʣʮ La marca CE indica el cumplimiento de las siguientes normativas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Refundida) Asimismo, cumple la normativa de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se envía con la fuente de alimentación recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos CE : 1995/5/EC R&TTE 2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast) , , 2014/35/EU . : Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands Use únicamente cables protegidos para datos con este sistema. Esta unidad ha sido evaluada con cables de menos de 3 metros. Es posible que los cables de más de 3 metros no cumplan con el desempeño de clase B. ﺗﻢ.اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم . أﻣﺘﺎر3 اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ3 ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ .B أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ La indicación CE indica el cumplimiento con las siguientes directivas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulada) Además, cumple con la directiva de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EC cuando se envía con la fuente de poder recomendada. Contacto europeo: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Países Bajos A marca CE indica conformidade com as seguintes diretivas: • 1995/5/EC R&TTE • 2011/65/EU RoHS (Reformulação) Além disso, o produto está em conformidade com a Diretiva para baixa tensão 2014/35/ EU, quando fornecido com a fonte de alimentação recomendada. Contato na Europa: Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen Holanda CE : بالمعايير التالية ϭϵϵϱͬϱͬZΘdd v 2011/65/EU RoHS v )(إعادة الصياغة تلتزم بمعيار الجهد المنخفض 2014/35/EU .الطاقة الموصى به Hand Held Products Europe B.V. Lagelandseweg 70 6545CG Nijmegen The Netherlands 第I類 I类 Clase I Use somente cabos de dados blindados com este sistema. Esta unidade foi testada com cabos com menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais de 3 metros não atendem o desempenho de classe B. Class I 1 اﻟﻔﺌﺔ CB Scheme Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition. Plan OC (organismes de certification) Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième édition. Schéma OC Schema CB CB-Zertifizierung Esquema CB Esquema CB Esquema CB Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1 seconde édition (schéma OC). Certificato in base allo Schema CB IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione. CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950, Second Edition. Se ha certificado que cumple el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Se ha certificado que cumple con el esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda edición. Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição. CB 方案 CB Scheme CB Scheme CB Scheme Схема CB 已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版 的认证。 經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1 標準第二版。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition に認定されています。 CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second Edition 인증을 받았습니다 . Сертификация согласно схеме CB МЭК 60950-1, издание второе. Patents Brevets Brevets Brevetti Patente Patentes Patentes Patentes For patent information, refer to www.hsmpats.com. Veuillez consulter le site www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des renseignements au sujet du brevet. Pour plus d’informations sur les brevets, visitez la page www.hsmpats.com. Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare riferimento al sito Web www.hsmpats.com. Patentinformationen sind unter www.hsmpats.com erhältlich. Para obtener información sobre las patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com. Para obtener información sobre patentes, consulte www.hsmpats.com. Para obter informações sobre patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com. 专利 專利 特許 특허 Патенты 有关专利信息,请参阅 www.hsmpats.com。 相關專利資訊請參閱 www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。 特許情報については、 www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ さい。 특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참 조하십시오 . Информация о патентах приведена на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com. Product Environmental Information Renseignements relatifs à l’environnement à propos des produits Informations environnementales sur les produits Informazioni ambientali relative al prodotto Informationen zur Umweltverträglichkeit von Produkten Reportez-vous à la page www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir des renseignements concernant les directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE. Reportez-vous au site www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental pour obtenir les informations sur les directives RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. 产品环境信息 產品環境資訊 製品の環境情報 제품 환경 정보 有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息, 请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 。 請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 以瞭解 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 資訊。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情 報については、 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental を参照してください。 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는 www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental 에서 참조하십시오 . Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. TÜV R Statement Normes TÜV R TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition. Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07, seconde édition. TÜV Rheinland C Consultare il sito web www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental per informazioni su RoHS/REACH/RAEE. TÜV Rheinland C US US CB Scheme IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme .ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1 ʭʩʨʰʨʴ Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental finden Sie Informationen über RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Экологическая информация о продукции Информация о соответствии требованиям RoHS / REACH / WEEE приведена на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. If the following label is attached to your product, the product meets Korean agency approval: 이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주 로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 , 모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 . This product is EMC B grade equipment, intended for residential use. This equipment can be used in any area. ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ www.hsmpats.com . اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ،CB IEC 60950-1 ﻣﺨﻄﻂ CB ﻣﺨﻄﻂ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع،ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع .www.hsmpats.com إﱃ Información ambiental del producto Información ambiental de producto Informações ambientais sobre produtos Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obtener información sobre RoHS/REACH/ WEEE. Consulte la información RoHS/ REACH/WEEE en www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental. Consulte a página www.honeywellaidc.com/ environmental para obter informações sobre as normas RoHS/ REACH/WEEE. ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ :ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information. ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳϳΑϟΕΎϔλϭϣϟ ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟϰΟέ˵ϳ www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .5R+65($&+:((( 依據標準 : 低功率射頻電機技術規範 : LP0002 NCC standard: Low power frequency electric machineries technical standard: LP0002 根據交通部低功率管理辦法規定: 第十二條 經型式認證合格之低功率射頻電機,非經許 可,公司、商號或使用者均不得擅自 變更頻率、加大功率或變更原設計之特性及功能。 第十四條 低功率射頻電機之使用不得影響飛航安全及干擾合法通信;經 發現有干擾現象 時,應立即停用,並改善至無干擾時方得繼續使用。 前項合法通信,指依電信規定作業之無線電信。低功率射頻電 機須忍受合法通信 或工業、科學及醫療用電波輻射性電機設備之干擾。 Este produto está homologado pela ANATEL, de acordo com os procedimentos regulamentados pela Resolução No. 242/2000 e atende aos requisitos técnicos aplicados. Para maiores informações, consulte o site da ANATEL – www.anatel.gov.br CIDF15000182 Modelo: CCB02 1937-14-1571 (01)07898927490140 " Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário, isto é, não tem direito a proteção contra interferência prejudicial, mesmo de estações do mesmo tipo, e não pode causar interferência a sistemas operando em caráter primário." 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com 产品中有害物质的名称及含量 (Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product) 部件名称 (Parts Name) 有害物质 (Hazardous Substances) 铅 (Pb) 汞 (Hg) 镉 (Cd) 六价铬 (Cr6+) 多溴联苯 (PBB) 多溴二苯醚 (PBDE) 印刷电路板 (PCB) x o o o o o 外壳 (Housing) o o o o o o 连线 (Cables) o o o o o o 本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。 (The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.) o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.) This document was prepared and executed in the English language. In the event this document is translated into another language and a conflict arises between the English version and a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being recognized and acknowledged that the English language version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any notice or communication given in connection with this document must include a version in the English language. Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise. Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra, étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en anglais. Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit comporter une version en anglais. Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese. In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in lingua inglese. Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer Sprache erfolgen. Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés. Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este documento deve conter a versão em inglês. 本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存 在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最 清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通, 都应包括英文版本。 本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而 英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方 一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所 有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。 本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に 翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係 者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書 に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも のとします。 본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언 어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생 하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의 도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본 문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되 어야 합니다. Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на английском языке. При переводе данного документа на другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным признается, что версия документа на английском языке наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным документом, должны включать в себя версию на английском языке. For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and click Resources > Warranty. Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources > Garantie. Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty. Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen > Garantie. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía. Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) > Warranty (Garantia). 欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击 Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。 如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按 一下 Resources > Warranty。 保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources > Warranty とクリックしてください。 보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여 Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 . Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty. Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty. Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) > Warranty (Záruka). Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja. Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın. ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ .Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com Ωέϭϣϟ< ϥΎϣοϟϕϭϓέϘϧϭwww.honeywellaidc.com ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ ,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا.ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار، ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي،آﺧﺮ ﻳﺠﺐ أن.اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ .اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ Manufacturer Contact Information: Honeywell International Inc. Honeywell Sensing & Productivity Solutions 9680 Old Bailes Road Fort Mill, SC 29707 USA 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com CCB02-MULT-RS Rev B 6/16 Honeywell 9680 Old Bailes Road Fort Mill, SC 29707 www.honeywellaidc.com ™ Xenon-UG Rev R 2/17 8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
advertisement
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project